TWiki Reference Manual (TWiki-4.2.3, Wed, 06 Aug 2008, build 17396)
This page contains all documentation topics as one long, complete reference sheet.
Related Topics: TWikiSite,
TWikiHistory,
TWikiPlannedFeatures,
TWikiEnhancementRequests,
UserDocumentationCategory,
AdminDocumentationCategory
TWiki System Requirements
Server and client requirements
Low client and server base requirements are core features that keep TWiki widely deployable, particularly across a range of browser platforms and versions. Many
Plugins and
contrib modules exist which enhance and expand TWiki's capabilities; they may have additional requirements.
Server Requirements
TWiki is written in Perl 5, uses a number of shell commands, and requires
RCS (Revision Control System), a GNU Free Software package. TWiki is developed in a basic Linux/Apache environment. It also works with Microsoft Windows, and should have no problem on any other platform that meets the requirements.
Resource |
Required Server Environment * |
Perl |
5.6.1 or higher (5.8.4 or higher is recommended) |
RCS |
5.7 or higher (including GNU diff ) Optional, TWiki includes a pure perl implementation of RCS that can be used instead (although it's slower) |
GNU diff |
GNU diff 2.7 or higher is required when not using the all-Perl RcsLite. Install on PATH if not included with RCS (check version with diff -v ) Must be the version used by RCS, to avoid problems with binary attachments - RCS may have hard-coded path to diff |
GNU patch |
For upgrades only: GNU patch is required when using the TWiki:Codev.UpgradeTWiki script |
GNU fgrep , egrep |
Modify command line parameters in configure if you use non-GNU grep programs |
Cron/scheduler |
• Unix: cron • Windows: cron equivalents |
Web server |
Apache is well supported; see TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki#OtherWebServers for other servers |
Required CPAN Modules
The following Perl modules are used by TWiki:
Module |
Preferred version |
Algorithm::Diff (included) |
|
CGI::Carp |
>=1.26 |
Config |
>=0 |
Cwd |
>=3.05 |
Data::Dumper |
>=2.121 |
Error (included) |
|
File::Copy |
>=2.06 |
File::Find |
>=1.05 |
File::Spec |
>=3.05 |
File::Temp |
(included with perl 5.6 and later) |
FileHandle |
>=2.01 |
IO::File |
>=1.10 |
Text::Diff (included) |
|
Time::Local |
>=1.11 |
Optional CPAN Modules
The following Perl modules may be used by TWiki:
Module |
Preferred version |
Description |
CGI::Cookie |
>=1.24 |
Used for session support |
CGI::Session |
>=3.95 |
Used for session support |
Digest::base |
|
|
Digest::SHA1 |
|
|
Jcode |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Locale::Maketext::Lexicon |
>=0 |
Used for I18N support |
Net::SMTP |
>=2.29 |
Used for sending mail |
Unicode::Map |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Unicode::Map8 |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Unicode::MapUTF8 |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Unicode::String |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
URI |
|
Used for configure |
Most of them will probably already be available in your installation. You can check version numbers with the
configure
script, or if you're still trying to get to that point, check from the command line like this:
perl -e 'use FileHandle; print $FileHandle::VERSION."\n"'
Client Requirements
The TWiki
standard installation has relatively low browser requirements:
- HTML 3.2 compliant
- Cookies, if persistent sessions are required
CSS and Javascript are used in most skins, although there is a low-fat skin (Classic skin) available that minimises these requirements. Some skins will require more recent releases of browsers. The default skin (Pattern) is tested on IE 6, Safari, and Mozilla 5.0 based browsers (such as Firefox).
You can easily select a balance of browser capability versus look and feel. Try the installed skins at
TWikiSkinBrowser and more at
TWiki:Plugins.SkinPackage.
Important note about TWiki Plugins
- Plugins can require just about anything - browser-specific functions, stylesheets (CSS), Java applets, cookies, specific Perl modules,... - check the individual Plugin specs.
Related Topics: AdminDocumentationCategory
Back to top
TWiki Installation Guide
The following is installation instructions for the TWiki 4.2 production release on an Apache web server on Linux. Visit
TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki for the latest updates to this guide and supplemental information for installing or upgrading TWiki, including notes on installing TWiki on different platforms, environments and web hosting sites.
If you are upgrading from a previous version of TWiki, you probably want to read
TWikiUpgradeGuide
instead.
Both this document and the TWikiUpgradeGuide are also available in the root of the distribution as HTML files. For this reason links to pages inside your own TWiki are written like
TWiki.WebHome
and not like live web links.
Preparing to install TWiki
Before attempting to install TWiki, you are encouraged to review the
TWiki:TWiki.AdminSkillsAssumptions. This guide assumes the person installing TWiki has, at a minimum, basic knowledge of server administration on the system on which TWiki is to be installed. While it is possible to install TWiki with FTP access alone (for example, on a hosted site), it is tricky and may require additional support from your hosting service (for example, in setting file ownership and installing missing perl CPAN libraries).
To help setup a correct Apache configuration, you are very much encouraged to use the automatic tool
TWiki:TWiki.ApacheConfigGenerator which generates the contents for an Apache config file for TWiki based on your inputs.
While this installation guide specifically describes installation on an Apache web server on Linux, TWiki should be fine with any web server and OS that meet the system requirements (see below). For additional notes on installing TWiki on other systems, see
TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki#OtherPlatforms.
If you are installing TWiki without Unix/Linux root (administrator) priviledges (for example, on a hosted domain), see "Notes on Installing TWiki on Non-Root Account" below for supplemental instructions to the basic steps presented below.
If you are upgrading from an earlier major version of TWiki such as Cairo (TWiki 3) you will need the information found in
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiUpgradeGuide. There is also a static HTML
TWikiUpgradeGuide.html
included in the root of your TWiki distribution.
Upgrading from a recent TWiki4 release is much simpler. Upgraders from earlier TWiki4 versions can follow the steps described in
TWiki:TWiki.UpgradingTWiki04x00PatchReleases to ensure a safe upgrade without accidently overwriting customizations.
One of the more difficult tasks is installation of addition CPAN libraries. See
TWiki:TWiki.HowToInstallCpanModules for detailed information on how to install CPAN libraries.
If you need help, ask a question in the
TWiki:Support web or on
TWiki:Codev.TWikiIRC (irc.freenode.net, channel #twiki)
Basic Installation
- Download the TWiki distribution from http://TWiki.org/download.html.
- Make a directory for the installation and unpack the distribution in it. In the rest of this document we assume this directory is called
twiki
.
- Note! that TWiki does not allow spaces in the directory names. Especially on Windows make sure to use a directory path without spaces.
- Setup access file and directory rights to enable the webserver user (the user Apache runs the CGI scripts as) to read and write inside the twiki directory.
- Warning! Do not just just run a
chmod -R 770 twiki
. The access rules have different meaning for files and directories. This is the most common mistake installers make.
- The distribution tgz has the file and directory access rights setup to work with a reasonable security level that will work for all types of installations including shared hosting.
- The ownership of the twiki directory tree is normally set to the user that unpacked the tgz and will have to be changed to the webserver user using the command
chown -R user:group /path/to/twiki
. The webserver username varies from Distributions. Examples for some major distributions:
- RedHat, Fedora, CentOS, Gentoo, Mandriva :
chown -R apache:apache /path/to/twiki
- debian/Ubuntu/Kubunto :
chown -R www-data:www-data /path/to/twiki
- Suse :
chown -R wwwrun:www /path/to/twiki
- If you mistakenly change the access rights in a way that makes TWiki stop working, simply run the script found at TWiki:TWiki.SettingFileAccessRightsLinuxUnix to set the access right of the entire TWiki tree back to the distributed defaults.
- It is possible to define tighter access rules than the ones given by default after the installation is complete. But how tight they should be depends on your distribution and local needs. Typically you may want to limit all access from world if the webserver machine has login access for other users than root and the web server administrator. For a dedicated web server made just for running TWiki with limited login access the default access rights have a good safety level.
- Check the Perl installation. Ensure that Perl 5 and the Perl CGI library are installed on your system.
- The default location of Perl is
/usr/bin/perl
. If it's somewhere else, change the path to Perl in the first line of each script in the twiki/bin
directory.
- Some systems require a special extension on perl scripts (e.g.
.cgi
or .pl
). This is normally only needed under Windows and only where perl scripts are only recognized by file extension. Linux and Unix users should normally never need to do this. If necessary, rename all files in twiki/bin
(i.e. rename view
to view.pl
etc). If you do this, make sure you set the ScriptSuffix
option in configure
(Step 6).
- Create the file LocalLib.cfg located as
twiki/bin/LocalLib.cfg
- There is a template for this file in
twiki/bin/LocalLib.cfg.txt
. Simply copy LocalLib? .cfg.txt to LocalLib? .cfg. Make sure the ownership and access rights of the copy are the same as LocalLib? .cfg.txt
- The file
twiki/bin/LocalLib.cfg
must contain a setting for $twikiLibPath
, which must point to the absolute file path of your twiki/lib
e.g. /var/www/twiki/lib
.
- If you need to install additional CPAN modules, but can't update the main Perl installation files on the server, you can set
$CPANBASE
to point to your personal CPAN install. Don't forget that the webserver user has to be able to read those files as well.
- Choose best configuration method for your webserver. There are two ways to configure Apache: config file included from httpd.conf or .htaccess files
- Apache config file: The recommended method is using a config file. With a config file you can put the entire TWiki configuration in ONE file (typically named
twiki.conf
). Performance is much better with a config file, and one file gives the best overview and ensures that you get a safe installation . However using a config file requires that you can restart Apache which again means that you need root or sudo access to stop and start Apache. The TWiki apache config file is included from the main Apache config file http.conf. Most distributions have a directory from which any file that ends with .conf
gets included when you restart Apache (Example RedHat/Fedora/Centos: /etc/httpd/conf.d). If you use a virtual host setup in Apache you should include the twiki.conf file from inside the desired virtual host config in your Apache configuration.
- .htaccess file: This should only be used when you cannot use a config file. Performance is slowed down because Apache has to look through all directories in search for possible .htaccess files each time someone views a page in TWiki. Normally this is the only way to control Apache in a shared host environment where you have no root or sudo priviledges.
- Configure the webserver
- Unless you are an Apache expert setting up the webserver can be quite difficult. But TWiki has three resources that make setting up Apache easier.
- The best and easiest way is to use webpage TWiki:TWiki.ApacheConfigGenerator which contains a tool that can generate a safe and working config file for TWiki on Apache.
- In the root of the twiki installation you find an example config file
twiki_httpd_conf.txt
- In the root of the twiki installation and in the
twiki/bin
directory you find example .htaccess
files you can copy and modify. The files contains help text explaining how to set them up. In twiki/bin
you find .htaccess.txt
which can be copied to .htaccess
and defined access to the CGI scripts. In the root of TWiki you find pub-htaccess.txt
which you can copy to pub/.htaccess
, subdir-htaccess.txt
which you can copy to all directories as .htaccess
except bin and pub, and you find root-htaccess.txt
which you can copy to .htaccess
in the twiki root directory. But again only use .htaccess files if you do not have root priviledges.
- If you are unsure about how to do this on your system, see TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki#OtherPlatforms for links to information about various server setups.
- Note! When you use config files you need to restart Apache each time you change a setting to make the new setting active.
- Protect the configure script
- You should never leave the
configure
script open to the public. Limit access to the twiki/bin/configure
script to either localhost, an IP address or a specific user using basic Apache authentication. The TWiki:TWiki.ApacheConfigGenerator lets you setup who has access to the configure script. Also the example twiki-httpd-conf.txt and bin/.htaccess.txt files includes the needed setting to protect the configure script.
- If you limit the access to a particular user then you need to setup a .htpasswd file that contains the user name and password that Apache will authenticate against. Per default both TWiki:TWiki.ApacheConfigGenerator and the example config files and .htaccess files uses
twiki/data/.htpasswd
but this file does not exist until you have TWiki running and have registered the first user. You therefore have two options. Either limit the access to localhost or an IP address, or make a .htpasswd file. To make a .htpasswd file change directory to twiki/data
and issue the command htpasswd -c .htpasswd username
and enter your password when asked. The username must match the Require user username
directive in the Apache config file or .htaccess file. Do not use a username you will later use to register in TWiki because TWiki will then claim that you are already registered.
- Run the
configure
script from your browser (enter http://yourdomain/twiki/bin/configure
into your browser address bar)
- Resolve any errors or warnings it tells you about.
- Note! When you run
configure
for the first time, you can only edit the section General Path Settings
. Save these settings, and then return to configure
to continue configuration.
- If your webserver can be accessed by more than one domain name make sure to add the additional alternative URLs to
{PermittedRedirectHostUrls}
- When you return to configure you now need to setup Mail and Proxies. Especially the
{WebMasterEmail}
, and {SMTP}{MAILHOST}
must be defined to enable TWiki to send registration emails. Many ISPs have introduced authentication when sending emails to fight spam so you may also have to set {SMTP}{Username}
and {SMTP}{Password}
. If you do not want to enable mailing or want to enable it later you can uncheck {EnableEmail}
.
You now have a basic, unauthenticated installation running. At this point you can just point your Web browser at
http://yourdomain.com/twiki/bin/view
and start TWiki-ing away!
Important Server Security Settings
Before you continue any further there are some basic and very important security settings you have to make sure are set correctly.
- As already described above you should protect the configure script from general access. The configure script is designed for use by administrators only and should be restricted to invocation by them only, by using the basic Apache authentication. Because of this there has not been put much effort into hardening the script. The configure script cannot save any settings once the password has been saved the first time, but the script could still be vulnerable to specially crafted field values and the script reveals many details about the webserver that you should not display in public.
- You absolutely must turn off any kind of PHP, Perl, Python, Server Side Includes etc in the
pub
directory. TWiki has some built-in protection which renames files with dangerous filenames by appending .txt to the filename. But this is a secondary security measure. The essential action that you must take is to turn off any possible execution of any of the attached files.
Most Linux distributions have a default Apache installation which has PHP and server side include (SSI) enabled.
- Make sure that you deny access to all other twiki directories than the
bin
and pub
directories. When you have access to the Apache config files the twiki_httpd_conf.txt
file mentioned above also contains protection of these directories.
For those that do not have access to the Apache config files a sample subdir-htaccess.txt
file can be copied as .htaccess
to the data, lib, locale, templates, tools and working directories.
The
TWiki:TWiki.ApacheConfigGenerator as well as the example
twiki_httpd_conf.txt
and example
htaccess.txt
files include the needed settings that protect against all 3 security elements.
Next Steps
Once you have TWiki installed and running, you might consider the following optional steps for setting up and customizing your TWiki site. Many of the references below refer to topics within your TWiki installation. For example,
TWiki.TWikiSkins
refers to the
TWikiSkins
topic in your TWiki web. Easy way to jump directly to view the pages is to open your own TWiki in your browser and write
TWiki.TWikiSkins
in the Jump test box to the right in the top bar and hit Enter. You can find these topics in the on-line reference copy at the official TWiki website:
TWiki Release 4.2
Enable Authentication of Users
This step provides for site access control and user activity tracking on your TWiki site.
This is particularly important for sites that are publicly accessible on the web. This guide describes only the most common of several possible authentication setups for TWiki and is suitable for public web sites. For information about other setups, see
TWiki.TWikiUserAuthentication
, and
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiUserAuthenticationSupplement.
These are the steps for enabling "Template Login" which asks for a username and password in a web page, and processes them using the Apache 'htpasswd' password manager. Users can log in and log out.
- Under the
Security Settings
pane of configure
:
- Select
TWiki::Client::TemplateLogin
for {LoginManager}
.
- Select
TWiki::Users::HtPasswdUser
for {PasswordManager}
.
- Save your
configure
settings.
- Register yourself using the
TWiki.TWikiRegistration
topic.
Check that the password manager recognizes the new user. Check that a new line with the username and encrypted password is added to the data/.htpasswd
file. If not, you probably got a path wrong, or the permissions may not allow the webserver user to write to that file.
- Edit a topic (by clicking on the
Edit
link at beginning or end of topic) to check if authentication works.
You are strongly encouraged to read
TWiki.TWikiUserAuthentication
,
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiUserAuthenticationSupplement, and
TWiki:TWiki.SecuringTWikiSite for further information about managing users and security of your TWiki site.
Note! The other
LoginManager
option
TWiki::Client::ApacheLogin
uses a basic Apache type authentication where the browser itself prompts you for username and password. Most will find the TemplateLogin looking nicer. But ApacheLogin is required when you use Apache authentication methods like mod_ldap where all authentication is handled by an Apache module and not by the TWiki perl code. When you use ApacheLogin the apache configuration must be set up to require authentication of the some but not all the scripts in the bin directory. This section in the Apache config (or .htaccess) controls this
<FilesMatch "(attach|edit|manage|rename|save|upload|mail|logon|rest|.*auth).*">
require valid-user
</FilesMatch>
The
TWiki:TWiki.ApacheConfigGenerator includes this section when you choose
ApacheLogin. In the example
twiki_httpd_conf.txt
and
bin/.htaccess.txt
files this section is commented out with #. Uncomment the section when you use
ApacheLogin. It is important that this section is commented out or removed when you use
TemplateLogin.
Define the Administrator User(s)
Administrators have read and write access to any topic in TWiki, irrespectively of TWiki access controls. When you install TWiki one of the first things you will want to do is define yourself as an administrator. You become an administrator simply by adding yourself to the
TWikiAdminGroup
. It is the
WikiName and not the login name you add to the group. Editing the
Main.TWikiAdminGroup
topic requires that you are an administrator. So to add the first administrator you need to login using the internal TWiki admin user login and the password you defined in configure.
- Navigate to the
Main.TWikiAdminGroup
topic
- Follow carefully the steps
Main.TWikiAdminGroup
of how to become an admin
- Note that if you use ApacheLogin you have to be registered and logged in before you use the internal admin login
Set TWiki Preferences
Preferences for customizing many aspects of TWiki are set simply by editing a special topic with TWiki.
-
TWiki.TWikiPreferences
. Read through it and identify any additional settings or changes you think you might need. You can edit the settings in TWiki.TWikiPreferences
but these will be overwritten when you later upgrade to a newer TWiki version. Instead copy any settings or variables that you want to customize from TWiki.TWikiPreferences
and paste them into Main.TWikiPreferences
. When you later upgrade TWiki simply avoid overwriting the data/Main/TWikiPreferences.txt
file and all your settings will be kept. Settings in Main.TWikiPreferences
overrides settings in both TWiki.TWikiPreferences
and any settings defined in Plugin topics. See notes at top of TWiki.TWikiPreferences
for more information.
Enable Email Notification
Each TWiki web has an automatic email notification service that sends you an email with links to all of the topics modified since the last alert. To enable this service:
- Confirm the Mail and Proxies settings in the Configure interface.
- Setup a cron job (or equivalent) to call the
tools/mailnotify
script as described in the TWiki.MailerContrib
topic.
Enable WebStatistics
You can generate a listing manually, or on an automated schedule, of visits to individual pages, on a per web basis. For information on setting up this feature, see the
TWiki.TWikiSiteTools
topic.
Automate removal of expired sessions and lease files
Per default TWiki cleans out expired session and lease files each time any topic is viewed. This however cost performance. It is an advantage to define a negative value in
configure
for {Sessions}{ExpireAfter} and install let cron run the
tools/tick_twiki.pl
script. Read The topic
TWikiScripts#tick_twiki_pl
for details how to do this.
Enable Localisation
TWiki now supports displaying of national (non-ascii) characters and presentation of basic interface elements in different languages. To enable these features, see the
Localisation
section of
configure
. For more information about these features, see
TWiki:TWiki.InternationalizationSupplement.
Tailor New Users Home Topic
When a new users registers on your TWiki, a home topic is created for them based on the
TWiki.NewUserTemplate
topic (and its
TWiki.UserForm
). It contains additional resources you can use to:
- Localise the user topic.
- Add a default ALLOWTOPICCHANGE so only the user can edit their own home topic. We do not encourage this for Intranet sites as it sends a wrong signal to new users, but it can be necessary on a public TWiki to prevent spam.
- Add and remove fields defined in the
TWiki.UserForm
If you choose to tailor anything you are strongly adviced to copy
NewUserTemplate
and
UserForm
to the Main web and tailor the Main web copies. TWiki will look for the
NewUserTemplate
in the Main web first and if it does not exist it uses the default from the TWiki web. By creating a
Main.NewUserTemplate
and its
Main.UserForm
you will not loose your tailorings next time you upgrade TWiki.
If you added or removed fields from the user form you may also need to tailor
TWiki.TWikiRegistration
.
Install Plugins
TWiki:Plugins is an extensive library of Plugins for TWiki, that enhance functionality in a huge number of ways. A few plugins are pre-installed in the TWiki distribution. For more information on these, see
TWiki.InstalledPlugins
.
You activate installed plugin in the
Plugins section of
configure
. In this section you also find a
Find More Extensions button which opens an application which can install additional plugins from the TWiki.org website. If you are behind a firewall or your server has no access to the Internet it is also possible to install plugins manually. Manual installation instructions for the plugins can be found in the plugin topics on TWiki.org. Additional documenation on TWiki plugins can be found at
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiPluginsSupplement.
Some plugins require that you define their settings in
configure
. You fill find these under the
Extensions section of configure.
Customize Your TWiki!
The real power of TWiki lies in it's flexibility to be customized to meet your needs. You can with small means change the looks of the default skin (called PatternSkin) by reading the
TWiki.PatternSkinCustomization
At the official TWiki website you can find more resources. A good place to start for exploring what's possible is
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiAdminCookBook which offers tips and tricks for customizing your TWiki site. Many of these are appropriate to implement immediately after installing TWiki and before adding content so now's a good time to look at these.
Customization of Special Pages
Some pages are meant to be customized after choice of authentication. If you do not use the internal TWiki password manager the topics that contains the features for changing and resetting passwords and changing the email address should be changed to a note describing how to perform these tasks in your organization. The topics are:
-
TWiki.ChangePassword
-
TWiki.ResetPassword
-
TWiki.ChangeEmailAddress
WYSIWYG vs Raw Edit
From TWiki release 4.2.0 the WYSIWYG editor has been replaced by a much better and more powerful editor and it was decided that WYSIWYG would be the default edit mode. An Edit Raw link is available for those that have a need or preference for this mode.
However you may prefer to have the same user interface as in TWiki 4.1 where
Edit was the raw text editor and you had a WYSIWYG button. You can modify the templates that define the buttons by following the description on
TWiki:Codev.TWikiRawEditDefault04x02.
Copyright, License and Classification Statements
In the bottom of each topic you will find a default copyright messages saying "Copyright &© by the contributing authors. All material on this collaboration platform is the property of the contributing authors." It is a setting WEBCOPYRIGHT that defines this. This is often not adequate.
- If your TWiki is used in a commercial application without public access you should replace this by your normal copyright notice. You should also consider adding classifications (e.g. For Internal Use Only) so people do not have to add this manually to every new topic.
- If your TWiki is public with public access you need to decide which copyright and license the contributions should be covered by. For open source type applications licenses such as the GNU Free Documentation License, FreeBSD Documentation License, and Creative Commons license are possible licenses to consider. Remember that once people have started contributing it is difficult and not correct to change or impose licenses on existing contributions.
You change the copy right statement globally by taking these steps.
- Copy the setting WEBCOPYRIGHT from
TWiki.TWikiPreferences
to Main.TWikiPreferences
and alter the copied text to your need.
- You can create a unique message for each web by adding the WEBCOPYRIGHT setting to
WebPreferences
in each web. E.g. adding a confidencial classification to a very restricted web.
- The WEBCOPYRIGHT in
TWiki.WebPreferences
covers the documentation that comes with TWiki and is covered by the original TWiki Copyright and GPL License. You will normally leave this unchanged.
Troubleshooting
The first step is to re-run the
configure
script and make sure you have resolved all errors, and are satisfied that you understand any warnings.
Failing that, please check
TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki on TWiki.org, the supplemental documentation that help you
install TWiki on different platforms, environments and web hosting sites. For example:
It is also advisable to review
TWiki:Codev.KnownIssuesOfTWiki04x02.
If you need help, ask a question in the
TWiki:Support web or on
TWiki:Codev/TWikiIRC (irc.freenode.net, channel #twiki)
Appendices
TWiki System Requirements
Low client and server base requirements are core features that keep TWiki widely deployable, particularly across a range of browser platforms and versions.
Server Requirements
TWiki is written in Perl 5, uses a number of shell commands, and requires
RCS (Revision Control System), a GNU Free Software package. TWiki is developed in a basic Linux/Apache environment. It also works with Microsoft Windows, and should have no problem on any other platform that meets the requirements.
Resource |
Required Server Environment |
Perl |
5.8.4 or higher is recommended. TWiki will run in perl 5.6.1 but only with Wysiwyg editor disabled. Wysiwyg requires unicode support which is provided by perl 5.8.1 and forward. |
RCS |
5.7 or higher (including GNU diff ) Optional, TWiki includes a pure perl implementation of RCS that can be used instead (although it's slower) |
GNU diff |
GNU diff 2.7 or higher is required when not using the all-Perl RcsLite? . Install on PATH if not included with RCS (check version with diff -v ) Must be the version used by RCS, to avoid problems with binary attachments - RCS may have hard-coded path to diff |
Other external programs |
fgrep, egrep |
Cron/scheduler |
• Unix: cron • Windows: cron equivalents |
Web server |
Apache is well supported; for information on other servers, see TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki#OtherWebServers. |
Required CPAN Modules
Most of the CPAN libraries listesd below are part of a standard Perl installation so you most likely have them all!
See
TWiki:TWiki.HowToInstallCpanModules for detailed information on how to install CPAN libraries
The following Perl
CPAN modules are used by TWiki:
Module |
Preferred version |
Algorithm::Diff (included) |
|
CGI |
Versions 2.89 and 3.37 must be avoided. Most version from 3.15 and onwards should work. |
CGI::Carp |
>=1.26 |
Config |
>=0 |
Cwd |
>=3.05 |
Data::Dumper |
>=2.121 |
Error (included) |
|
File::Copy |
>=2.06 |
File::Find |
>=1.05 |
File::Spec |
>=3.05 |
FileHandle |
>=2.01 |
IO::File |
>=1.10 |
Text::Diff (included) |
|
Time::Local |
>=1.11 |
Optional CPAN Modules
The following Perl modules may be used by TWiki:
See
TWiki:TWiki.HowToInstallCpanModules for detailed information on how to install CPAN libraries
Module |
Preferred version |
Description |
Archive::Tar |
|
May be required by the Extensions Installer in configure if command line tar or unzip is not available |
CGI::Cookie |
>=1.24 |
Used for session support |
CGI::Session |
>=3.95 |
Highly recommended! Used for session support |
Digest::base |
|
|
Digest::SHA1 |
|
|
Jcode |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Locale::Maketext::Lexicon |
>=0 |
Used for I18N support |
Net::SMTP |
>=2.29 |
Used for sending mail |
Unicode::Map |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Unicode::Map8 |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Unicode::MapUTF8 |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
Unicode::String |
|
Used for I18N support with perl 5.6 |
URI |
|
Used for configure |
Most of them will probably already be available in your installation. You can check version numbers with the
configure
script, or if you're still trying to get to that point, check from the command line like this:
perl -e 'use FileHandle; print $FileHandle::VERSION."\n"'
Client Requirements
The TWiki standard installation has relatively low browser requirements:
- HTML 3.2 compliant
- Cookies, if persistent sessions are required
CSS and Javascript are used in most skins, although there is a low-fat skin (Classic skin) available that minimises these requirements. Some skins will require more recent releases of browsers. The default skin (Pattern) is tested on IE 6, Safari, and Mozilla 5.0 based browsers (such as Firefox).
You can easily select a balance of browser capability versus look and feel. Try the installed skins at
TWiki/TWikiSkinBrowser
and more at
TWiki:Plugins.SkinPackage.
Important note about TWiki Plugins
- Plugins can require just about anything - browser-specific functions, stylesheets (CSS), Java applets, cookies, specific Perl modules,... - check the individual Plugin specs.
- Note: Plugins included in the TWiki distribution do not add requirements, except for the CommentPlugin which requires Perl 5.6.1.
Notes on Installing TWiki on Non-Root Account
The following supplemental notes to the
Basic Installation instructions apply to installing TWiki on a system where you don't have Unix/Linux root (administrator) privileges, for example, on a hosted Web account or an intranet server administered by someone else.
Referring to the
Basic Installation steps presented above:
- Step 2: If you cannot unpack the TWiki distribution directly in your installation directory, you can unpack the distribution on your local PC and then manually create the directory structure on your host server and upload the files as follows:
- Using the table below, create a directory structure on your host server
- Upload the TWiki files by FTP (transfer as text except for the image files in
pub
directory.)
- Note: Don't worry if you are not able to put the twiki/lib directory at the same level as the
twiki/bin
directory (e.g. because CGI bin directories can't be under your home directory and you don't have root access). You can create this directory elsewhere and configure the twiki/bin/setlib.cfg
file (done in Step 2).
TWiki dir: |
What it is: |
Where to copy: |
Example: |
twiki |
start-up pages |
root TWiki dir |
/home/smith/twiki/ |
twiki/bin |
CGI bin |
CGI-enabled dir |
/home/smith/twiki/bin |
twiki/lib |
library files |
same level as twiki/bin |
/home/smith/twiki/lib |
twiki/locale |
language files |
dir secure from public access |
/home/smith/twiki/locale |
twiki/pub |
public files |
htdoc enabled dir |
/home/smith/twiki/pub |
twiki/data |
topic data |
dir secure from public access |
/home/smith/twiki/data |
twiki/templates |
web templates |
dir secure from public access |
/home/smith/twiki/templates |
twiki/tools |
TWiki utlilities |
dir secure from public access |
/home/smith/twiki/tools |
twiki/working |
Temporary and internal files |
dir secure from public access |
/home/smith/twiki/working |
- Step 3: Files in the pub directory must be readable as a url. This means that directory permissions should be set to
755
(or 775
) and file permissions should be set to 644
(or 664
). If you can run a chmod
command, you can accomplish this in two quick steps by running these commands from the root direct:
-
chmod -R 755 pub
-
chmod 644 `find pub -type f -print`
- In addition, you should create a
.htaccess
file in the pub directory, using the template included in the root level of the distribution entitled pub-htaccess.txt
.
- Note: This setup does not provide for absolute security for TWiki attachments. For more information, see TWiki:Codev.SecuringYourTWiki.
- Step 6: In order to run the configure script, create a file called
.htaccess
in the bin directory that includes the following single line: SetHandler cgi-script
. This informs the server to treat all the perl scripts in the bin directory as scripts.
For additional information about installing TWiki on a hosted accounts, see
TWiki:TWiki.InstallingTWiki#WebHostingSites
Installing Manually Without Configure
It is highly recommended to use run configure from the browser when setting up TWiki. Configure does a lot of the hard work for you.
But there may be instances where you do not want to use configure or where configure simply won't run because of a missing dependency.
The manual steps you have to take are:
- Copy the file
lib/TWiki.spec
to lib/LocalSite.cfg
- Remove the comment # in front of
$TWiki::cfg{DefaultUrlHost}
, $TWiki::cfg{ScriptUrlPath}
, $TWiki::cfg{PubUrlPath}
, $TWiki::cfg{PubDir}
, $TWiki::cfg{TemplateDir}
, $TWiki::cfg{DataDir}
, $TWiki::cfg{LocalesDir}
, and $TWiki::cfg{OS}
and make sure these settings have the correct values.
- Make sure to define at least these settings:
$TWiki::cfg{LoginManager}
, $TWiki::cfg{WebMasterEmail}
, $TWiki::cfg{SMTP}{MAILHOST}
, $TWiki::cfg{SMTP}{SENDERHOST}
.
Back to top
TWiki Upgrade Guide
This guide covers upgrading from a previous version of TWiki (such as Cairo or TWiki4.0) to TWiki 4.2
Overview
TWiki-4.0.0 was a major new release. TWiki-4.1.0 was a minor release without dramatic changes since 4.0.0. TWiki-4.2.0 is also a minor release containing a few new features that can be seen by the end user, a large number of bug fixes, and a face lift for the skin. It also contains some important updates under the hood to the way users are handled which enables new types of authentication and integration with other systems. The most important new feature is the
QuerySearch feature.
Upgrade Requirements
- Please review the AdminSkillsAssumptions before you upgrade TWiki
- Review TWiki:TWiki.TWikiUpgradeTo04x02 for latest information and experience notes.
- To upgrade from a release prior to TWiki Release 01-Sep-2004, start with TWiki:TWiki.UpgradingTWiki on TWiki.org
- To upgrade from a standard TWiki Release 01-Sep-2004 to the latest TWiki-4.X Production Release, follow the instructions below
- Once the upgrade has been applied, an existing earlier installation will still be able to read all the topics, but should not be used to write. Make sure you take a backup!
- Not all Plugins written for TWiki Release 01-Sep-2004 are fully supported with 4.X. Make sure the Plugins you use can be upgraded as well!
Major Changes Compared to TWiki Release 01-Sep-2004 and TWiki Release 4.0.0
See
TWikiReleaseNotes04x00,
TWikiReleaseNotes04x01 and
TWikiReleaseNotes04x02
Upgrade Procedure
The following steps are a rough guide to upgrading only. It is impossible to give detailed instructions, as what you have to do may depend on whether you can configure the webserver or not, and how much you have changed distributed files in your current TWiki release.
The main steps are:
- Install the new TWiki version, configure it, and get it to work similar to the old version
- Install additional extensions (Plugins). Make sure to use the latest versions
- Copy all the non-default webs from the old installation to the new
- Copy the users from old installation to the new incl all their topics from Main
- Apply tailorings to your Skin (logos, menu bars etc)
- Apply preferences from old installation
Installation
- Follow the installation instructions in INSTALL.html which you find in the root of the new installation. Install the new release in a new directory. Do not install on top of the old release.
- Use the configure script to configure TWiki.
- If you are upgrading from a 4.x.x release, you can carry over the configure settings from the old release.
- You need to run configure and save the configuration once when you upgrade as this will update the altered and added settings.
- You can also choose to start with a fresh configuration and walk through all the settings using your old LocalSite.cfg as a reference. This way you will not have old obsolete settings in the new LocalSite.cfg.
- If at any time during the installation you want to start over from fresh all you need to do is delete the
lib/LocalSite.cfg
file and re-run configure.
- Additional resources
- Make sure you have a working basic TWiki before you continue
Install Extensions
- Note that not all extensions that worked in Cairo have been updated to work with TWiki4.X. Many Cairo plugins work fine. Some do not. Many plugins have been upgraded to work with TWiki4.0 and later.
- From TWiki-4.1.0 the configure script which you ran during installation supports installation of additional plugins.
- Manual installation is possible. Follow the instruction on the Plugin page at twiki.org.
- Check the plugin topics from your old TWiki installation. There may be plugin settings that you want to transfer to the new TWiki installation.
Hint: For an easier upgrade later on, set the plugin preferences settings in the Main.TWikiPreferences topic, not in the plugin topic. To identify the plugin, prefix the name of the setting with the capitalized name of the plugin. For example, to change the DEFAULT_TYPE
setting of the CommentPlugin, create a COMMENTPLUGIN_DEFAULT_TYPE
setting in Main.TWikiPreferences.
- Typical plugin settings you may have altered.
- CommentPlugin - Set DEFAULT_TYPE
- EditTablePlugin - Set CHANGEROWS, Set QUIETSAVE, and Set EDITBUTTON
- InterwikiPlugin - Set RULESTOPIC
- InterWikis - If you added your own rules you should save this topic and not overwrite it.
- SlideShowPlugin - Make sure you did not change the embedded 'Default Slide Template' If you did you should save it. It is a bad idea to do. It is better to define your own slide show templates as separate topics that do not get overwritten when you upgrade.
- SmiliesPlugin - Did you add your own smileys? No real changes were made to the smilies topic October 2005 so you can just leave this topic as it is.
- TablePlugin - Set TABLEATTRIBUTES
- Remember that a plugin must be activated in configure.
- To avoid having to re-apply plugin settings each time you upgrade a plugin or TWiki itself, define the altered plugin settings in
Main.TWikiPreferences
instead
Copy your old webs to new TWiki
- When upgrading from Cairo or earlier it may be necessary to unlock the rcs files in data and pub directories from the old installation using the following shell commands:
-
find data -name '*,v' -exec rcs -u -M '{}' \;
-
find pub -name '*,v' -exec rcs -u -M '{}' \;
- Copy your local webs over to the data and pub directories of the new install. Do not copy the default webs: TWiki, Main, Trash, Sandbox, _default, and _empty.
- Make sure all data and pub files and directories are owned by the webserver user.
- Note: TWiki's WebChanges topics depend on the file timestamp. If you touch the .txt files make sure to preserve the timestamp, or to change them in the sequence of old file timestamps.
Copy Users And Their Topics From Main Web
- Copy all the topics from the Main web and corresponding pub/Main directories from the old TWiki to the new TWiki but do not overwrite any of the new topics already inside the new Main directory!
- Manually merge all the users from the old
Main.TWikiUsers
topic to the new TWiki. If you upgrade from Cairo you can simply use the old file and add the missing new system users to the list of users. If you upgrade from TWiki-4.0.X simply use the old topic. Starting from 4.2.0 TWiki no longer ships with a Main.TWikiUsers
topic. When you register the first user TWiki now checks for an existing Main.TWikiUsers
and if it does not exist it gets created.
- If you use
data/.htpasswd
for authentication copy this file from the old TWiki to the new.
- If you upgrade from Cairo and you are using the Htpasswd login manager, then note that email addresses for users have moved out of user topics and into the password file. There is a script that performs this extra upgrade step for you - see
tools/upgrade_emails.pl
.
- The old sandbox web may have a lot of useful topic and users may use it actively for drafts. Manually select the topics (remember the corresponding pub directories) from the old Sandbox web and copy them to the new TWiki. Decide if you want to overwrite the sandbox homepage and left menu bar or keep the new.
- If you added or removed fields from the user topic form you may also have tailored
TWiki.TWikiRegistration
. Make sure you either reuse the registration topic from the old installation or apply the same field changes to the new TWiki.TWikiRegistration
topic.
- Starting from 4.2.0 TWiki ships with
NewUserTemplate
and UserForm
in the TWiki web. If you choose to tailor anything you are strongly adviced to copy NewUserTemplate
and UserForm
to the Main web and tailor the Main web copies. TWiki will look for the NewUserTemplate
in the Main web first and if it does not exist it uses the default from the TWiki web. By creating a Main.NewUserTemplate
and its Main.UserForm
you will not loose your tailorings next time you upgrade TWiki.
- Make sure all data and pub files and directories are owned by the webserver user.
Apply Customizations To The Skin
- Not many of the old Cairo skins work well with TWiki4.X.
- Add Logos, update top bar and left bar as required.
- Apply any desired changes to style sheets and templates. The default PatternSkin has been totally rewritten since Cairo and once more in 4.0.2. Since then changes to PatternSkin have been minor and you may be able to carry over most simpler tailorings directly from 4.0.2-4.0.5.
- Additional resources:
Apply Preferences From Old Installation
- Transfer any customized and local settings from TWiki.TWikiPreferences to the topic pointed at by {LocalSitePreferences} (Main.TWikiPreferences). Per default this is
Main.TWikiPreferences
. This avoids having to write over files in the distribution on a later upgrade.
- If you changed any of the topics in the original TWiki distribution, you will have to transfer your changes to the new install manually. There is no simple way to do this, though a suggestion is to use 'diff' to find changed files in the
data/TWiki
of the old and new TWiki installation, and transfer the changes into the new TWiki install. If you can run a GUI on your server, you may find that using a visual diff tool like WinMerge, meld, kdiff3, xxdiff, etc. is helpful.
- Compare the
WebPreferences
topics in the old TWiki Installation with the default from the new TWiki installation and add any new Preferences that may be relevant.
- Compare the
WebLeftBar
topics in the old TWiki Installation with the default from the new TWiki installation and add any new feature that you desire.
Customization of Special Pages
Some pages in the TWiki web are meant to be customized after choice of authentication. If you do not use the internal TWiki password manager the topics that contains the features for changing and resetting passwords and changing the email address should be changed to a note describing how to perform these tasks in your organization. If you have made such customizations remember to replace these topics in the TWiki web with the tailored versions from your old installation. The topics are:
-
TWiki.ChangePassword
-
TWiki.ResetPassword
-
TWiki.ChangeEmailAddress
Upgrading from Cairo to TWiki4 (additional advice)
Favicon
TWiki4's
PatternSkin introduces the use of the favicon feature which most browsers use to show a small icon in front of the URL and for bookmarks.
In TWiki4 it is assumed that each web has a favicon.ico file attached to the WebPreferences topic. When you upgrade from Cairo to TWiki4 you do not have this file and you will get flooded with errors the error log of your web server. There are two solutions to this.
- Attach a favicon.ico file to WebPreferences in each web.
- Preferred: Change the setting of the location of favicon.ico in TWikiPreferences so all webs use the favicon.ico from the TWiki web. This is the fastest and easiest solution.
To change the location of favicon.ico in TWikiPreferences to the TWiki web add this line to
TWikiPreferences
* Set FAVICON = %PUBURLPATH%/%SYSTEMWEB%/%WEBPREFSTOPIC%/favicon.ico
TWikiUsers topic in Main web
Your Cairo
Main.TWikiUsers topic will work in TWiki4 but you will need to ensure that these 4 users from the default TWiki4 version of TWikiUsers are copied to the existing TWikiUsers topic. TWikiGuest is probably already there but the others are new
- TWikiContributor - placeholder for a TWiki developer, and is used in TWiki documentation
- TWikiGuest - guest user, used as a fallback if the user can't be identified
- TWikiRegistrationAgent - special user used during the new user registration process
- UnknownUser - used where the author of a previously stored piece of data can't be determined
You additionally need to ensure that TWikiUsers has the
Set ALLOWTOPICCHANGE = TWikiAdminGroup, TWikiRegistrationAgent
. Otherwise people will not be able to register.
Important Changes since 4.0.5
Supported Perl version
TWiki 4.0.5 worked on Perl version 5.6.X. Reports from users has shown that unfortunately TWiki 4.1.0 does not support Perl versions older then 5.8.0. It is the goal that TWiki should work on at least Perl version 5.6.X but none of the developers have had access to Perl installations older than 5.8.0.
Since TWiki 4.1.0 has some urgent bugs the development team decided to release TWiki 4.1.1 without resolving the issue with Perl 5.6.X. We will however address this and try and resolve it for a planned 4.1.2 release. The TWiki community is very interested in contributions from users that have fixes for the code which will enable TWiki to run on older versions of Perl.
See the
WhatVersionsOfPerlAreSupported topic to keep up to date with the discussion how to get back support for earlier Perl versions.
Template spec changed
Until TWiki 4.0.5
TWikiTemplates the text inside template definition blocks (anything between %TMPL:DEF{"block"}% and %TMPL:END% was stripped of leading and trailing white space incl new lines.
This caused a lot of problems for skin developers when you wanted a newline before or after the block text.
From TWiki 4.1.0 this has changed so that white space is no longer stripped. Skins like PatternSkin and NatSkin have been updated so that they work with the new behavior. But if you use an older skin or have written your own you will most likely need to make some adjustments.
It is not difficult. The general rule is - if you get mysterious blank lines in your skin, the newline after the %TMPL:DEF{"block"}% needs to be removed. Ie. the content of the block must follow on the same line as the TMPL:DEF.
The spec change have the same impact on
CommentPlugin templates where you may have to remove the first line break after the TMPL:DEF. See the
CommentPluginTemplate for examples of how comment template definitions should look like in TWiki-4.1.X
An example: A CommentPlugin template that adds a comment as appending a row to a table. Before the spec change this would work.
<verbatim>
%TMPL:DEF{OUTPUT:tabletest}%%POS:BEFORE%
|%URLPARAM{"comment"}%| -- %WIKIUSERNAME% - %DATE% |
%TMPL:END%
</verbatim>
From Twiki 4.1.0 the old template definition will add an empty line before the new table row. To fix it simply remove the new line before the table.
<verbatim>
%TMPL:DEF{OUTPUT:tabletest}%%POS:BEFORE%|%URLPARAM{"comment"}%| -- %WIKIUSERNAME% - %DATE% |
%TMPL:END%
</verbatim>
The advantage of the spec change is that now you can add leading and trailing white space including new lines. This was not possible before.
Important Changes since 4.1.0
New location for session and other temporary files
An upgrader upgrading to 4.1.1 should note the following important change
The directory for passthrough files and session files have been replaced by a common directory for temporary files used by TWiki. Previously the two configure settings
{PassthroughDir}
and
{Sessions}{Dir}
were by default set to
/tmp
. These config settings have been replaced by
{TempfileDir}
with the default setting value
/tmp/twiki
. If the
twiki
directory does not exist twiki will create it first time it needs it.
It is highly recommended no longer to use the tmp directory common to other web applications and the new default will work fine for most. You may want to delete all the old session files in /tmp after the upgrade to 4.1.1. They all start with cgisess_. It is additionally highly recommended to limit write access to the
{TempfileDir}
for security reasons if you have non-admin users with login access to the webserver just like you would do with the other webserver directories.
Important Changes since 4.1.2
New WYSIWYG Editor
TWiki now ships with a new WYSIWYG editor based on TinyMCE replaces the Kupu based editor.
TinyMCE is not a perfect Wysiwyg editor but it is magnitudes better than the Kupu editor
The WysiwygPlugin that drives the engine behind both TinyMCE has additionally been heavily improved so that less TWiki Applications are negatively affected by editing WYSIWYG
When TinyMCEPlugin is enabled the Edit button per default becomes WYSIWYG editing mode. A new Raw Edit link has been added to enable application developers to edit the good old way
The WYSIWYG button has been removed.
NEWTOPICLINKSYMBOL removed
The NEWTOPICLINKSYMBOL preference which was deprecated in 4.1 has now been removed from the code. If you want to control the appearance of new links, you can use NEWLINKFORMAT.
UserForm and NewUserTemplate Customization
When a new user registers on TWiki his user topic is created based on the
NewUserTemplate
and
UserForm
.
The
NewUserTemplate
was located in the TWiki web and the
UserForm
in the Main web. When upgrading TWiki these were some of the topics you had to take care not to overwrite.
From 4.2.0 the
UserForm
and
NewUserTemplate
are distributed in the TWiki web. If you create the two in the Main web the Main web version will be used instead. So if you tailor the user topic format or the form then you should always copy the two files to the Main web and modify the ones in the Main web. When you later upgrade TWiki your tailored template and form will not be overwritten.
TWikiUsers no longer distributed
The
Main.TWikiUsers
topic contains all the registered users. It is a topic you do not want to overwrite when you upgrade TWiki.
From 4.2.0 this file is no longer included in the TWiki distribution. When you register the first time TWiki creates the
Main.TWikiUsers
topic in the Main web if it does not exist already. This means that you can now upgrade TWiki without risk of overwriting the important
TWikiUsers
topic.
- For new installers this makes no difference at all
- For upgraders this is one less problem to worry about as your important Main.TWikiUsers topic now no longer gets overwritten when upgrading.
New working
directory
A new directory
working
which per default is located in the twiki root, has been introduced which contains:
- registration_approvals - with 4.2.0 it is moved to here from the data directory)
- tmp - so we now avoid having to fight with special access rights and /tmp directory that gets cleaned out when booting.
- work_areas - with 4.2.0 it is moved to here from the pub directory. Configure automatically moved the directory when you upgrade.
Note: Remember to restrict access to this new directory when you upgrade.
The configuration setting
{WorkingDir}
defines the container directory for temporary files, extensions' work areas, and intermediate registration data. The default is
working
under your installation root.
Take care for that change if you run your own routine to delete obsolete session files, which will now be found under
working/tmp/cgisess*
.
New Internal Admin Login
TWiki 4.2 introduces a new
Internal Admin Login feature which uses "admin" (configurable) as username and the password used for configure to become temporary administrator. When you do a new installation you need to use this feature as Main.TWikiAdminGroup is now access restricted by default to avoid security attacks during the hours an installation may take. From configure there is a link to the TWikiAdminGroup topic and on TWikiAdminGroup the step by step instructions are written in a yellow box. Our advice is not to remove this help text in case you need it later.
Back to top
TWiki User Authentication
TWiki site access control and user activity tracking options
Overview
Authentication, or "login", is the process by which a user lets TWiki know who they are.
Authentication isn't just to do with access control. TWiki uses authentication to identify users, so it can keep track of who made changes, and manage a wide range of personal settings. With authentication enabled, users can personalise TWiki and contribute as recognised individuals, instead of shadows.
TWiki authentication is very flexible, and can either stand alone or integrate with existing authentication schemes. You can set up TWiki to require authentication for every access, or only for changes. Authentication is also essential for access control.
Quick Authentication Test - Use the %USERINFO% variable to return your current identity:
TWiki user authentication is split into four sections; password management, user mapping, user registration, and login management. Password management deals with how users personal data is stored. Registration deals with how new users are added to the wiki. Login management deals with how users log in.
Once a user is logged on, they can be remembered using a
Client Session stored in a cookie in the browser (or by other less elegant means if the user has disabled cookies). This avoids them having to log on again and again.
TWiki user authentication is configured through the Security Settings pane in the
configure interface.
Please note
FileAttachments are not protected by TWiki User Authentication.
Tip: TWiki:TWiki.TWikiUserAuthenticationSupplement on TWiki.org has supplemental documentation on user authentication.
Password Management
As shipped, TWiki supports the Apache 'htpasswd' password manager. This manager supports the use of
.htpasswd
files on the server. These files can be unique to TWiki, or can be shared with other applications (such as an Apache webserver). A variety of password encodings are supported for flexibility when re-using existing files. See the descriptive comments in the Security Settings section of the [[/bin/configure][configure] interface for more details.
You can easily plug in alternate password management modules to support interfaces to other third-party authentication databases.
User Mapping
Often when you are using an external authentication method, you want to map from an unfriendly "login name" to a more friendly
WikiName. Also, an external authentication database may well have user information you want to import to TWiki, such as user groups.
By default, TWiki supports mapping of usernames to wikinames, and supports TWiki groups internal to TWiki. If you want, you can plug in an alternate user mapping module to support import of groups etc.
User Registration
New user registration uses the password manager to set and change passwords and store email addresses. It is also responsible for the new user verification process. the registration process supports
single user registration via the
TWikiRegistration page, and
bulk user registration via the
BulkRegistration page (for admins only).
The registration process is also responsible for creating user topics, and setting up the mapping information used by the User Mapping support.
Login Management
Login management controls the way users have to log in. There are three basic options; no login, login via a TWiki login page, and login using the webserver authentication support.
No Login (select none
in configure)
Does exactly what it says on the tin. Forget about authentication to make your site completely public - anyone can browse and edit freely, in classic Wiki style. All visitors are given the
TWikiGuest default identity, so you can't track individual user activity.
Note: This setup is
not recommended on public websites for security reasons; anyone would be able to change system settings and perform tasks usually restricted to administrators.
Template Login (select TWiki::Client::TemplateLogin
in configure)
Template Login asks for a username and password in a web page, and processes them using whatever Password Manager you choose. Users can log in and log out. Client Sessions are used to remember users. Users can choose to have their session remembered so they will automatically be logged in the next time they start their browser.
Enabling Template Login
- Use the configure interface to
- select the
TWiki::Client::TemplateLogin
login manager (on the Security Settings pane).
- select the appropriate password manager for your system, or provide your own.
- there is also an EXPERT configure setting
{TemplateLogin}{PreventBrowserRememberingPassword}
that you can set to prevent Browsers from remembering username and passwords if you are concerned about public terminal usage.
- Register yourself in the TWikiRegistration topic.
Check that the password manager recognises the new user. If you are using .htpasswd
files, check that a new line with the username and encrypted password is added to the .htpasswd
file. If not, you probably got a path wrong, or the permissions may not allow the webserver user to write to that file.
- Create a new topic to check if authentication works.
- Edit the TWikiAdminGroup topic in the Main web to include users with system administrator status.
This is a very important step, as users in this group can access all topics, independent of TWiki access controls.
TWikiAccessControl has more information on setting up access controls.
At this time
TWikiAccessControls cannot control access to files in the
pub
area, unless they are only accessed through the
viewfile
script. If your
pub
directory is set up in the webserver to allow open access you may want to add
.htaccess
files in there to restrict access.
You can create a custom version of the
TWikiRegistration form by copying the topic, and then deleting or adding input tags in your copy. The
name=""
parameter of the input tags must start with:
"Twk0..."
(if this is an optional entry), or
"Twk1..."
(if this is a required entry). This ensures that the fields are carried over into the user home page correctly. Do
not modify the version of
TWikiRegistration shipped with TWiki, as your changes will be overwritten next time you upgrade.
The default new user template page is in
TWiki.NewUserTemplate. The same variables get expanded as in the
template topics. You can create a custom new user home page by creating the
Main.NewUserTemplate? topic, which will then override the default.
Apache Login (select TWiki::Client::ApacheLogin
in configure)
Using this method TWiki does not authenticate users internally. Instead it depends on the
REMOTE_USER
environment variable, which is set when you enable authentication in the webserver.
The advantage of this scheme is that if you have an existing website authentication scheme using Apache modules such as
mod_auth_ldap
or
mod_auth_mysql
you can just plug in directly to them.
The disadvantage is that because the user identity is cached in the browser, you can log in, but you can't log out again unless you restart the browser.
TWiki maps the
REMOTE_USER
that was used to log in to the webserver to a
WikiName using the table in
TWikiUsers. This table is updated whenever a user registers, so users can choose not to register (in which case their webserver login name is used for their signature) or register (in which case that login name is mapped to their
WikiName).
The same private
.htpasswd
file used in TWiki Template Login can be used to authenticate Apache users, using the Apache Basic Authentication support.
Warning: Do
not use the Apache
htpasswd
program with
.htpasswd
files generated by TWiki!
htpasswd
wipes out email addresses that TWiki plants in the info fields of this file.
Enabling Apache Login using mod_auth
You can use any other Apache authentication module that sets REMOTE_USER.
- Use configure to select the
TWiki::Client::ApacheLogin
login manager.
- Use configure to set up TWiki to create the right kind of
.htpasswd
entries.
- Create a
.htaccess
file in the twiki/bin
directory.
There is an template for this file in twiki/bin/.htaccess.txt
that you can copy and change. The comments in the file explain what need to be done.
If you got it right, the browser should now ask for login name and password when you click on the Edit. If .htaccess
does not have the desired effect, you may need to "AllowOverride All" for the directory in httpd.conf
(if you have root access; otherwise, e-mail web server support)
At this time TWikiAccessControls do not control access to files in the pub
area, unless they are only accessed through the viewfile
script. If your pub
directory is set up to allow open access you may want to add .htaccess
files in there as well to restrict access
- You can create a custom version of the TWikiRegistration form by copying the default topic, and then deleting or adding input tags in your copy. The
name=""
parameter of the input tags must start with: "Twk0..."
(if this is an optional entry), or "Twk1..."
(if this is a required entry). This ensures that the fields are carried over into the user home page correctly. Do not modify the version of TWikiRegistration shipped with TWiki, as your changes will be overwritten next time you upgrade.
The default new user template page is in TWiki.NewUserTemplate. The same variables get expanded as in the template topics. You can create a custom new user home page by creating the Main.NewUserTemplate? topic, which will then override the default.
- Register yourself in the TWikiRegistration topic.
Check that a new line with the username and encrypted password is added to the .htpasswd
file. If not, you may have got a path wrong, or the permissions may not allow the webserver user to write to that file.
- Create a new topic to check if authentication works.
- Edit the TWikiAdminGroup topic in the Main web to include users with system administrator status.
This is a very important step, as users in this group can access all topics, independent of TWiki access controls.
TWikiAccessControl has more information on setting up access controls.
Logons via bin/logon
Any time a user requests a page that needs authentication, they will be forced to log on. It may be convenient to have a "logon" link as well, to give the system a chance to identify the user and retrieve their personal settings. It may be convenient to force them to log on.
The
bin/logon
script enables this. If you are using Apache Login, the
bin/logon
script must be setup in the
bin/.htaccess
file to be a script which requires a
valid user
. Once authenticated, it will redirect the user to the view URL for the page from which the
logon
script was linked.
Sessions
TWiki uses the
CPAN:CGI::Session and
CPAN:CGI::Cookie modules to track sessions. These modules are de facto standards for session management among Perl programmers. If you can't use Cookies for any reason,
CPAN:CGI::Session also supports session tracking using the client IP address.
You don't
have to enable sessions to support logins in TWiki. However it is
strongly recommended. TWiki needs some way to remember the fact that you logged in from a particular browser, and it uses sessions to do this. If you don;t enable sessions, TWiki will try hard to remember you, but due to limitations in the browsers it may also forget you (and then suddenly remember you again later!). So for the best user experience, you should enable sessions.
There are a number of
TWikiVariables available that you can use to interrogate your current session. You can even add your own session variables to the TWiki cookie. Session variables are referred to as "sticky" variables.
Getting, Setting, and Clearing Session Variables
You can get, set, and clear session variables from within TWiki web pages or by using script parameters. This allows you to use the session as a personal "persistent memory space" that is not lost until the web browser is closed. Also note that if a session variable has the same name as a TWiki preference, the session variables value takes precedence over the TWiki preference.
This allows for per-session preferences.
To make use of these features, use the tags:
%SESSION_VARIABLE{ "varName" }%
%SESSION_VARIABLE{ "varName" set="varValue" }%
%SESSION_VARIABLE{ "varName" clear="" }%
Note that you
cannot override access controls preferences this way.
Cookies and Transparent Session IDs
TWiki normally uses cookies to store session information on a client computer. Cookies are a common way to pass session information from client to server. TWiki cookies simply hold a unique session identifier that is used to look up a database of session information on the TWiki server.
For a number of reasons, it may not be possible to use cookies. In this case, TWiki has a fallback mechanism; it will automatically rewrite every internal URL it sees on pages being generated to one that also passes session information.
TWiki Username vs. Login Username
This section applies only if you are using authentication with existing login names (i.e. mapping from login names to
WikiNames).
TWiki internally manages two usernames: Login Username and TWiki Username.
- Login Username: When you login to the intranet, you use your existing login username, ex:
pthoeny
. This name is normally passed to TWiki by the REMOTE_USER
environment variable, and used internally. Login Usernames are maintained by your system administrator.
- TWiki Username: Your name in WikiNotation, ex:
PeterThoeny
, is recorded when you register using TWikiRegistration; doing so also generates a personal home page in the Main web.
TWiki can automatically map an Intranet (Login) Username to a TWiki Username if the {AllowLoginName} is enabled in
configure. The default is to use your
WikiName as a login name.
NOTE: To correctly enter a WikiName - your own or someone else's - be sure to include the Main web name in front of the Wiki username, followed by a period, and no spaces, for example Main.WikiUsername
or %USERSWEB%.WikiUsername
.
This points WikiUsername
to the Main web, where user home pages are located, no matter which web it's entered in. Without the web prefix, the name appears as a NewTopic? everywhere but in the Main web.
Changing Passwords
If your {PasswordManager} supports password changing, you can change and reset passwords using forms on regular pages.
Changing E-mail Addresses
If the active {PasswordManager} supports storage and retrieval of user e-mail addresses, you can change your e-mail using a regular page. As shipped, this is true only for the Apache 'htpasswd' password manager.
Controlling access to individual scripts
You may want to add or remove scripts from the list of scripts that require authentication. The method for doing this is different for each of Template Login and Apache Login.
- For Template Login, update the {AuthScripts} list using configure
- For Apache Login, add/remove the script from
.htaccess
How to choose an authentication method
One of the key features of TWiki is that it is possible to add HTML to topics. No authentication method is 100% secure on a website where end users can add HTML, as there is always a risk that a malicious user can add code to a topic that gathers user information, such as session IDs. The TWiki developers have been forced to make certain tradeoffs, in the pursuit of efficiency, that may be exploited by a hacker.
This section discusses some of the known risks. You can be sure that any potential hackers have read this section as well!
At one extreme, the most secure method is to use TWiki via SSL (Secure Sockets Layer), with a login manager installed and Client Sessions turned
off.
Using TWiki with sessions turned off is a pain, though, as with all the login managers there are occasions where TWiki will forget who you are. The best user experience is achieved with sessions turned
on.
As soon as you allow the server to maintain information about a logged-in user, you open a door to potential attacks. There are a variety of ways a malicious user can pervert TWiki to obtain another users session ID, the most common of which is known as a
cross-site scripting attack. Once a hacker has an SID they can pretend to be that user.
To help prevent these sorts of attacks, TWiki supports
IP matching, which ensures that the IP address of the user requesting a specific session is the same as the IP address of the user who created the session. This works well as long as IP addresses are unique to each client, and as long as the IP address of the client can't be faked.
Session IDs are usually stored by TWiki in cookies, which are stored in the client browser. Cookies work well, but not all environments or users permit cookies to be stored in browsers. So TWiki also supports two other methods of determining the session ID. The first method uses the client IP address to determine the session ID. The second uses a rewriting method that rewrites local URLs in TWiki pages to include the session ID in the URL.
The first method works well as long as IP addresses are
unique to each individual client, and client IP addresses can't be faked by a hacker. If IP addresses are unique and can't be faked, it is almost as secure as cookies + IP matching, so it ranks as the
fourth most secure method.
If you have to turn IP matching off, and cookies can't be relied on, then you may have to rely on the second method, URL rewriting. This method exposes the session IDs very publicly, so should be regarded as "rather dodgy".
Most TWiki sites don't use SSL, so, as is the case with
most sites that don't use SSL, there is always a possibility that a password could be picked out of the aether. Browsers do not encrypt passwords sent over non-SSL links, so using Apache Login is no more secure than Template Login.
Of the two shipped login managers, Apache Login is probably the most useful. It lets you do this sort of thing:
wget --http-user=RogerRabbit --http-password=i'mnottelling http://www.example.com/bin/save/Sandbox/StuffAUTOINC0?text=hohoho,%20this%20is%20interesting
i.e. pass in a user and password to a request from the command-line. However it doesn't let you log out.
Template Login degrades to url re-writing when you use a client like dillo that does not support cookies. However, you can log out and back in as a different user.
Finally, it would be really neat if someone was to work out how to use certificates to identify users.....
See
TWiki:TWiki.SecuringTWikiSite for more information.
Back to top
TWiki Access Control
Restricting read and write access to topics and webs, by Users and groups
TWiki Access Control allows you restrict access to single topics and entire webs, by individual user and by user Groups. Access control, combined with
TWikiUserAuthentication, lets you easily create and manage an extremely flexible, fine-grained privilege system.
Tip: TWiki:TWiki.TWikiAccessControlSupplement on TWiki.org has additional documentation on access control.
An Important Control Consideration
Open, freeform editing is the essence of
WikiCulture - what makes TWiki different and often more effective than other collaboration tools. For that reason, it is strongly recommended that decisions to restrict read or write access to a web or a topic are made with great care - the more restrictions, the less Wiki in the mix. Experience shows that
unrestricted write access works very well because:
- Peer influence is enough to ensure that only relevant content is posted.
- Peer editing - the ability for anyone to rearrange all content on a page - keeps topics focused.
- In TWiki, content is transparently preserved under revision control:
- Edits can be undone by the administrator (per default a member of TWikiAdminGroup; see #ManagingGroups).
- Users are encouraged to edit and refactor (condense a long topic), since there's a safety net.
As a
collaboration guideline:
- Create broad-based Groups (for more and varied input), and...
- Avoid creating view-only Users (if you can read it, you should be able to contribute to it).
Permissions settings of the webs on this TWiki site
Please Note:
- A blank in the the above table may mean either the corresponding control is absent or commented out or that it has been set to a null value. The two conditions have dramatically different and possibly opposed semantics.
- TWikiGuest is the guest account - used by unauthenticated users.
- The TWiki web must not deny view to TWikiGuest; otherwise, people will not be able to register.
Note: Above table comes from
SitePermissions
Authentication vs. Access Control
Authentication: Identifies who a user is based on a login procedure. See
TWikiUserAuthentication.
Access control: Restrict access to content based on users and groups once a user is identified.
Users and Groups
Access control is based on the familiar concept of Users and Groups. Users are defined by their
WikiNames. They can then be organized in unlimited combinations by inclusion in one or more user Groups. For convenience, Groups can also be included in other Groups.
Managing Users
A user can create an account in
TWikiRegistration. The following actions are performed:
- WikiName and encrypted password are recorded using the password manager if authentication is enabled.
- A confirmation e-mail is sent to the user.
- A user home page with the WikiName of the user is created in the Main web.
- The user is added to the TWikiUsers topic.
The default visitor name is
TWikiGuest. This is the non-authenticated user.
Managing Groups
The following describes the standard TWiki support for groups. Your local TWiki may have an alternate group mapping manager installed. Check with your TWiki administrator if you are in doubt.
Groups are defined by group topics located in the
Main
web. To create a new group, visit
TWikiGroups and enter the name of the new group ending in
Group
into the "new group" form field. This will create a new group topic with two important settings:
-
Set GROUP = < list of Users and/or Groups >
-
Set ALLOWTOPICCHANGE = < list of Users and/or Groups >
The GROUP setting is a comma-separated list of users and/or other groups. Example:
-
Set GROUP = Main.SomeUser, Main.OtherUser, Main.SomeGroup
The ALLOWTOPICCHANGE setting defines who is allowed to change the group topic; it is a comma delimited list of users and groups. You typically want to restrict that to the members of the group itself, so it should contain the name of the topic. This prevents users not in the group from editing the topic to give themselves or others access. For example, for the KasabianGroup topic write:
-
Set ALLOWTOPICCHANGE = Main.KasabianGroup
Note: TWiki has strict formatting rules. Make sure you have three spaces, an asterisk, and an extra space in front of any access control rule.
The Super Admin Group
A number of TWiki functions (for example, renaming webs) are only available to administrators. Administrators are simply users who belong to the
SuperAdminGroup. This is a standard user group, the name of which is defined by {SuperAdminGroup} setting in
configure. The default name of this group is the
TWikiAdminGroup
. The system administrator may have chosen a different name for this group if your local TWiki uses an alternate group mapping manager but for simplicity we will use the default name TWikiAdminGroup in the rest of this topic.
You can create new administrators simply by adding them to the
TWikiAdminGroup topic. For example,
-
Set GROUP = Main.ElizabethWindsor, Main.TonyBlair
A member of the Super Admin Group has unrestricted access throughout the TWiki, so only trusted staff should be added to this group.
Restricting Access
You can define who is allowed to read or write to a web or a topic. Note that some plugins may not respect access permissions.
- Restricting VIEW blocks viewing and searching of content. When you restric VIEW to a topic or web, this also restricts INCLUDE and Formatted SEARCH from showing the content of the topics.
- Restricting CHANGE blocks creating new topics, changing topics or attaching files.
- Restricting RENAME prevents renaming of topics within a web.
Note that there is an important distinction between CHANGE access and RENAME access. A user can CHANGE a topic, but thanks to version control their changes cannot be lost (the history of the topic before the change is recorded). However if a topic or web is renamed, that history may be lost. Typically a site will only give RENAME access to administrators and content owners.
Controlling access to a Web
You can define restrictions on who is allowed to view a TWiki web. You can restrict access to certain webs to selected Users and Groups, by:
- authenticating all webs and restricting selected webs: Topic access in all webs is authenticated, and selected webs have restricted access.
- authenticating and restricting selected webs only: Provide unrestricted viewing access to open webs, with authentication and restriction only on selected webs.
- You can define these settings in the WebPreferences topic, preferable towards the end of the topic:
-
Set DENYWEBVIEW = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWWEBVIEW = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set DENYWEBCHANGE = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWWEBCHANGE = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set DENYWEBRENAME = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWWEBRENAME = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
If your site allows hierarchical webs, then access to sub-webs is determined from the access controls of the parent web, plus the access controls in the sub-web. So, if the parent web has
ALLOWWEBVIEW
set, this will also apply to the subweb. Also note that you will need to ensure that the parent web's
FINALPREFERENCES
does not include the access control settings listed above. Otherwise you will not be able override the parent web's access control settings in sub-webs.
Creation and renaming of sub-webs is controlled by the WEBCHANGE setting on the parent web (or ROOTCHANGE for
root webs). Renaming is additionally restricted by the setting of WEBRENAME in the web itself.
Note: If you restrict access to the Main, make sure to add the
TWikiRegistrationAgent
so that users can register. Example:
-
-
Set ALLOWWEBCHANGE = TWikiAdminGroup, TWikiRegistrationAgent
Note: For Web level access rights Setting any of these settings to an empty value has the same effect as not setting them at all. Please note that the documentation of TWiki 4.0 and earlier versions of TWiki 4.1 did not reflect the actual implementation, e.g. an empty ALLOWWEBVIEW does
not prevent anyone from viewing the web, and an an empty DENYWEBVIEW does
not allow all to view the web.
Controlling access to a Topic
- You can define these settings in any topic, preferable towards the end of the topic:
-
Set DENYTOPICVIEW = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWTOPICVIEW = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set DENYTOPICCHANGE = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWTOPICCHANGE = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set DENYTOPICRENAME = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWTOPICRENAME = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
Remember when opening up access to specific topics within a restricted web that other topics in the web - for example, the
WebLeftBar - may also be accessed when viewing the topics. The message you get when you are denied access should tell you what topic you were not permitted to access.
Be careful with empty values for any of these.
-
Set ALLOWTOPICVIEW =
This means the same as not setting it at all. (This was documented wrong in versions 4.0.X, 4.1.0 and 4.1.1)
-
Set DENYTOPICVIEW =
Since TWiki 4.0 this means do not deny anyone the right to view this topic. If DENYTOPICVIEW is set to an empty value anyone has access even if ALLOWTOPICVIEW or ALLOWWEBVIEW is defined. This allows to have very restrictive default access rights to an entire web and still allow individual topics to have more open access.
The same rules apply to ALLOWTOPICCHANGE/DENYTOPICCHANGE and APPLYTOPICRENAME/DENYTOPICRENAME. Setting ALLOWTOPICCHANGE or ALLOWTOPICRENAME to en empty value means the same as not defining it. Setting DENYTOPICCHANGE or DENYTOPICRENAME to an empty value means that anyone can edit or rename the topic.
If the same setting is defined multiple times the last one overrides the previous. They are not OR'ed together.
The setting to an empty has caused confusion and great debate and it has been decided that the empty setting syntax will be replaced by something which is easier to understand in a later version of TWiki. A method to upgrade will be provided. Please read the release notes carefully when you upgrade.
See "How TWiki evaluates ALLOW/DENY settings" below for more on how ALLOW and DENY interacts.
Controlling access to Attachments
Attachments are referred to directly, and are not normally indirected via TWiki scripts. This means that the above instructions for access control will
not apply to attachments. It is possible that someone may inadvertently publicise a URL that they expected to be access-controlled.
The easiest way to apply the same access control rules for attachments as apply to topics is to use the Apache
mod_rewrite
module, and configure your webserver to redirect accesses to attachments to the TWiki
viewfile
script. For example,
ScriptAlias /twiki/bin/ /filesystem/path/to/twiki/bin/
Alias /twiki/pub/ /filesystem/path/to/twiki/pub/
RewriteEngine on
RewriteCond %{REQUEST_URI} !^/+twiki/+pub/+TWiki/+.+
RewriteRule ^/+twiki/+pub/+([^/]+)/+((([^/]+)/+)+)(.+) /twiki/bin/viewfile/$1/$4?filename=$5 [L,PT]
That way all the controls that apply to the topic also apply to attachments to the topic. Other types of webserver have similar support.
Note: Images embedded in topics will load much slower since each image will be delivered by the
viewfile
script.
Controlling who can manage top-level webs
Top level webs are a special case, because they don't have a parent web with a
WebPreferences. So there has to be a special control just for the root level.
- You can define these settings in the Main.%TWIKIPREFSTOPIC% topic, preferable towards the end of the topic:
-
Set DENYROOTCHANGE = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWROOTCHANGE = < comma-delimited list of Users and Groups >
Note that you do
not require
ROOTCHANGE
access to rename an existing top-level web. You just need
WEBCHANGE
in the web itself.
How TWiki evaluates ALLOW/DENY settings
When deciding whether to grant access, TWiki evaluates the following rules in order (read from the top of the list; if the logic arrives at
PERMITTED or
DENIED that applies immediately and no more rules are applied). You need to read the rules bearing in mind that VIEW, CHANGE and RENAME access may be granted/denied separately.
- If the user is an administrator
- If DENYTOPIC is set to a list of wikinames
- people in the list will be DENIED.
- If DENYTOPIC is set to empty ( i.e. Set DENYTOPIC = )
- access is PERMITTED i.e no-one is denied access to this topic.
Attention: Use this with caution. This is deprecated and will likely change in the next release.
- If ALLOWTOPIC is set
- people in the list are PERMITTED
- everyone else is DENIED
- If DENYWEB is set to a list of wikinames
- people in the list are DENIED access
- If ALLOWWEB is set to a list of wikinames
- people in the list will be PERMITTED
- everyone else will be DENIED
- If you got this far, access is PERMITTED
Access control and INCLUDE
ALLOWTOPICVIEW and ALLOWTOPICCHANGE only applies to the topic in which the settings are defined. If a topic A includes another topic B, topic A does not inherit the access rights of the included topic B.
Examples: Topic A includes topic B
- If the included topic B has ALLOWTOPICCHANGE set to block editing for a user, it does not prevent editing the including topic A.
- If the included topic B has ALLOWTOPICVIEW set to block view for a user, the user can still view topic A but he cannot see the included topic B. He will see a message No permission to view B
Access Control quick recipes
Obfuscating Webs
Another way of hiding webs is to keep them hidden by not publishing the URL and by preventing the
all webs
search option from accessing obfuscated webs. Do so by enabling the
NOSEARCHALL
variable in
WebPreferences:
This setup can be useful to hide a new web until content its ready for deployment, or to hide view access restricted webs.
Note: Obfuscating a web without view access control is
very insecure, as anyone who knows the URL can access the web.
Restrict Access to Whole TWiki Site
For a firewalled TWiki, e.g. an intranet wiki or extranet wiki, you want to allow only invited people to access your TWiki. In this case, enable
user authentication with ApacheLogin and lock down access to the whole
twiki/bin
and
twiki/pub
directories to all but valid users. In the Apache
.htaccess
file or the appropriate
.conf
file, replace the
<FilesMatch "(attach|edit|...
section with this:
<FilesMatch ".*">
require valid-user
</FilesMatch>
If needed, you can further restrict access to selected webs with ALLOWWEBVIEW and other access control settings.
Note: With this configuration, someone with access to the site needs to register new users.
Authenticate all Webs and Restrict Selected Webs
Use the following setup to authenticate users for topic viewing in all webs and to restrict access to selected webs. Requires
TWikiUserAuthentication to be enabled.
- Set
require valid-user
on your view
script in .htaccess or the appropriate Apache .conf file. As of 4.x, this looks like: FilesMatch "(attach|edit|manage|rename|save|view|upload|mail|logon|.*auth).*"
(normally view
is not in that list).
- Restrict view access to selected Users and Groups. Set one or both of these variables in its WebPreferences topic:
-
Set DENYWEBVIEW = < list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWWEBVIEW = < list of Users and Groups >
- Note:
DENYWEBVIEW
is evaluated before ALLOWWEBVIEW
. Access is denied if the authenticated person is in the DENYWEBVIEW
list, or not in the ALLOWWEBVIEW
list. Access is granted if DENYWEBVIEW
and ALLOWWEBVIEW
are not defined.
- If you still want public users to be able to register automatically follow TWiki:TWiki.RegisterOnViewRestrictedSite.
Authenticate and Restrict Selected Webs Only
Use the following setup to provide unrestricted viewing access to open webs, with authentication only on selected webs. Requires
TWikiUserAuthentication to be enabled.
- Restrict view access to selected Users and Groups. Set one or both of these variables in its WebPreferences topic:
-
Set DENYWEBVIEW = < list of Users and Groups >
-
Set ALLOWWEBVIEW = < list of Users and Groups >
- Note:
DENYWEBVIEW
is evaluated before ALLOWWEBVIEW
. Access is denied if the authenticated person is in the DENYWEBVIEW
list, or not in the ALLOWWEBVIEW
list. Access is granted if DENYWEBVIEW
and ALLOWWEBVIEW
are not defined.
Hide Control Settings
Tip: To hide access control settings from normal browser viewing, you can put them into the
topic preference settings by clicking the link
Edit topic preference settings
under
More topic actions
menu. Preferences set in this manner are not visible in the topic text, but take effect nevertheless. Access control settings added as topic preference settings are stored in the topic meta data and they override settings defined in the topic text.
Alternatively, place them in HTML comment markers, but this exposes the access setting during ordinary editing.
<!--
* Set DENYTOPICCHANGE = Main.SomeGroup
-->
Back to top
TWiki Text Formatting
Working in TWiki is as easy as typing in text. You don't need to know HTML, though you can use it if you prefer. Links to topics are created automatically when you enter
WikiWords. And TWiki shorthand gives you all the power of HTML with a simple coding system that takes no time to learn. It's all laid out below.
TWiki Editing Shorthand
Formatting Command:
|
You write:
|
You get:
|
Paragraphs:
Blank lines will create new paragraphs.
|
1st paragraph
2nd paragraph
|
1st paragraph
2nd paragraph
|
Headings:
Three or more dashes at the beginning of a line, followed by plus signs and the heading text. One plus creates a top level heading, two pluses a second level heading, etc. The maximum heading depth is 6.
You can create a table of contents with the %TOC% variable. If you want to exclude a heading from the TOC, put !! after the ---+ .
Empty headings are allowed, but won't appear in the table of contents.
|
---++ Sushi
---+++ Maguro
---+++!! Not in TOC
|
Sushi
Maguro
Not in TOC
|
Bold Text:
Words get shown in bold by enclosing them in * asterisks.
|
*Bold*
|
Bold
|
Italic Text:
Words get shown in italic by enclosing them in _ underscores.
|
_Italic_
|
Italic
|
Bold Italic:
Words get shown in bold italic by enclosing them in __ double-underscores.
|
__Bold italic__
|
Bold italic
|
Fixed Font:
Words get shown in fixed font by enclosing them in = equal signs.
|
=Fixed font=
|
Fixed font
|
Bold Fixed Font:
Words get shown in bold fixed font by enclosing them in double equal signs.
|
==Bold fixed==
|
Bold fixed
|
You can follow the closing bold, italic, or other (* _ __ = == ) indicator
with normal punctuation, such as commas and full stops.
Make sure there is no space between the text and the indicators.
|
_This works_,
_this does not _
|
This works,
_this does not _
|
Verbatim Text:
Surround code excerpts and other formatted text with <verbatim> and </verbatim> tags.
verbatim tags disable HTML code. Use <pre> and </pre> tags instead if you want the HTML code within the tags to be interpreted.
NOTE: Preferences variables (* Set NAME = value) are set within verbatim tags.
|
<verbatim>
class CatAnimal {
void purr() {
<code here>
}
}
</verbatim>
|
class CatAnimal {
void purr() {
<code here>
}
}
|
Separator (Horizontal Rule):
Three or more three dashes at the beginning of a line..
|
-------
|
|
Bulleted List:
Multiple of three spaces, an asterisk, and another space.
For all the list types, you can break a list item over several lines by indenting lines after the first one by at least 3 spaces.
|
* level 1
* level 2
* back on 1
* A bullet
broken over
three lines
* last bullet
|
- level 1
- back on 1
- A bullet broken over three lines
- last bullet
|
Numbered List:
Multiple of three spaces, a type character, a dot, and another space. Several types are available besides a number:
Type |
Generated Style |
Sample Sequence |
1. |
Arabic numerals |
1, 2, 3, 4... |
A. |
Uppercase letters |
A, B, C, D... |
a. |
Lowercase letters |
a, b, c, d... |
I. |
Uppercase Roman Numerals |
I, II, III, IV... |
i. |
Lowercase Roman Numerals |
i, ii, iii, iv... |
|
1. Sushi
1. Dim Sum
1. Fondue
A. Sushi
A. Dim Sum
A. Fondue
i. Sushi
i. Dim Sum
i. Fondue
|
- Sushi
- Dim Sum
- Fondue
- Sushi
- Dim Sum
- Fondue
- Sushi
- Dim Sum
- Fondue
|
Definition List:
Three spaces, a dollar sign, the term, a colon, a space, followed by the definition.
Deprecated syntax: Three spaces, the term with no spaces, a colon, a space, followed by the definition.
|
$ Sushi: Japan
$ Dim Sum: S.F.
|
- Sushi
- Japan
- Dim Sum
- S.F.
|
Table:
Each row of the table is a line containing of one or more cells. Each cell starts and ends with a vertical bar '|'. Any spaces at the beginning of a line are ignored.
-
| *bold* | header cell with text in asterisks
-
| center-aligned | cell with at least two, and equal number of spaces on either side
-
| right-aligned | cell with more spaces on the left
-
| 2 colspan || and multi-span columns with multiple |'s right next to each other
-
|^| cell with caret indicating follow-up row of multi-span rows
- You can split rows over multiple lines by putting a backslash
'\' at the end of each line
- Contents of table cells wrap automatically as determined by the browser
- Use
%VBAR% or | to add | characters in tables.
- Use
%CARET% or ^ to add ^ characters in tables.
The TablePlugin provides the |^| multiple-span row functionality and additional rendering features
|
| *L* | *C* | *R* |
| A2 | B2 | C2 |
| A3 | B3 | C3 |
| multi span |||
| A5-7 | 5 | 5 |
|^| six | six |
|^| seven | seven |
| split\
| over\
| 3 lines |
| A9 | B9 | C9 |
|
L |
C |
R |
A2 |
B2 |
C2 |
A3 |
B3 |
C3 |
multi span |
A5-7 |
5 |
5 |
six |
six |
seven |
seven |
split |
over |
3 lines |
A9 |
B9 |
C9 |
|
WikiWord Links:
CapitalizedWordsStuckTogether (or WikiWords) will produce a link automatically if preceded by whitespace or parenthesis.
If you want to link to a topic in a different web write Otherweb.TopicName .
To link to a topic in a subweb write Otherweb.Subweb.TopicName .
The link label excludes the name of the web, e.g. only the topic name is shown. As an exception, the name of the web is shown for the WebHome topic.
Dots '.' are used to separate webs and subwebs from topic names and therefore cannot be used in topic names.
It's generally a good idea to use the TWikiVariables %SYSTEMWEB% and %USERSWEB% instead of TWiki and Main.
|
WebStatistics
Sandbox.WebNotify
Sandbox.WebHome
Sandbox.Subweb.TopicName
|
WebStatistics
WebNotify
Sandbox
TopicName
|
Anchors:
You can define a reference inside a TWiki topic (called an anchor name) and link to that. To define an anchor write #AnchorName at the beginning of a line. The anchor name must be a WikiWord of no more than 32 characters. To link to an anchor name use the [[MyTopic#MyAnchor]] syntax. You can omit the topic name if you want to link within the same topic.
|
[[WikiWord#NotThere]]
[[#MyAnchor][Jump]]
#MyAnchor To here
|
WikiWord#NotThere
Jump
To here
|
Forced Links:
You can create a forced internal link by enclosing words in double square brackets.
Text within the brackets may contain optional spaces; the topic name is formed by capitalizing the initial letter and by removing the spaces; for example, [[text formatting FAQ]] links to topic TextFormattingFAQ. You can also refer to a different web and use anchors.
To "escape" double square brackets that would otherwise make a link, prefix the leading left square bracket with an exclamation point.
|
[[wiki syntax]]
[[Main.TWiki groups]]
escaped:
![[wiki syntax]]
|
wiki syntax
Main.TWiki groups
escaped:
[[wiki syntax]]
|
Specific Links:
You can create a link where you specify the link text and the URL separately using nested square brackets [[reference][text]] . Internal link references (e.g. WikiSyntax) and URLs (e.g. http://TWiki.org/) are both supported.
The rules described under Forced Links apply for internal link references.
Anchor names can be added as well, to create a link to a specific place in a topic.
|
[[WikiSyntax][wiki syntax]]
[[http://gnu.org][GNU]]
|
wiki syntax
GNU
|
Prevent a Link:
Prevent a WikiWord from being linked by prepending it with an exclamation point.
|
!SunOS
|
SunOS
|
Disable Links:
You can disable automatic linking of WikiWords by surrounding text with <noautolink> and </noautolink> tags.
It is possible to turn off all auto-linking with a NOAUTOLINK preferences setting.
|
<noautolink>
RedHat & SuSE
</noautolink>
|
RedHat & SuSE
|
Mailto Links:
E-mail addresses are linked automatically. To create e-mail links that have more descriptive link text, specify subject lines or message bodies, or omit the e-mail address, you can write [[mailto:user@domain][descriptive text]] .
|
a@b.com
[[mailto:a@b.com]\
[Mail]]
[[mailto:?subject=\
Hi][Hi]]
|
a@bNOSPAM.com
Mail
Hi
|
Literal content:
TWiki generates HTML code from TWiki shorthand.
Experts surround anything that must be output literally in the HTML code, without the application of
TWiki shorthand rules, with <literal>..</literal> tags. any HTML
within literal tags must be well formed i.e. all tags must be properly closed before
the end of the literal block. TWiki Variables are expanded within literal blocks.
|
<literal>
| Not | A | Table |
<literal>
|
| Not | A | Table |
|
Protected content:
Experts protect text from mangling by WYSIWYG editors using
<sticky>..</sticky> tags. Sticky tags don't have any effect on normal
topic display; they are only relevant when content has to be
protected from a WYSIWYG editor (usually because it isn't well-formed HTML, or because it
is HTML that WYSIWYG would normally filter out or modify). Protected
content appears as plain text in the WYSIWYG editor.
|
<sticky>
<div>
This div is required
</div>
<sticky>
|
This div is required
|
Using HTML
You can use most HTML tags in TWiki topics without a problem. This is useful where you want to
add some content that is formatted in a way that is not supported using
TWiki shorthand, for example,
you can write
<strike>deleted text</strike>
to get
deleted text.
There are a few usability and technical considerations to keep in mind:
- On collaboration pages, it's better not to use HTML, but to use TWiki shorthand instead - this keeps the text uncluttered and easy to edit using the plaintext editor.
- If you must use HTML, use XHTML 1.0 Transitional syntax.
- Use
<literal>..</literal>
tags around blocks of HTML to avoid accidental interpretation of TWiki shorthand within the HTML.
- Script tags may be filtered out, at the discretion of your TWiki administrator.
Recommendations when pasting HTML from other sources (using the plain-text editor):
- Copy only text between
<body>
and </body>
tags.
- Remove all empty lines. TWiki inserts
<p />
paragraph tags on empty lines, which causes problems if done between HTML tags that do not allow paragraph tags, like for example between table tags.
- Remove leading spaces. TWiki might interpret some text as lists.
- Do not span a tag over more than one line. TWiki requires that the opening and closing angle brackets -
<...>
- of a HTML tag are on the same line, or the tag will be broken.
- In your HTML editing program, save without hard line breaks on text wrap.
When using a WYSIWYG editor, you can just copy-paste directly into the editor, and the content will
be converted to
TWiki shorthand automatically when you save.
Hyperlinks
Being able to create links without any special formatting is a core TWiki feature, made possible with
WikiWords and inline URLs.
Internal Links
- GoodStyle is a WikiWord that links to the GoodStyle topic located in the current web.
- NotExistingYet? is a topic waiting to be written. Create the topic by clicking on the ?. (Try clicking, but then, Cancel - creating the topic would wreck this example!)
External Links
-
http://...
, https://...
, ftp://...
, gopher://...
, news://...
, file://...
, telnet://...
and mailto:...@...
are linked automatically.
- E-mail addresses like
name@domain.com
are linked automatically.
-
[[Square bracket rules]]
let you easily create non-WikiWord links.
- You can also write
[[http://yahoo.com Yahoo home page]]
as an easier way of doing external links with descriptive text for the link, such as Yahoo home page.
TWiki Variables
TWiki Variables are names enclosed in percent signs that are that are expanded to some other text when the topic
is displayed. For example,
%TOPIC%
is expanded to
TWikiVariablesQuickStart.
Some variables can take arguments in curly braces - for example,
%INCLUDE{"OtherTopic" ARG="arg"}%
.
Many TWiki variables are built-in, and others are predefined for your convenience. You can also define your own
TWiki Variables at the entire site, individual web, or individual topic level. For more information,
go to
TWikiVariables
TWiki Variables are fully expanded
before any of the TWiki text formatting rules are applied.
Documentation Graphics: There are many graphics available to use in your topics. Use
%ICON{"help"}%
,
%ICON{"tip"}%
, and
%ICON{"warning"}%
to get:
,
, and
, respectively.
TWikiDocGraphics lists them all.
To "escape" a variable, prefix it with an exclamation mark. Write:
!%SOMEVARIABLE%
to get: %SOMEVARIABLE%.
TWikiPlugin Formatting Extensions
Plugins can extend the functionality of TWiki into many other areas. There are a huge number of TWiki plugins available from the
Plugins web on TWiki.org.
Currently enabled plugins on this TWiki installation, as listed by
%PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS%
:
- SpreadSheetPlugin (any TWiki, $Rev: 17387 (11 Aug 2008) $): Add spreadsheet calculation like
"$SUM( $ABOVE() )"
to TWiki tables and other topic text - CommentPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Allows users to quickly post comments to a page without an edit/preview/save cycle
- EditTablePlugin (4.8.4, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Edit TWiki tables using edit fields, date pickers and drop down boxes
- GoogleAnalyticsPlugin (2011-05-14, $Rev: 21272 (2011-05-14) $): Adds Google Analytics javascript code to specified pages
- InterwikiPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 14913 (17 Sep 2007) $): Link
ExternalSite:Page
text to external sites based on aliases defined in a rules topic - PreferencesPlugin (TWiki-4.2, $Rev: 15487 (11 Aug 2008) $): Allows editing of preferences using fields predefined in a form
- SlideShowPlugin (02 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17260 (11 Aug 2008) $): Create web based presentations based on topics with headings.
- SmiliesPlugin (Dakar, $Rev: 16049 (11 Aug 2008) $): Render smilies as icons, like for
:-)
or for :eek:
- TablePlugin (2014-01-21, $Rev: 26934 (2014-01-21) $): Control attributes of tables and sorting of table columns
- TinyMCEPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Integration of TinyMCE? with WysiwygPlugin
- TwistyPlugin (1.4.10, $Rev: 15653 (19 Nov 2007) $): Twisty section JavaScript library to open/close content dynamically
- WysiwygPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17359 (11 Aug 2008) $): Translator framework for Wysiwyg editors
Check on current Plugin status and settings for this site in
TWikiPreferences.
Common Editing Errors
TWiki formatting rules are fairly simple to use and quick to type. However, there are some things to watch out for, taken from the
TextFormattingFAQ:
- Q: Text enclosed in angle brackets like
<filename>
is not displayed. How can I show it as it is?
- A: The
'<'
and '>'
characters have a special meaning in HTML, they define HTML tags. You need to escape them, so write '<'
instead of '<'
, and '>'
instead of '>'
.
Example: Type 'prog <filename>'
to get 'prog <filename>'
.
- Q: Why is the
'&'
character sometimes not displayed?
- A: The
'&'
character has a special meaning in HTML, it starts a so called character entity, i.e. '©'
is the ©
copyright character. You need to escape '&'
to see it as it is, so write '&'
instead of '&'
.
Example: Type 'This & that'
to get 'This & that'
.
Back to top
TWiki Variables
Special text strings expand on the fly to display user data or system info
TWikiVariables are text strings -
%VARIABLE%
or
%VARIABLE{ parameter="value" }%
- that expand into content whenever a topic is rendered for viewing. There are two types of variables:
- Preferences variables: Can be defined and changed by the user
- Predefined variables: Defined by the TWiki system or by Plugins (for example, the SpreadSheetPlugin introduces a
%CALC{}%
variable)
Using Variables
To use a variable type its name. For example,
- type
%T%
to get (a preferences variable)
- type
%TOPIC%
to get TWikiVariables
(a predefined variable)
- type
%CALC{ "$UPPER(Text)" }%
to get TEXT
(a variable defined by Plugin)
Note:
- To leave a variable unexpanded, precede it with an exclamation point, e.g. type
!%TOPIC%
to get %TOPIC%
- Variables are expanded relative to the topic they are used in, not the topic they are defined in
- Type
%ALLVARIABLES%
to get a full listing of all variables defined for a particular topic
Variable Names
Variable names must start with a letter. The following characters can be letters, numbers and the underscore '_'. You can use both upper-case and lower-case letters and you can mix the characteres. E.g.
%MYVAR%
,
%MyVar%
,
%My2ndVar%
, and
%My_Var%
are all valid variable names. Variables are case sensitive.
%MyVAR%
and
%MYVAR%
are not the same variable.
By convention all settings, predefined variables and variables used by plugins are always UPPER-CASE.
Preferences Variables
Unlike predefined variables, preferences variables can be defined by the user in various places.
Setting Preferences Variables
You can set variables in all the following places:
- local site level in TWiki.TWikiPreferences
- plugin topics (see TWikiPlugins)
- local site level in Main.TWikiPreferences
- user level in individual user topics in Main web
- web level in WebPreferences of each web
- topic level in topics in webs
- session variables (if sessions are enabled)
Settings at higher-numbered levels override settings of the same variable at lower numbered levels, unless the variable was included in the setting of FINALPREFERENCES at a lower-numbered level, in which case it is locked at the value it has at that level.
If you are setting a variable and using it in the same topic, note that TWiki reads all the variable settings from the saved version of the topic before it displays anything. This means you can use a variable anywhere in the topic, even if you set it somewhere inconspicuous near the end.
But beware: it also means that if you change the setting of a variable you are using in the same topic,
Preview
will show the wrong thing, and you must
Save
the topic to see it correctly.
The syntax for setting Variables is the same anywhere in TWiki (on its own TWiki bullet line, including nested bullets):
[multiple of 3 spaces] * [space] Set [space] VARIABLENAME [space] = [space] value
Examples:
Spaces between the = sign and the value will be ignored. You can split a value over several lines by indenting following lines with spaces - as long as you don't try to use * as the first character on the following line.
Example:
* Set VARIABLENAME = value starts here
and continues here
Whatever you include in your Variable will be expanded on display, exactly as if it had been entered directly.
Example: Create a custom logo variable
- To place a logo anywhere in a web by typing
%MYLOGO%
, define the Variable on the web's WebPreferences topic, and upload a logo file, ex: mylogo.gif
. You can upload by attaching the file to WebPreferences, or, to avoid clutter, to any other topic in the same web, e.g. LogoTopic
. Sample variable setting in WebPreferences:
-
Set MYLOGO = %PUBURL%/%WEB%/LogoTopic/mylogo.gif
You can also set preferences variables on a topic by clicking the link
Edit topic preference settings
under
More topic actions
. Preferences set in this manner are not visible in the topic text, but take effect nevertheless.
Access Control Variables
These are special types of preferences variables to control access to content.
TWikiAccessControl explains these security settings in detail.
Local values for variables
Certain topics (a users home topic, web site and default preferences topics) have a problem; variables defined in those topics can have two meanings. For example, consider a user topic. A user may want to use a double-height edit box when they are editing their home topic - but
only when editing their home topic. The rest of the time, they want to have a normal edit box. This separation is achieved using
Local
in place of
Set
in the variable definition. For example, if the user sets the following in their home topic:
* Set EDITBOXHEIGHT = 10
* Local EDITBOXHEIGHT = 20
Then when they are editing any other topic, they will get a 10 high edit box. However when they are editing their home topic, they will get a 20 high edit box.
Local
can be used wherever a preference needs to take a different value depending on where the current operation is being performed.
Use this powerful feature with great care!
%ALLVARIABLES%
can be used to get a listing of the values of all variables in their evaluation order, so you can see variable scope if you get confused.
Frequently Used Preferences Variables
The following preferences variables are frequently used. They are defined in
TWikiPreferences#Miscellaneous_Settings:
-
%BR%
- line break
-
%BULLET%
- bullet sign
-
%BB%
- line break and bullet combined
-
%BB2%
- indented line break and bullet
-
%RED% text %ENDCOLOR%
- colored text (also %YELLOW%
, %ORANGE%
, %PINK%
, %PURPLE%
, %TEAL%
, %NAVY%
, %BLUE%
, %AQUA%
, %LIME%
, %GREEN%
, %OLIVE%
, %MAROON%
, %BROWN%
, %BLACK%
, %GRAY%
, %SILVER%
, %WHITE%
)
-
%H%
- Help icon
-
%I%
- Idea icon
-
%M%
- Moved to icon
-
%N%
- New icon
-
%P%
- Refactor icon
-
%Q%
- Question icon
-
%S%
- Pick icon
-
%T%
- Tip icon
-
%U%
- Updated icon
-
%X%
- Alert icon
-
%Y%
- Done icon
There are additional useful preferences variables defined in
TWikiPreferences, in
Main.TWikiPreferences, and in
WebPreferences of every web.
Predefined Variables
Most predefined variables return values that were either set in the configuration when TWiki was installed, or taken from server info (such as current username, or date and time). Some, like
%SEARCH%
, are powerful and general tools.
- Predefined variables can be overridden by preferences variables (except TOPIC and WEB)
- Plugins may extend the set of predefined variables (see individual Plugins topics for details)
- Take the time to thoroughly read through ALL preference variables. If you actively configure your site, review variables periodically. They cover a wide range of functions, and it can be easy to miss the one perfect variable for something you have in mind. For example, see
%INCLUDINGTOPIC%
, %INCLUDE%
, and the mighty %SEARCH%
.
This version of TWiki - TWiki-4.2.3, Wed, 06 Aug 2008, build 17396 - predefines the following variables:
ACTIVATEDPLUGINS -- list of currently activated plugins
- Syntax:
%ACTIVATEDPLUGINS%
- Expands to: SpreadSheetPlugin, CommentPlugin, EditTablePlugin, GoogleAnalyticsPlugin, InterwikiPlugin, PreferencesPlugin, SlideShowPlugin, SmiliesPlugin, TablePlugin, TinyMCEPlugin, TwistyPlugin, WysiwygPlugin
- Related: PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS, FAILEDPLUGINS, PLUGINVERSION
ALLVARIABLES -- list of currently defined TWikiVariables
- Syntax:
%ALLVARIABLES%
- Expands to: a table showing all defined TWikiVariables in the current context
AQUA -- start aqua colored text
-
AQUA
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%AQUA% aqua text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: aqua text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
ATTACHURL -- full URL for attachments in the current topic
ATTACHURLPATH -- path of the attachment URL of the current topic
AUTHREALM -- authentication realm
- String defined as {AuthRealm} in configure. This is used in certain password encodings, and in login templates as part of the login prompt.
- Syntax:
%AUTHREALM%
- Expands to: Enter your LoginName. (Typically First name and last name, no space, no dots, capitalized, e.g. JohnSmith, unless you chose otherwise). Visit TWikiRegistration if you do not have one.
- Related: TWikiUserAuthentication, SESSIONID, SESSIONVAR, LOGIN, LOGOUT, SESSION_VARIABLE
BASETOPIC -- base topic where an INCLUDE started
- The name of the topic where a single or nested INCLUDE started - same as
%TOPIC%
if there is no INCLUDE
- Syntax:
%BASETOPIC%
- Related: BASEWEB, INCLUDINGTOPIC, INCLUDE, TOPIC
BASEWEB -- base web where an INCLUDE started
- The web name where the includes started, e.g. the web of the first topic of nested includes. Same as
%WEB%
in case there is no include.
- Syntax:
%BASEWEB%
- Related: BASETOPIC, INCLUDINGWEB, INCLUDE, WEB
BB -- bullet with line break
BB2 -- level 2 bullet with line break
BB3 -- level 3 bullet with line break
BB4 -- level 4 bullet with line break
BLACK -- start black colored text
-
BLACK
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%BLACK% black text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: black text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
BLUE -- start blue colored text
-
BLUE
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%BLUE% blue text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: blue text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
BR -- line break
BROWN -- start brown colored text
-
BROWN
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%BROWN% brown text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: brown text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
BULLET -- bullet character
CALC{"formula"} -- add spreadsheet calculations to tables and outside tables
- The
%CALC{"formula"}%
variable is handled by the SpreadSheetPlugin. There are around 80 formulae, such as $ABS()
, $EXACT()
, $EXISTS()
, $GET()/$SET()
, $IF()
, $LOG()
, $LOWER()
, $PERCENTILE()
, $TIME()
, $VALUE()
.
- Syntax:
%CALC{"formula"}%
- Examples:
-
%CALC{"$SUM($ABOVE())"}%
returns the sum of all cells above the current cell
-
%CALC{"$EXISTS(Web.SomeTopic)"}%
returns 1
if the topic exists
-
%CALC{"$UPPER(Collaboration)"}%
returns COLLABORATION
- Related: IF, SpreadSheetPlugin
CARET -- caret symbol
COMMENT{ attributes } -- insert an edit box into the topic to easily add comments.
- A
%COMMENT%
without parameters shows a simple text box.
- The following standard attributes are recognized
Name | Description | Default |
type | This is the name of the template to use for this comment. Comment templates are defined in a TWiki template - see Customisation, below. If this attribute is not defined, the type is whatever is defined by COMMENTPLUGIN_DEFAULT_TYPE, either in this topic or in your WebPreferences. | below |
default | Default text to put into the textarea of the prompt. | |
target | Name of the topic to add the comment to | the current topic |
location | Regular expression specifying the comment location in the target topic. Read carefully the CommentPlugin documentation! | |
mode | For compatibility with older versions only, synonymous with type | |
nonotify | Set to "on" to disable change notification for target topics | off |
noform | Set to "on" to disable the automatic form that encloses your comment block - remember to insert <form> tags yourself! See CommentPluginExamples#noform for an example. | off |
nopost | Set to "on" to disable insertion of the posted text into the topic. | off |
remove | Set to "on" to remove the comment prompt after the first time it is clicked. | off |
button | Button label text | Add comment |
DATE -- signature format date
DISPLAYTIME -- display date and time
- Syntax:
%DISPLAYTIME%
- Expands to:
17 Jul 2018 - 01:01
- Date part of the format is displayed as defined by the {DefaultDateFormat} in configure. The time is shown as hh:mm (24 hour clock)
- Related: DISPLAYTIME{"format"}, GMTIME, SERVERTIME
DISPLAYTIME{"format"} -- formatted display time
- Formatted time - either GMT or Local server time, depending on {DisplayTimeValues} setting in configure. Same format qualifiers as
%GMTIME%
- Syntax:
%DISPLAYTIME{"format"}%
- Example:
%DISPLAYTIME{"$hou:$min"}%
expands to 01:01
- Related: DISPLAYTIME, GMTIME, SERVERTIME
EDITACTION -- Selects an edit template
- EDITACTION defined in a topic or preference setting will define the use of an editaction template instead of the standard edit. If EDITACTION is defined as
text
, then hide the form. If EDITACTION is defined as form
hide the normal text area and only edit the form.
- Syntax: Set EDITACTION = text|form
- Expands to: %EDITACTION%
- Related: TWikiScripts#edit
- When EDITACTION is defined as text or form the Edit and Edit Raw buttons simply add
;action=text
or ;action=form
to the URL for the edit script. If you have defined EDITACTION in a topic setting or preference setting you can still edit the topic content or the form by removing the ;action=form
or ;action=text
from the edit URL in the browser and reload.
EDITTABLE{ attributes } -- edit TWiki tables using edit fields and other input fields
- The
%EDITTABLE{}%
variable is handled by the EditTablePlugin
- Syntax:
%EDITTABLE{ attributes }%
- Supported attributes:
Attribute | Comment | Default |
header | Specify the header format of a new table like "|*Food*|*Drink*|" . Useful to start a table with only a button | (no header) |
format | The format of one column when editing the table. A cell can be a text input field, or any of these edit field types: • Text input field (1 line): | text, <size>, <initial value> | • Textarea input field: | textarea, <rows>x<columns>, <initial value> | • Drop down box: | select, <size>, <option 1>, <option 2>, etc* | * only one item can be selected • Radio buttons: | radio, <size*>, <option 1>, <option 2>, etc | * size indicates the number of buttons per line in edit mode • Checkboxes: | checkbox, <size*>, <option 1>, <option 2>, etc | * size indicates the number of checkboxes per line in edit mode • Fixed label: | label, 0, <label text> | • Row number: | row, <offset> | • Date: | date, <size>, <initial value>, <DHTML date format> | (see Date Field Type) | "text, 16" for all cells |
changerows | Rows can be added and removed if "on" Rows can be added but not removed if "add" Rows cannot be added or removed if "off" | CHANGEROWS plugin setting |
quietsave | Quiet Save button is shown if "on" , hidden if "off" | QUIETSAVE plugin setting |
include | Other topic defining the EDITTABLE parameters. The first %EDITTABLE% in the topic is used. This is useful if you have many topics with the same table format and you want to update the format in one place. | (none) |
helptopic | Topic name containing help text shown below the table when editing a table. The %STARTINCLUDE% and %STOPINCLUDE% variables can be used in the topic to specify what is shown. | (no help text) |
headerislabel | Table header cells are read-only (labels) if "on" ; header cells can be edited if "off" or "0" | "on" |
editbutton | Set edit button text, e.g. "Edit this table" ; set button image with alt text, e.g. "Edit table, %PUBURL%/%TWIKIWEB%/TWikiDocGraphics/edittopic.gif" ; hide edit button at the end of the table with "hide" (Note: Button is automatically hidden if an edit button is present in a cell) | EDITBUTTON plugin setting |
javascriptinterface | Use javascript to directly move and delete row without page refresh. Enable with "on" , disable with "off" . | JAVASCRIPTINTERFACE plugin setting |
- Example:
%EDITTABLE{ format="| text, 20 | select, 1, one, two, three |" changerows="on" }%
| *Name* | *Type* |
| Foo | two |
- Related: See EditTablePlugin for more details
ENCODE{"string"} -- encodes a string to HTML entities
- Encode "special" characters to HTML numeric entities. Encoded characters are:
- all non-printable ASCII characters below space, except newline (
"\n"
) and linefeed ("\r"
)
- HTML special characters
"<"
, ">"
, "&"
, single quote ('
) and double quote ("
)
- TWiki special characters
"%"
, "["
, "]"
, "@"
, "_"
, "*"
, "="
and "|"
- Syntax:
%ENCODE{"string"}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"string" | String to encode | required (can be empty) |
type="entity" | Encode special characters into HTML entities, like a double quote into " . Does not encode \n or \r . | type="url" |
type="html" | As type="entity" except it also encodes \n and \r | type="url" |
type="quotes" | Escape double quotes with backslashes (\" ), does not change other characters | type="url" |
type="url" | Encode special characters for URL parameter use, like a double quote into %22 | (this is the default) |
- Example:
%ENCODE{"spaced name"}%
expands to spaced%20name
- Note: Values of HTML input fields must be entity encoded.
Example: <input type="text" name="address" value="%ENCODE{ "any text" type="entity" }%" />
- Note: Double quotes in strings must be escaped when passed into other TWiki variables.
Example: %SEARCH{ "%ENCODE{ "string with "quotes"" type="quotes" }%" noheader="on" }%
ENDCOLOR -- end colored text
-
ENDCOLOR
is a rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%RED% red text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: red text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: VarAQUA, VarBLACK, VarBLUE, VarBROWN, VarGRAY, VarGREEN, VarLIME, VarMAROON, VarNAVY, VarOLIVE, VarORANGE, VarPINK, VarPURPLE, VarRED, VarSILVER, VarTEAL, VarWHITE, VarYELLOW, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
ENDSECTION{"name"} -- marks the end of a named section within a topic
- Syntax:
%ENDSECTION{"name"}%
- Syntax:
%ENDSECTION{type="include"}%
- Supported parameter:
Parameter: | Description: |
"name" | Name of the section. |
type="..." | Type of the section being terminated; supported types "section" , "include" , "templateonly" . |
- If the
STARTSECTION
is named, the corresponding ENDSECTION
must also be named with the same name. If the STARTSECTION
specifies a type, then the corresponding ENDSECTION
must also specify the same type. If the section is unnamed, ENDSECTION
will match with the nearest unnamed %STARTSECTION%
of the same type above it.
- Related: STARTSECTION
ENV{"varname"} -- inspect the value of an environment variable
- Returns the current value of the environment variable in the CGI (Common Gateway Interface) environment. This is the environment that the TWiki scripts run in on the web server.
- Note: For security reasons, only those variables whose names match the regular expression in
{AccessibleENV}
in the Security Settings/Miscellaneous section of configure
can be displayed. Any other variable will just be shown as an empty string, irrespective of its real value.
- Example:
%ENV{MOD_PERL}%
displays as: not set
- If a variable is undefined (as against being set to the empty string) it will be returned as
not set
.
- Related: HTTP_HOST, REMOTE_ADDR, REMOTE_PORT, REMOTE_USER
FAILEDPLUGINS -- debugging for plugins that failed to load, and handler list
FORMFIELD{"fieldname"} -- renders a field in the form attached to some topic
- Syntax:
%FORMFIELD{"fieldname"}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"fieldname" | The name of a TWiki form field | required |
topic="..." | Topic where form data is located. May be of the form Web.TopicName | Current topic |
format="..." | Format string. $value expands to the field value, and $title expands to the fieldname (also expands $name, $attributes, $type, $size and $definingTopic) | "$value" |
default="..." | Text shown when no value is defined for the field | "" |
alttext="..." | Text shown when field is not found in the form | "" |
- Example:
%FORMFIELD{"ProjectName" topic="Projects.SushiProject" default="(not set)" alttext="ProjectName field found"}%
- Related: SEARCH
GMTIME -- GM time
GMTIME{"format"} -- formatted GM time
- Syntax:
%GMTIME{"format"}%
- Supported variables:
Variable: | Unit: | Example |
$seconds | seconds | 59 |
$minutes | minutes | 59 |
$hours | hours | 23 |
$day | day of month | 31 |
$wday | day of the Week (Sun, Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat) | Thu |
$dow | day of the week (Sun = 0) | 2 |
$week | number of week in year (ISO 8601) | 34 |
$month | short name of month | Dec |
$mo | 2 digit month | 12 |
$year | 4 digit year | 1999 |
$ye | 2 digit year | 99 |
$tz | either "GMT" (if set to gmtime), or "Local" (if set to servertime) | GMT |
$iso | ISO format timestamp | 2018-07-17T01:01:27Z |
$rcs | RCS format timestamp | 2018/07/17 01:01:27 |
$http | E-mail & http format timestamp | Tue, 17 Jul 2018 01:01:27 GMT |
$epoch | Number of seconds since 00:00 on 1st January, 1970 | 1531789287 |
- Variables can be shortened to 3 characters
- Example:
%GMTIME{"$day $month, $year - $hour:$min:$sec"}%
expands to 17 Jul, 2018 - 01:01:27
- Note: When used in a template topic, this variable will be expanded when the template is used to create a new topic. See TWikiTemplates#TemplateTopicsVars for details.
- Related: DISPLAYTIME, GMTIME, REVINFO, SERVERTIME
GRAY -- start gray colored text
-
GRAY
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%GRAY% gray text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: gray text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
GREEN -- start green colored text
-
GREEN
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%GREEN% green text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: green text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
GROUPS -- a formatted list of groups
H -- help icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: H =
- Related: I, ICON, M, N, P, Q, S, T, U, X, Y
HOMETOPIC -- home topic in each web
HTTP -- get HTTP headers
- Called with the name of an HTTP header field, returns its value. Capitalization and the use of hyphens versus underscores are not significant.
- Syntax:
%HTTP%
- Syntax:
%HTTP{"Header-name"}%
- Examples:
%HTTP% | |
%HTTP{"Accept-language"}% | en, * |
%HTTP{"User-Agent"}% | Mozilla/4.5 (compatible; HTTrack 3.0x; Windows 98) |
- Note: You can see the HTTP headers your browser sends to the server on a number of sites e.g. http://www.ericgiguere.com/tools/http-header-viewer.html
- Related: HTTPS, REMOTE_ADDR, REMOTE_PORT, REMOTE_USER
HTTP_HOST -- environment variable
HTTPS -- get HTTPS headers
- The same as
%HTTP%
but operates on the HTTPS environment variables present when the SSL protocol is in effect. Can be used to determine whether SSL is turned on.
- Syntax:
%HTTPS%
- Syntax:
%HTTPS{"Header-name"}%
- Related: HTTP, REMOTE_ADDR, REMOTE_PORT, REMOTE_USER
I -- idea icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: I =
- Related: H, ICON, M, N, P, Q, S, T, U, X, Y
ICON{"name"} -- small documentation graphic or icon of common attachment types
- Generates the HTML img tag of a small graphic image attached to TWikiDocGraphics. Images typically have a 16x16 pixel size. You can select a specific image by name, or you can give a full filename, in which case the type of the file will be used to select one of a collection of common file type icons.
- Syntax:
%ICON{"name"}%
- Examples:
-
%ICON{"flag-gray"}%
returns
-
%ICON{"pdf"}%
returns
-
%ICON{"smile.pdf"}%
returns
-
%ICON{"/dont/you/dare/smile.pdf"}%
returns
-
%ICON{"http://twiki.org/doc/xhtml.xsl"}%
returns
- Graphic samples:
arrowbright
, bubble
, choice-yes
, hand
- File type samples:
bmp
, doc
, gif
, hlp
, html
, mp3
, pdf
, ppt
, txt
, xls
, xml
, zip
- Related: ICONURL, ICONURLPATH, TWikiPreferences, FileAttachments, TWikiDocGraphics
ICONURL{"name"} -- URL of small documentation graphic or icon
- Generates the full URL of a TWikiDocGraphics image, which TWiki renders as an image. The related
%ICON{"name"}%
generates the full HTML img tag. Specify image name or full filename (see ICON for details on filenames.)
- Syntax:
%ICONURL{"name"}%
- Examples:
-
%ICONURL{"arrowbright"}%
returns http://open-services.net/pub/TWiki/TWikiDocGraphics/arrowbright.gif
-
%ICONURL{"novel.pdf"}%
returns http://open-services.net/pub/TWiki/TWikiDocGraphics/pdf.gif
-
%ICONURL{"/queen/boheme.mp3"}%
returns http://open-services.net/pub/TWiki/TWikiDocGraphics/mp3.gif
- Related: ICONURLPATH, ICON, TWikiPreferences, FileAttachments, TWikiDocGraphics
ICONURLPATH{"name"} -- URL path of small documentation graphic or icon
- Generates the URL path of a TWikiDocGraphics image, typically used in an HTML img tag. Specify image name or full filename (see ICON for details on filenames.)
- Syntax:
%ICONURLPATH{"name"}%
- Examples:
-
%ICONURLPATH{"locktopic"}%
returns /pub/TWiki/TWikiDocGraphics/locktopic.gif
-
%ICONURLPATH{"eggysmell.xml"}%
returns /pub/TWiki/TWikiDocGraphics/xml.gif
-
%ICONURLPATH{"/doc/xhtml.xsl"}%
returns /pub/TWiki/TWikiDocGraphics/xsl.gif
- Related: ICONURL, ICON, TWikiPreferences, FileAttachments, TWikiDocGraphics
IF{"condition" ...} -- simple conditionals
- Evaluate a condition and show one text or another based on the result. See details in IfStatements
- Syntax:
%IF{"CONDITION" then="THEN" else="ELSE"}%
shows "THEN"
if "CONDITION"
evaluates to TRUE
, otherwise "ELSE"
will be shown
- Example:
%IF{"defined FUNFACTOR" then="FUNFACTOR is defined" else="FUNFACTOR is not defined"}%
renders as FUNFACTOR is not defined
- Related: $IF() of SpreadSheetPlugin
INCLUDE{"page"} -- include other topic or web page
- Syntax:
%INCLUDE{"page" ...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"SomeTopic" | The name of a topic located in the current web, i.e. %INCLUDE{"WebNotify"}% | |
"Web.Topic" | A topic in another web, i.e. %INCLUDE{"TWiki.SiteMap"}% | |
"http://..." | A full qualified URL, i.e. %INCLUDE{"http://twiki.org:80/index.html"}% . Supported content types are text/html and text/plain . if the URL resolves to an attachment file on the server this will automatically translate to a server-side include. | |
pattern="..." | Include a subset of a topic or a web page. Specify a RegularExpression that scans from start ('^' ) to end and contains the text you want to keep in parenthesis, e.g., pattern="^.*?(from here.*?to here).*" . IncludeTopicsAndWebPages has more. | none |
rev="2" | Include a previous topic revision; N/A for URLs | top revision |
raw="on" | When a page is included, normally TWiki will process it, doing the following: 1) Alter relative links to point back to originating host, 2) Remove some basic HTML tags (html, head, body, script) and finally 3) Remove newlines from HTML tags spanning multiple lines. If you prefer to include exactly what is in the source of the originating page set this to on . raw="on" is short for disableremoveheaders="on" , disableremovescript="on" , disableremovebody="on" , disablecompresstags="on" and disablerewriteurls="on" . | disabled |
literal="on" | While using the raw option will indeed include the raw content, the included content will still be processed and rendered like regular topic content. To disable parsing of the included content, set the literal option to "on" . | disabled |
disableremoveheaders="on" | Bypass stripping headers from included HTML (everything until first </head> tag) | disabled |
disableremovescript="on" | Bypass stripping all <script> tags from included HTML | disabled |
disableremovebody="on" | Bypass stripping the </body> tag and everything around over and below it | disabled |
disablecompresstags="on" | Bypass replacing newlines in HTML tags with spaces. This compression step rewrites unmatched <'s into < entities unless bypassed | disabled |
disablerewriteurls="on" | Bypass rewriting relative URLs into absolute ones | disabled |
warn="off" | Warn if topic include fails: Fail silently (if off ); output default warning (if set to on ); else, output specific text (use $topic for topic name) | %INCLUDEWARNING% preferences setting |
section="name" | Includes only the specified named section, as defined in the included topic by the STARTSECTION and ENDSECTION variables. Nothing is shown if the named section does not exists. section="" is equivalent to not specifying a section | |
PARONE="val 1" PARTWO="val 2" | Any other parameter will be defined as a variable within the scope of the included topic. The example parameters on the left will result in %PARONE% and %PARTWO% being defined within the included topic. | |
- Note: JavaScript in included webpages is filtered out as a security precaution per default (disable filter with
disableremovescript
parameter)
- Examples: See IncludeTopicsAndWebPages
- Related: BASETOPIC, BASEWEB, INCLUDINGTOPIC, INCLUDINGWEB, STARTINCLUDE, STOPINCLUDE, STARTSECTION, ENDSECTION
INCLUDINGTOPIC -- name of topic that includes current topic
- The name of the topic that includes the current topic - same as
%TOPIC%
in case there is no include
- Syntax:
%INCLUDINGTOPIC%
- Related: BASETOPIC, INCLUDINGWEB, INCLUDE, TOPIC
INCLUDINGWEB -- web that includes current topic
- The web name of the topic that includes the current topic - same as
%WEB%
if there is no INCLUDE.
- Syntax:
%INCLUDINGWEB%
- Related: BASEWEB, INCLUDINGTOPIC, INCLUDE, WEB
LANGUAGE -- current user's language
- Returns the language code for the language used as the current user. This is the language actually used by TWiki Internationalization (e.g. in user interface).
- The language is detected from the user's browser, unless some site/web/user/session-defined setting overrides it:
- If the
LANGUAGE
preference is set, it's used as user's language instead of any language detected from the browser.
- Avoid defining
LANGUAGE
at a non per-user way, so each user can choose his/her preferred language.
- Related: LANGUAGES
LANGUAGES -- list available TWiki languages
- List the languages available (as
PO
files) to TWiki. Those are the languages in which TWiki's user interface is available.
- Syntax:
%LANGUAGES{...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
format | format for each item. See below for variables available in the format string. | " * $langname" |
separator | separator between items. | "\n" (newline) |
marker="selected" | Text for $marker if the item matches selection | "selected" |
selection="%LANGUAGE%" | Current language to be selected in list | (none) |
-
format
variables: Variable | Meaning |
$langname | language's name, as informed by the translators |
$langtag | language's tag. Ex: en , pt-br , etc. |
- Example:
<select>%LANGUAGES{format="<option $marker value='$langtag'>$langname</option>" selection="%LANGUAGE%"}%</select>
creates an option list of the available languages with the current language selected
LIME -- start lime colored text
-
LIME
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%LIME% lime text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: lime text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
LOCALSITEPREFS -- web.topicname of site preferences topic
- The full name of the local site preferences topic. These local site preferences overload the system level preferences defined in TWiki.TWikiPreferences.
- Syntax:
%LOCALSITEPREFS%
- Expands to:
Main.TWikiPreferences
, renders as TWikiPreferences
LOGIN -- present a full login link
LOGOUT -- present a full logout link
M -- moved to... icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: M =
- Related: H, I, ICON, N, P, Q, S, T, U, X, Y
MAINWEB -- synonym for USERSWEB
- Deprecated. Please use %USERSWEB% instead.
MAKETEXT -- creates text using TWiki's I18N infrastructure
- Syntax:
%MAKETEXT{"string" args="..."}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter | Description | Default |
"text" or string="text" | The text to be displayed. | none |
args="param1, param2" | a comma-separated list of arguments to be interpolated in the string, replacing the [_N] placeholders in it. | none |
- Examples:
-
%MAKETEXT{string="Notes:"}%
expands to
Notes:
-
%MAKETEXT{"If you have any questions, please contact [_1]." args="%WIKIWEBMASTER%"}%
expands to
If you have any questions, please contact webmaster@open-servicesNOSPAM.net.
-
%MAKETEXT{"Did you want to [[[_1]][reset [_2]'s password]]?" args="%SYSTEMWEB%.ResetPassword,%WIKIUSERNAME%"}%
expands to
Did you want to reset Main.TWikiGuest's password?
- Notes:
- TWiki will translate the
string
to the current user's language only if it has such string in its translation table for that language.
- Amperstands (
&
) followed by one letter (one of a...z, A...Z) (say, X
) in the translatable string will be translated to <span class='twikiAccessKey'>X</span>
. This is used to implement access keys. If you want to write an actual amperstand that stays just before a letter, write two consecutive amperstands (&&
): they will be transformed in just one.
- translatable string starting with underscores (
_
) are reserved. You cannot use translatable phrases starting with an underscore.
- Make sure that the translatable string is constant. Specially, do not include
%VARIABLES%
inside the translatable strings (since they will get expanded before the %MAKETEXT{...}%
itself is handled).
MAROON -- start maroon colored text
-
MAROON
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%MAROON% maroon text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: maroon text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
META -- displays meta-data
- Provided mainly for use in templates, this variable generates the parts of the topic view that relate to meta-data (attachments, forms etc.) The
formfield
item is the most likely to be useful to casual users.
- Syntax:
%META{ "item" ...}%
- Parameters:
Item | Options | Description |
"formfield" | name="..." : name of the field. The field value can be shortened as described in FormattedSearch for $formfield newline="..." : by default, each newline character will be rewritten to <br /> to allow metadata that contains newlines to be used in tables, etc. $n indicates a newline character. bar="..." : by default, each vertical bar is rewritten to an HTML entity so as to not be mistaken for a table separator. | Show a single form field |
"form" | none | Generates the table showing the form fields. See Form Templates |
"attachments" | all="on" to show hidden attachments. title="..." to show a title - only if attachments are displayed. template="..." to use a custom template for the rendering of attachments; default attachtables is used. | Generates the list of attachments |
"moved" | none | Details of any topic moves |
"parent" | dontrecurse="on" : By default recurses up tree, this has some cost. nowebhome="on" : Suppress WebHome. prefix="..." : Prefix that goes before parents, but only if there are parents, default "" . format="..." : Format string used to display each parent topic where $web expands to the web name, and $topic expands to the topic name; default: "[[$web.$topic][$topic]]" suffix="..." : Suffix, only appears if there are parents; default "" . separator="..." : Separator between parents; default " > " . | Generates the parent link |
- Related: METASEARCH
METASEARCH -- special search of meta data
- Syntax:
%METASEARCH{...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
type="topicmoved" | What sort of search is required? "topicmoved" if search for a topic that may have been moved "parent" if searching for topics that have a specific parent i.e. its children "field" if searching for topics that have a particular form field value (use the name and value parameters to specify which field to search) | Required |
web="%WEB%" | Wiki web to search: A web, a list of webs separated by whitespace, or all webs. | Current web |
topic="%TOPIC%" | The topic the search relates to, for topicmoved and parent searches | All topics in a web |
name | form field to search, for field type searches. May be a regular expression (see SEARCH). | |
value | form field value, for field type searches. May be a regular expression (see SEARCH). | |
title="Title" | Text that is prefixed to any search results | empty |
format="..." | Custom format results. Supports same format strings as SEARCH. See FormattedSearch for usage, variables & examples | Results in table |
default="none" | Default text shown if no search hit | Empty |
- Example:
%METASEARCH{type="topicmoved" web="%WEB%" topic="%TOPIC%" title="This topic used to exist and was moved to: "}%
- Example: You may want to use this in WebTopicViewTemplate and WebTopicNonWikiTemplate:
%METASEARCH{type="parent" web="%WEB%" topic="%TOPIC%" title="Children: "}%
- Example:
%METASEARCH{type="field" name="Country" value="China"}%
- Related: SEARCH, META
- Note: METASEARCH is deprecated in favour of the new and much more powerful query type search. See SEARCH and QuerySearch.
N -- "new" icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: N =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, P, Q, S, T, U, X, Y
NAVY -- start navy blue colored text
-
NAVY
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%NAVY% navy text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: navy text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
NOP -- template text not to be expanded in instantiated topics
- Syntax:
%NOP%
- In normal topic text, expands to <nop>, which prevents expansion of adjacent variables and wikiwords
- When the topic containing this is used as a template for another topic, it is removed.
- Syntax:
%NOP{...}%
deprecated
- In normal topic text, expands to whatever is in the curly braces (if anything).
- Note: This is deprecated. Do not use it. Use
%STARTSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
.. %ENDSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
instead (see TWikiTemplates for more details).
- Related: STARTSECTION, TWikiTemplates
NOTIFYTOPIC -- name of the notify topic
OLIVE -- start olive green colored text
-
OLIVE
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%OLIVE% olive text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: olive text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
ORANGE -- start orange colored text
-
ORANGE
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%ORANGE% orange text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: orange text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
P -- pencil icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: P =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, Q, S, T, U, X, Y
PINK -- start pink colored text
-
PINK
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%PINK% pink text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: pink text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS -- list of plugin descriptions
- Syntax:
%PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS%
- Expands to:
- SpreadSheetPlugin (any TWiki, $Rev: 17387 (11 Aug 2008) $): Add spreadsheet calculation like
"$SUM( $ABOVE() )"
to TWiki tables and other topic text - CommentPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Allows users to quickly post comments to a page without an edit/preview/save cycle
- EditTablePlugin (4.8.4, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Edit TWiki tables using edit fields, date pickers and drop down boxes
- GoogleAnalyticsPlugin (2011-05-14, $Rev: 21272 (2011-05-14) $): Adds Google Analytics javascript code to specified pages
- InterwikiPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 14913 (17 Sep 2007) $): Link
ExternalSite:Page
text to external sites based on aliases defined in a rules topic - PreferencesPlugin (TWiki-4.2, $Rev: 15487 (11 Aug 2008) $): Allows editing of preferences using fields predefined in a form
- SlideShowPlugin (02 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17260 (11 Aug 2008) $): Create web based presentations based on topics with headings.
- SmiliesPlugin (Dakar, $Rev: 16049 (11 Aug 2008) $): Render smilies as icons, like for
:-)
or for :eek:
- TablePlugin (2014-01-21, $Rev: 26934 (2014-01-21) $): Control attributes of tables and sorting of table columns
- TinyMCEPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Integration of TinyMCE? with WysiwygPlugin
- TwistyPlugin (1.4.10, $Rev: 15653 (19 Nov 2007) $): Twisty section JavaScript library to open/close content dynamically
- WysiwygPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17359 (11 Aug 2008) $): Translator framework for Wysiwyg editors
- Related: ACTIVATEDPLUGINS, FAILEDPLUGINS, PLUGINVERSION
PLUGINVERSION -- the version of a TWiki Plugin, or the TWiki Plugins API
- Syntax:
%PLUGINVERSION{"name"}%
to get the version of a specific plugin
- Example:
%PLUGINVERSION{"InterwikiPlugin"}%
expands to $Rev: 14913 (17 Sep 2007) $
- Syntax:
%PLUGINVERSION%
to get the version of the API
- Expands to:
1.2
- Related: WIKIVERSION, ACTIVATEDPLUGINS, FAILEDPLUGINS, PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS
PUBURL -- the base URL of attachments
PUBURLPATH -- the base URL path of attachments
PURPLE -- start purple colored text
-
PURPLE
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%PURPLE% purple text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: purple text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
Q -- question icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: Q =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, P, S, T, U, X, Y
QUERYPARAMS -- show paramaters to the query
- Expands the parameters to the query that was used to display the page.
- Syntax:
%QUERYPARAMS{...}%
- Parameters:
-
format="..."
format string for each entry, default $name=$value
-
separator="..."
separator string, default separator="$n"
(newline)
-
encoding="..."
the encoding to apply to parameter values; see ENCODE for a description of the available encodings. If this parameter is not given, no encoding is performed.
- The following escape sequences are expanded in the format string:
Sequence: |
Expands To: |
$name |
Name of the parameter |
$value |
String value of the parameter. Multi-valued parameters will have a "row" for each value. |
$n or $n() |
New line. Use $n() if followed by alphanumeric character, e.g. write Foo$n()Bar instead of Foo$nBar |
$nop or $nop() |
Is a "no operation". This variable gets removed; useful for nested search |
$quot |
Double quote (" ) (\" also works) |
$percnt |
Percent sign (% ) |
$dollar |
Dollar sign ($ ) |
- Example:
-
%QUERYPARAMS{format="<input type='hidden' name='$name' value='$value' encoding="entity" />"}%
- See also QUERYSTRING, URLPARAM
QUERYSTRING -- full, unprocessed string of parameters to this URL
- String of all the URL parameters that were on the URL used to get to the current page. For example, if you add ?name=Samantha;age=24;eyes=blue to this URL you can see this in action. This string can be appended to a URL to pass parameter values on to another page.
- Note: URLs built this way are typically restricted in length, typically to 2048 characters. If you need more space than this, you will need to use an HTML form and
%QUERYPARAMS%
.
- Syntax:
%QUERYSTRING%
- Expands to:
- Related: QUERYPARAMS, URLPARAM
RED -- start red colored text
-
RED
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%RED% red text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: red text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
REMOTE_ADDR -- environment variable
REMOTE_PORT -- environment variable
REMOTE_USER -- environment variable
RENDERLIST -- render bullet lists in a variety of formats
- The
%RENDERLIST%
variable is handled by the RenderListPlugin
- Syntax:
%RENDERLIST%
- Syntax:
%RENDERLIST{ "org" focus="Sales.WestCoastTeam" }%
- Example:
%RENDERLIST{ "org" }%
* [[Eng.WebHome][Engineering]]
* [[Eng.TechPubs][Tech Pubs]]
* [[Sales.WestCoastTeam][Sales]]
* [[Sales.EastCoastTeam][East Coast]]
* [[Sales.WestCoastTeam][West Coast]]
- Related: RenderListPlugin
REVINFO -- revision information of current topic
REVINFO{"format"} -- formatted revision information of topic
- Syntax:
%REVINFO{"format"}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"format" | Format of revision information, see supported variables below | "r1.$rev - $date - $wikiusername" |
web="..." | Name of web | Current web |
topic="..." | Topic name | Current topic |
rev="1.5" | Specific revison number | Latest revision |
- Supported variables in format:
Variable: | Unit: | Example |
$web | Name of web | Current web |
$topic | Topic name | Current topic |
$rev | Revison number. Prefix r1. to get the usual r1.5 format | 5 |
$username | Login username of revision | jsmith |
$wikiname | WikiName of revision | JohnSmith |
$wikiusername | WikiName with Main web prefix | Main.JohnSmith |
$date | Revision date. Actual date format defined as {DefaultDateFormat} in configure | 21 Sep 2006 |
$time | Revision time | 23:24:25 |
$iso | Revision date in ISO date format | 2006-09-22T06:24:25Z |
$min , $sec , etc. | Same date format qualifiers as GMTIME{"format"} | |
- Example:
%REVINFO{"$date - $wikiusername" rev="1.1"}%
returns revision info of first revision
- Related: GMTIME{"format"}, REVINFO
S -- red star icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: S =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, P, Q, T, U, X, Y
SCRIPTNAME -- name of current script
- The name of the current script is shown, including script suffix, if any (for example
viewauth.cgi
)
- Syntax:
%SCRIPTNAME%
- Expands to:
view
- Related: SCRIPTSUFFIX, SCRIPTURL, SCRIPTURLPATH
SCRIPTSUFFIX -- script suffix
- Some TWiki installations require a file extension for CGI scripts, such as
.pl
or .cgi
- Syntax:
%SCRIPTSUFFIX%
- Expands to:
- Related: SCRIPTNAME, SCRIPTURL, SCRIPTURLPATH
SCRIPTURL -- base URL of TWiki scripts
SCRIPTURL{"script"} -- URL of TWiki script
- Syntax:
%SCRIPTURL{"script"}%
- Expands to:
http://open-services.net/bin/script
- Example: To get the authenticated version of the current topic you can write
%SCRIPTURL{"viewauth"}%/%WEB%/%TOPIC%
which expands to http://open-services.net/bin/viewauth/TWiki/TWikiVariables
- Note: In most cases you should use
%SCRIPTURLPATH{"script"}%
instead, as it works with URL rewriting much better
- Related: PUBURL, SCRIPTNAME, SCRIPTSUFFIX, SCRIPTURL, SCRIPTURLPATH, SCRIPTURLPATH{"script"}
SCRIPTURLPATH -- base URL path of TWiki scripts
- As
%SCRIPTURL%
, but doesn't include the protocol and host part of the URL
- Syntax:
%SCRIPTURLPATH%
- Expands to:
/bin
- Note: The
edit
script should always be used in conjunction with ?t=%GMTIME{"$epoch"}%
to ensure pages about to be edited are not cached in the browser
- Related: PUBURLPATH, SCRIPTNAME, SCRIPTSUFFIX, SCRIPTURL, SCRIPTURLPATH{"script"}
SCRIPTURLPATH{"script"} -- URL path of TWiki script
SEARCH{"text"} -- search content
- Inline search, shows a search result embedded in a topic
- Syntax:
%SEARCH{"text" ...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"text" | Search term. Is a keyword search, literal search, regular expression search, or query, depending on the type parameter. SearchHelp has more | required |
search="text" | (Alternative to above) | N/A |
web="Name" web="Main, Know" web="all" | Comma-separated list of webs to search. You can specifically exclude webs from an all search using a minus sign - for example, web="all,-Secretweb" . The special word all means all webs that do not have the NOSEARCHALL variable set to on in their WebPreferences. Note that TWikiAccessControls are respected when searching webs; it is much better to use them than NOSEARCHALL . | Current web |
topic="WebPreferences" topic="*Bug" | Limit search to topics: A topic, a topic with asterisk wildcards, or a list of topics separated by comma. Note this is a list of topic names and must not include web names. | All topics in a web |
excludetopic="Web*" excludetopic="WebHome, WebChanges" | Exclude topics from search: A topic, a topic with asterisk wildcards, or a list of topics separated by comma. Note this is a list of topic names and must not include web names. | None |
scope="topic" scope="text" scope="all" | Search topic name (title); the text (body) of topic; or all (title and body) | "text" |
type="keyword" type="word" type="literal" type="regex" type="query" | Control how the search is performed when scope="text" or scope="all" keyword : use Google-like controls as in soap "web service" -shampoo ; searches word parts: using the example, topics with "soapsuds" will be found as well, but topics with "shampoos" will be excluded word : identical to keyword but searches whole words: topics with "soapsuds" will not be found, and topics with "shampoos" will not be excluded literal : search for the exact string, like web service regex : use a RegularExpression search like soap;web service;!shampoo ; to search on whole words use \bsoap\b query : query search of form fields and other meta-data, like (Firstname='Emma' OR Firstname='John') AND Lastname='Peel' | %SEARCHVAR- DEFAULTTYPE% preferences setting (literal) |
order="topic" order="created" order="modified" order="editby" order= "formfield(name)" | Sort the results of search by the topic names, topic creation time, last modified time, last editor, or named field of TWikiForms. The sorting is done web by web; if you want to sort across webs, create a formatted table and sort it with TablePlugin's initsort. Note that dates are sorted most recent date last (i.e at the bottom of the table). | Sort by topic name |
limit="all" limit="16" | Limit the number of results returned. This is done after sorting if order is specified | All results |
date="..." | limits the results to those pages with latest edit time in the given time interval. | All results |
reverse="on" | Reverse the direction of the search | Ascending search |
casesensitive="on" | Case sensitive search | Ignore case |
bookview="on" | BookView search, e.g. show complete topic text | Show topic summary |
nonoise="on" | Shorthand for nosummary="on" nosearch="on" nototal="on" zeroresults="off" noheader="on" noempty="on" | Off |
nosummary="on" | Show topic title only | Show topic summary |
nosearch="on" | Suppress search string | Show search string |
noheader="on" | Suppress default search header Topics: Changed: By: , unless a header is explicitly specified | Show default search header, unless search is inline and a format is specified (Cairo compatibility) |
nototal="on" | Do not show number of topics found | Show number |
zeroresults="off" | Suppress all output if there are no hits | zeroresults="on" , displays: "Number of topics: 0" |
noempty="on" | Suppress results for webs that have no hits. | Show webs with no hits |
header="..." format="..." | Custom format results: see FormattedSearch for usage, variables & examples | Results in table |
expandvariables="on" | Expand variables before applying a FormattedSearch on a search hit. Useful to show the expanded text, e.g. to show the result of a SpreadSheetPlugin %CALC{}% instead of the formula | Raw text |
multiple="on" | Multiple hits per topic. Each hit can be formatted. The last token is used in case of a regular expression ";" and search | Only one hit per topic |
nofinalnewline="on" | If on , the search variable does not end in a line by itself. Any text continuing immediately after the search variable on the same line will be rendered as part of the table generated by the search, if appropriate. | off |
recurse="on" | Recurse into subwebs, if subwebs are enabled. | off |
separator=", " | Line separator between search hits | "$n" (Newline) |
newline="%BR%" | Line separator within a search hit. Useful if the format="" parameter contains a $pattern() that captures more than one line, i.e. contents of a textfield in a form. | "$n" (Newline) |
- Example:
%SEARCH{"wiki" web="Main" scope="topic"}%
- Example with format:
%SEARCH{"FAQ" scope="topic" nosearch="on" nototal="on" header="| *Topic: * | *Summary: * |" format="| $topic | $summary |"}%
(displays results in a table with header - details)
- Hint: If the TWiki:Plugins.TablePlugin is installed, you may set a
%TABLE{}%
variable just before the %SEARCH{}%
to alter the output of a search. Example: %TABLE{ tablewidth="90%" }%
- Related: METASEARCH, TOPICLIST, WEBLIST, FormattedSearch, QuerySearch, SearchHelp, SearchPatternCookbook, RegularExpression
SERVERTIME -- server time
SERVERTIME{"format"} -- formatted server time
- Same format qualifiers as
%GMTIME%
- Syntax:
%SERVERTIME{"format"}%
- Example:
%SERVERTIME{"$hou:$min"}%
expands to 21:01
- Note: When used in a template topic, this variable will be expanded when the template is used to create a new topic. See TWikiTemplates#TemplateTopicsVars for details.
- Related: DISPLAYTIME, GMTIME, SERVERTIME
SESSIONID -- unique ID for this session
SESSIONVAR -- name of CGI and session variable that stores the session ID
SESSION_VARIABLE -- get, set or clear a session variable
SILVER -- start silver colored text
-
SILVER
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%SILVER% silver text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: silver text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
SLIDESHOWEND -- end slideshow
SLIDESHOWSTART -- convert a topic with headings into a slideshow
- The
%SLIDESHOWSTART%
variable is handled by the SlideShowPlugin
- Syntax:
%SLIDESHOWSTART%
- Syntax:
%SLIDESHOWSTART{ template="MyOwnSlideTemplate" }%
- Example:
%SLIDESHOWSTART%
---++ Sample Slide 1
* Bullet 1
* Bullet 2
---++ Sample Slide 2
* Bullet 1
* Bullet 2
%SLIDESHOWEND%
- Related: SLIDESHOWEND, SlideShowPlugin
SPACEDTOPIC -- topic name, spaced and URL-encoded deprecated
- The current topic name with added URL-encoded spaces, for use in regular expressions that search for backlinks to the current topic
- Syntax:
%SPACEDTOPIC%
- Expands to:
Var%20*SPACEDTOPIC
- Note: This is a deprecated variable. It can be duplicated with
%ENCODE{%SPACEOUT{"%TOPIC%" separator=" *"}%}%
- Related: SPACEOUT, TOPIC, ENCODE
SPACEOUT{"string"} -- renders string with spaces inserted in sensible places
- Inserts spaces after lower case letters that are followed by a digit or a capital letter, and after digits that are followed by a capital letter.
- Useful for spacing out WikiWords
- Syntax:
%SPACEOUT{ "%TOPIC%" }%
- Expands to:
TWiki Variables
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
separator | The separator to put between words e.g. %SPACEOUT{"DogsCatsBudgies" separator=", "}% -> Dogs, Cats, Budgies | ' ' |
- Hint: Spaced out WikiWords are not automatically linked. To SPACEOUT a WikiWord but preserve the link use "double bracket" format. For example,
[[WebHome][%SPACEOUT{"WebHome"}%]]
expands to Web Home
- Related: SPACEDTOPIC, $PROPERSPACE() of SpreadSheetPlugin
STARTINCLUDE -- start position of topic text if included
- If present in included topic, start to include text from this location up to the end, or up to the location of the
%STOPINCLUDE%
variable. A normal view of the topic shows everything exept the %STARTINCLUDE%
variable itself.
- Note: If you want more than one part of the topic included, use
%STARTSECTION{type="include"}%
instead
- Syntax:
%STARTINCLUDE%
- Related: INCLUDE, STARTSECTION, STOPINCLUDE
STARTSECTION -- marks the start of a section within a topic
- Section boundaries are defined with
%STARTSECTION{}%
and %ENDSECTION{}%
.
- Sections may be given a name to help identify them, and/or a type, which changes how they are used.
-
type="section"
- the default, used for a generic section, such as a named section used by INCLUDE.
-
type="include"
- like %STARTINCLUDE%
... %STOPINCLUDE%
except that you can have as many include blocks as you want (%STARTINCLUDE%
is restricted to only one).
-
type="templateonly"
- start position of text to be removed when a template topic is used. This is used to embed text that you do not want expanded when a new topic based on the template topic is created. See TWikiTemplates for more information.
- Syntax:
%STARTSECTION{"name"}% ................ %ENDSECTION{"name"}%
- Syntax:
%STARTSECTION{type="include"}% ........ %ENDSECTION{type="include"}%
- Syntax:
%STARTSECTION{type="templateonly"}% ... %ENDSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default |
"name" | Name of the section. Must be unique inside a topic. | Generated name |
type="..." | Type of the section; type "section" , "include" or "templateonly" | "section" |
- Note: If a section is not given a name, it will be assigned one. Unnamed sections are assigned names starting with
_SECTION0
for the first unnamed section in the topic, _SECTION1
for the second, etc..
- Note: You can define nested sections. It is not recommended to overlap sections, although it is valid in TWiki. Use named sections to make sure that the correct START and ENDs are matched. Section markers are not displayed when a topic is viewed.
- Related: ENDSECTION, INCLUDE, NOP, STARTINCLUDE, STOPINCLUDE
STATISTICSTOPIC -- name of statistics topic
STOPINCLUDE -- end position of topic text if included
- If present in included topic, stop to include text at this location and ignore the remaining text. A normal view of the topic shows everyting exept the
%STOPINCLUDE%
variable itself.
- Syntax:
%STOPINCLUDE%
- Related: INCLUDE, STARTINCLUDE
SYSTEMWEB -- name of TWiki documentation web
- The web containing all documentation and default preference settings
- Syntax:
%SYSTEMWEB%
- Expands to:
TWiki
- Related: USERSWEB
T -- tip icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: T =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, P, Q, S, U, X, Y
TABLE{ attributes } -- control attributes of tables and sorting of table columns
- The
%TABLE{}%
variable is handled by the TablePlugin
- Syntax:
%TABLE{ attributes }%
- Supported attributes:
Argument | Comment | Default value | Example |
sort | Set table sorting by clicking headers "on" or "off" . | unspecified | sort="on" |
initsort | Column to sort initially ("1" to number of columns). | unspecified | initsort="2" |
initdirection | Initial sorting direction for initsort , set to "up" (descending) or "down" (ascending). | unspecified | initdirection="up" |
disableallsort | Disable all sorting, both initsort and header sort. This is mainly used by plugins such as the EditTablePlugin to disable sorting in a table while editing the table. | unspecified | disableallsort="on" |
headerbg | Header cell background color. | "#6b7f93" | headerbg="#999999" |
headerbgsorted | Header cell background color of a sorted column. | the value of headerbg | headerbgsorted="#32596c" |
headercolor | Header cell text color. | "#ffffff" | headercolor="#0000cc" |
databg | Data cell background color, a comma separated list. Specify "none" for no color, that is to use the color/background of the page the table is on. | "#edf4f9,#ffffff" | databg="#f2f2f2,#ffffff" |
databgsorted | Data cell background color of a sorted column; see databg . | the values of databg | databgsorted="#d4e8e4,#e5f5ea" |
datacolor | Data cell text color, a comma separated list. | unspecified | datacolor="#0000CC, #000000" |
tableborder | Table border width (pixels). | "1" | tableborder="2" |
tableframe | Table frame, set to "void" (no sides), "above" (the top side only), "below" (the bottom side only), "hsides" (the top and bottom sides only), "lhs" (the left-hand side only), "rhs" (the right-hand side only), "vsides" (the right and left sides only), "box" (all four sides), "border" (all four sides). | unspecified | tableframe="hsides" |
tablerules | Table rules, set to "none" (no rules), "groups" (rules will appear between row groups and column groups only), "rows" (rules will appear between rows only), "cols" (rules will appear between columns only), "all" (rules will appear between all rows and columns). | unspecified | tablerules="rows" |
cellpadding | Cell padding (pixels). | "0" | cellpadding="0" |
cellspacing | Cell spacing (pixels). | "0" | cellspacing="3" |
cellborder | Cell border width (pixels). | unspecified | cellborder="0" |
valign | Vertical alignment of cells and headers, set to "top" , "middle" , "bottom" or "baseline" . | unspecified | valign="top" |
headervalign | Vertical alignment of header cells; overrides valign . | unspecified | headervalign="top" |
datavalign | Vertical alignment of data cells; overrides valign . | unspecified | datavalign="top" |
headeralign | Header cell alignment, one value for all columns, or a comma separated list for different alignment of individual columns. Set to "left" , "center" , "right" or "justify" . Overrides individual cell settings. | unspecified | headeralign="left,right" |
dataalign | Data cell alignment, one value for all columns, or a comma separated list for different alignment of individual columns. Set to "left" , "center" , "right" or "justify" . Overrides individual cell settings. | unspecified | dataalign="center" |
tablewidth | Table width: Percentage of window width, or absolute pixel value. | unspecified | tablewidth="100%" |
columnwidths | Column widths: Comma delimited list of column widths, percentage or absolute pixel value. | unspecified | columnwidths="80%,20%" |
headerrows | Number of header rows to exclude from sort. (will be rendered in a HTML thead section) | (determined automatically) | headerrows="2" |
footerrows | Number of footer rows to exclude from sort. (will be rendered in a HTML tfoot section) | "0" | footerrows="1" |
id | Unique table identifier string, used for targeting a table with CSS. | tableN (where N is the table order number on the page) | id="userTable" |
summary | Table summary used by screenreaders: A summary of what the table presents. It should provide an orientation for someone who listens to the table. | unspecified | summary="List of subscribed users" |
caption | Table caption: A title that will be displayed just above the table. | unspecified | caption="Users" |
- Example:
%TABLE{ tableborder="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="3" cellborder="0" }%
| *A1* | *B1* |
| A2 | B2 |
- Category: FormattingAndRenderingVariables? , TablesAndSpreadsheetsVariables?
- Related: See TablePlugin for more details
TEAL -- start teal colored text
-
TEAL
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%TEAL% teal text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: teal text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
TOC -- table of contents of current topic
TOC{"Topic"} -- table of contents
- Table of Contents. Shows a TOC that is generated automatically based on headings of a topic. Headings in WikiSyntax (
"---++ text"
) and HTML ("<h2>text</h2>"
) are taken into account. Any heading text after "!!"
is excluded from the TOC; for example, write "---+!! text"
if you do not want to list a header in the TOC
- Syntax:
%TOC{"SomeTopic" ...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"TopicName" | topic name | Current topic |
web="Name" | Name of web | Current web |
depth="2" | Limit depth of headings shown in TOC | 6 |
title="Some text" | Title to appear at top of TOC | none |
- Example:
%TOC{depth="2"}%
- Example:
%TOC{"TWikiDocumentation" web="TWiki" title="Contents:"}%
- Example: see TWiki:Sandbox.TestTopicInclude
- Hint: TOC will generate links to the headings, so when a reader clicks on a heading it will jump straight where that heading is anchored in the text. If you have two headings with exactly the same text, then their anchors will also be identical and they won't be able to jump to them. To make the anchors unique, you can add an invisible HTML comment to the text of the heading. This will be hidden in normal view, but will force the anchors to be different. For example, ---+ Heading <!--5-->.
- Related: TOC
TOPIC -- name of current topic
-
%TOPIC%
expands to the name of the topic. If you are looking at the text of an included topic, it is the name of the included topic.
- Syntax:
%TOPIC%
- Expands to:
TWikiVariables
, renders as TWikiVariables
- Related: BASETOPIC, INCLUDINGTOPIC, TOPICLIST, WEB
TOPICLIST{"format"} -- topic index of a web
- List of all topics in a web. The "format" defines the format of one topic item. It may include variables: The
$topic
variable gets expanded to the topic name, $marker
to marker
parameter where topic matches selection
, and $web
to the name of the web, or any of the standard FormatTokens.
- Syntax:
%TOPICLIST{"format" ...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"format" | Format of one line, may include $web (name of web), $topic (name of the topic), $marker (which expands to marker for the item matching selection only) | "$topic" |
format="format" | (Alternative to above) | "$topic" |
separator=", " | line separator | "$n" (new line) |
marker="selected" | Text for $marker if the item matches selection | "selected" |
selection="TopicA, TopicB" | Current value to be selected in list | (none) |
web="Name" | Name of web | Current web |
- Example:
%TOPICLIST{" * $web.$topic"}%
creates a bullet list of all topics
- Example:
%TOPICLIST{separator=", "}%
creates a comma separated list of all topics
- Example:
%TOPICLIST{" <option>$topic</option>"}%
creates an option list (for drop down menus)
- Example:
<select>%TOPICLIST{" <option $marker value='$topic'>$topic</option>" separator=" " selection="%TOPIC%"}%</select>
creates an option list of web topics with the current topic selected
- Related: SEARCH, WEBLIST
TOPICURL -- shortcut to viewing the current topic
TWIKIWEB -- synonym for SYSTEMWEB
- Deprecated. Please use
%SYSTEMWEB%
instead.
U -- "updated" icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: U =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, P, Q, S, T, X, Y
URLPARAM{"name"} -- get value of a URL parameter
- Returns the value of a URL parameter.
- Syntax:
%URLPARAM{"name"}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"name" | The name of a URL parameter | required |
default="..." | Default value in case parameter is empty or missing | empty string |
newline="<br />" | Convert newlines in textarea to other delimiters | no conversion |
encode="entity" | Encode special characters into HTML entities. See ENCODE for more details. | no encoding |
encode="url" | Encode special characters for URL parameter use, like a double quote into %22 | no encoding |
encode="quote" | Escape double quotes with backslashes (\" ), does not change other characters; required when feeding URL parameters into other TWiki variables | no encoding |
multiple="on" multiple="[[$item]]" | If set, gets all selected elements of a <select multiple="multiple"> tag. A format can be specified, with $item indicating the element, e.g. multiple="Option: $item" | first element |
separator=", " | Separator between multiple selections. Only relevant if multiple is specified | "\n" (new line) |
- Example:
%URLPARAM{"skin"}%
returns print
for a .../view/TWiki/TWikiVariables?skin=print
URL
- Notes:
- URL parameters passed into HTML form fields must be entity ENCODEd.
- Double quotes in URL parameters must be escaped when passed into other TWiki variables.
Example: %SEARCH{ "%URLPARAM{ "search" encode="quotes" }%" noheader="on" }%
- When used in a template topic, this variable will be expanded when the template is used to create a new topic. See TWikiTemplates#TemplateTopicsVars for details.
- Watch out for TWiki internal parameters, such as
rev
, skin
, template
, topic
, web
; they have a special meaning in TWiki. Common parameters and view script specific parameters are documented at TWikiScripts.
- If you have
%URLPARAM{
in the value of a URL parameter, it will be modified to %<nop>URLPARAM{
. This is to prevent an infinite loop during expansion.
- There is a risk that this variable could be misused for cross-site scripting.
- Related: ENCODE, SEARCH, FormattedSearch, QUERYSTRING
USERINFO{"name"} -- retrieve details about a user
- Syntax:
%USERINFO%
- Expands to:
guest, TWikiGuest,
(comma-separated list of the username, wikiusername, and emails)
- With formatted output, using tokens
$emails
, $username
, $wikiname
, $wikiusername
, $groups
and $admin
($admin returns 'true' or 'false'):
- Example:
%USERINFO{ format="$username is really $wikiname" }%
- Expands to:
guest is really TWikiGuest
- Retrieve information about another user:
- Example:
%USERINFO{ "TWikiGuest" format="$username is really $wikiname" }%
- Expands to:
guest is really TWikiGuest
- Note: The parameter should be the wikiname of a user. Since TWiki 4.2.1, you can also pass a login name. You can only get information about another user if the
{AntiSpam}{HideUserDetails}
configuration option is not enabled, or if you are an admin. (User details are hidden in this TWiki)
- Related: USERNAME, WIKINAME, WIKIUSERNAME, TWikiUserAuthentication, ChangeEmailAddress
USERNAME -- your login username
USERSWEB -- name of users web
- The web containing individual user topics, TWikiGroups, and customised site-wide preferences.
- Syntax:
%USERSWEB%
- Expands to:
Main
- Related: SYSTEMWEB
VAR{"NAME" web="Web"} -- get a preference value from another web
- Syntax:
%VAR{"NAME" web="Web"}%
- Example: To get
%WEBBGCOLOR%
of the Main web write %VAR{"WEBBGCOLOR" web="Main"}%
, which expands to #FFEFA6
- Related: WEBPREFSTOPIC
VBAR -- vertical bar
WEB -- name of current web
-
%WEB%
expands to the name of the web where the topic is located. If you are looking at the text of an included topic, it is the web where the included topic is located.
- Syntax:
%WEB%
- Expands to:
TWiki
- Related: BASEWEB, INCLUDINGWEB, TOPIC
WEBLIST{"format"} -- index of all webs
- List of all webs. Obfusticated webs are excluded, e.g. webs with a
NOSEARCHALL = on
preference variable. The "format"
defines the format of one web item. The $name
variable gets expanded to the name of the web, $qname
gets expanded to double quoted name, $marker
to marker
where web matches selection
.
- Syntax:
%WEBLIST{"format" ...}%
- Supported parameters:
Parameter: | Description: | Default: |
"format" | Format of one line, may include $name (the name of the web), $qname (the name of the web in double quotes), $indentedname (the name of the web with parent web names replaced by indents, for use in indented lists), and $marker (which expands to marker for the item matching selection only) | "$name" |
format="format" | (Alternative to above) | "$name" |
separator=", " | Line separator | "$n" (new line) |
web="" | if you specify $web in format, it will be replaced with this | "" |
webs="public" | Comma separated list of webs, public expands to all non-hidden. NOTE: Administrators will see all webs, not just the public ones | "public" |
marker="selected" | Text for $marker if the item matches selection | "selected" |
selection="%WEB%" | Current value to be selected in list | selection="%WEB%" |
subwebs="Sandbox" | show webs that are a sub-web of this one (recursivly) | "" |
- Example:
%WEBLIST{" * [[$name.WebHome]]"}%
- creates a bullet list of all webs.
- Example:
<form><select name="web"> %WEBLIST{"<option $marker value=$qname>$name</option>" webs="Trash, public" selection="%WEB%" separator=" "}% </select></form>
- creates a dropdown of all public webs + Trash web, with the current web highlighted.
- Related: TOPICLIST, SEARCH
WEBPREFSTOPIC -- name of web preferences topic
WHITE -- start white colored text
-
WHITE
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%WHITE% white text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: white text (shown with a gray background here)
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
WIKIHOMEURL -- site home URL
- Syntax
%WIKIHOMEURL%
- Expands to
/bin/view
- Defined in TWikiPreferences and normally per default set to
%SCRIPTURLPATH{"view"}%
- Note: For the top bar logo URL use
%WIKILOGOURL%
defined in WebPreferences instead.
- Related: WIKITOOLNAME
WIKINAME -- your Wiki username
WIKIPREFSTOPIC -- name of site-wide preferences topic
WIKITOOLNAME -- name of your TWiki site
WIKIUSERNAME -- your Wiki username with web prefix
WIKIUSERSTOPIC -- name of topic listing all registers users
WIKIVERSION -- the version of the installed TWiki engine
X -- warning icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: X =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, P, Q, S, T, U, Y
Y -- "yes" icon
- Type: Preference variable - TWikiRenderingShortcut.
- Current value: Y =
- Related: H, I, ICON, M, N, P, Q, S, T, U, X
YELLOW -- start yellow colored text
-
YELLOW
is one of the rendering shortcut settings predefined in TWikiPreferences. See the section rendering shortcut settings in that topic for a complete list of colors.
- Syntax:
%YELLOW% yellow text %ENDCOLOR%
- Expands to: yellow text
- Note:
%<color>%
text must end with %ENDCOLOR%
. If you want to switch from one color to another one you first need to end the active color with %ENDCOLOR%
, e.g. write %RED% some text %ENDCOLOR% %GREEN% more text %ENDCOLOR%
.
- Related: ENDCOLOR, TWikiPreferences, StandardColors
Back to top
TWiki Formatted Search
Inline search feature allows flexible formatting of search result
The default output format of a
%SEARCH{...}%
is a table consisting of topic names and topic summaries. Use the
format="..."
parameter to customize the search result. The format parameter typically defines a bullet or a table row containing variables, such as
%SEARCH{ "food" format="| $topic | $summary |" }%
. See
%SEARCH{...}%
for other search parameters, such as
separator=""
.
Syntax
Two parameters can be used to specify a customized search result:
1. header="..."
parameter
Use the header parameter to specify the header of a search result. It should correspond to the format of the format parameter. This parameter is optional.
Example:
header="| *Topic:* | *Summary:* |"
Variables that can be used in the header string:
Name: |
Expands To: |
$web |
Name of the web |
$n or $n() |
New line. Use $n() if followed by alphanumeric character, e.g. write Foo$n()Bar instead of Foo$nBar |
$nop or $nop() |
Is a "no operation". This variable gets removed; useful for nested search |
$quot |
Double quote (" ) (\" also works) |
$percnt |
Percent sign (% ) |
$dollar |
Dollar sign ($ ) |
2. format="..."
parameter
Use the format parameter to specify the format of one search hit.
Example:
format="| $topic | $summary |"
Variables that can be used in the format string:
Name: |
Expands To: |
$web |
Name of the web |
$topic |
Topic name |
$topic(20) |
Topic name, "- " hyphenated each 20 characters |
$topic(30, -<br />) |
Topic name, hyphenated each 30 characters with separator "-<br />" |
$topic(40, ...) |
Topic name, shortended to 40 characters with "..." indication |
$parent |
Name of parent topic; empty if not set |
$parent(20) |
Name of parent topic, same hyphenation/shortening like $topic() |
$text |
Formatted topic text. In case of a multiple="on" search, it is the line found for each search hit. |
$locked |
LOCKED flag (if any) |
$date |
Time stamp of last topic update, e.g. 17 Jul 2018 - 01:01 |
$isodate |
Time stamp of last topic update, e.g. 2018-07-17T01:01Z |
$rev |
Number of last topic revision, e.g. 4 |
$username |
Login name of last topic update, e.g. jsmith |
$wikiname |
Wiki user name of last topic update, e.g. JohnSmith |
$wikiusername |
Wiki user name of last topic update, like Main.JohnSmith |
$createdate |
Time stamp of topic revision 1 |
$createusername |
Login name of topic revision 1, e.g. jsmith |
$createwikiname |
Wiki user name of topic revision 1, e.g. JohnSmith |
$createwikiusername |
Wiki user name of topic revision 1, e.g. Main.JohnSmith |
$summary |
Topic summary, just the plain text, all formatting and line breaks removed; up to 162 characters |
$summary(50) |
Topic summary, up to 50 characters shown |
$summary(showvarnames) |
Topic summary, with %ALLTWIKI{...}% variables shown as ALLTWIKI{...} |
$summary(noheader) |
Topic summary, with leading ---+ headers removed Note: The tokens can be combined, for example $summary(100, showvarnames, noheader) |
$changes |
Summary of changes between latest rev and previous rev |
$changes(n) |
Summary of changes between latest rev and rev n |
$formname |
The name of the form attached to the topic; empty if none |
$formfield(name) |
The field value of a form field; for example, $formfield(TopicClassification) would get expanded to PublicFAQ . This applies only to topics that have a TWikiForm |
$formfield(name, 10) |
Form field value, "- " hyphenated each 10 characters |
$formfield(name, 20, -<br />) |
Form field value, hyphenated each 20 characters with separator "-<br />" |
$formfield(name, 30, ...) |
Form field value, shortended to 30 characters with "..." indication |
$pattern(reg-exp) |
A regular expression pattern to extract some text from a topic (does not search meta data; use $formfield instead). In case of a multiple="on" search, the pattern is applied to the line found in each search hit. • Specify a RegularExpression that covers the whole text (topic or line), which typically starts with .* , and must end in .* • Put text you want to keep in parenthesis, like $pattern(.*?(from here.*?to here).*) • Example: $pattern(.*?\*.*?Email\:\s*([^\n\r]+).*) extracts the e-mail address from a bullet of format * Email: ... • This example has non-greedy .*? patterns to scan for the first occurance of the Email bullet; use greedy .* patterns to scan for the last occurance • Limitation: Do not use .*) inside the pattern, e.g. $pattern(.*foo(.*)bar.*) does not work, but $pattern(.*foo(.*?)bar.*) does • Note: Make sure that the integrity of a web page is not compromised; for example, if you include an HTML table make sure to include everything including the table end tag |
$count(reg-exp) |
Count of number of times a regular expression pattern appears in the text of a topic (does not search meta data). Follows guidelines for use and limitations outlined above under $pattern(reg-exp) . Example: $count(.*?(---[+][+][+][+]) .*) counts the number of <H4> headers in a page. |
$n or $n() |
New line. Use $n() if followed by alphanumeric character, e.g. write Foo$n()Bar instead of Foo$nBar |
$nop or $nop() |
Is a "no operation". This variable gets removed; useful for nested search |
$quot |
Double quote (" ) (\" also works) |
$percnt |
Percent sign (% ) |
$dollar |
Dollar sign ($ ) |
Examples
Here are some samples of formatted searches. The
SearchPatternCookbook has other examples, such as
creating a picklist of usernames,
searching for topic children and more.
Bullet list showing topic name and summary
Write this:
%SEARCH{ "FAQ" scope="topic" nosearch="on" nototal="on" header=" * *Topic: Summary:*" format=" * [[$topic]]: $summary" }%
To get this:
- Topic: Summary:
- TWikiFAQ: Frequently Asked Questions About TWiki This is a real FAQ, and also a demo of an easily implemented knowledge base solution. To see how it's done, view the source ...
- TWikiFaqTemplate: FAQ: Answer: Back to: TWikiFAQ
- TextFormattingFAQ: Text Formatting FAQ The most frequently asked questions about text formatting are answered. Also, TextFormattingRules contains the complete TWiki shorthand system ...
Table showing form field values of topics with a form
In a web where there is a form that contains a
TopicClassification
field, an
OperatingSystem
field and an
OsVersion
field we could write:
| *Topic:* | *OperatingSystem:* | *OsVersion:* |
%SEARCH{ "[T]opicClassification.*?value=\"[P]ublicFAQ\"" scope="text" type="regex" nosearch="on" nototal="on" format="| [[$topic]] | $formfield(OperatingSystem) | $formfield(OsVersion) |" }%
To get this:
Extract some text from a topic using regular expression
Write this:
%SEARCH{ "__Back to\:__ TWikiFAQ" scope="text" type="regex" nosearch="on" nototal="on" header="TWiki FAQs:" format=" * $pattern(.*?FAQ\:[\n\r]*([^\n\r]+).*) [[$topic][Answer...]]" }%
To get this:
TWiki FAQs:
- How can I create a simple TWiki Form based application? Answer...
- How do I delete or rename a topic? Answer...
- How do I delete or rename a file attachment? Answer...
- Why does the topic revision not increase when I edit a topic? Answer...
- TWiki has a GPL (GNU General Public License). What is GPL? Answer...
- I've problems with the WebSearch. There is no Search Result on any inquiry. By clicking the Index topic it's the same problem. Answer...
- What happens if two of us try to edit the same topic simultaneously? Answer...
- I would like to install TWiki on my server. Can I get the source? Answer...
- What does the "T" in TWiki stand for? Answer...
- So what is this WikiWiki thing exactly? Answer...
- Everybody can edit any page, this is scary. Doesn't that lead to chaos? Answer...
Nested Search
Search can be nested. For example, search for some topics, then form a new search for each topic found in the first search. The idea is to build the nested search string using a formatted search in the first search.
Here is an example. Let's search for all topics that contain the word "culture" (first search), and let's find out where each topic found is linked from (second search).
- First search:
-
%SEARCH{ "culture" format=" * $topic is referenced by: (list all references)" nosearch="on" nototal="on" }%
- Second search. For each hit we want this search:
-
%SEARCH{ "(topic found in first search)" format="$topic" nosearch="on" nototal="on" separator=", " }%
- Now let's nest the two. We need to escape the second search, e.g. the first search will build a valid second search string. Note that we escape the second search so that it does not get evaluated prematurely by the first search:
- Use
$percnt
to escape the leading percent of the second search
- Use
\"
to escape the double quotes
- Use
$dollar
to escape the $
of $topic
- Use
$nop
to escape the }%
sequence
Write this:
%SEARCH{ "culture" format=" * $topic is referenced by:$n * $percntSEARCH{ \"$topic\" format=\"$dollartopic\" nosearch=\"on\" nototal=\"on\" separator=\", \" }$nop%" nosearch="on" nototal="on" }%
To get this:
- ATasteOfTWiki is referenced by:
- FormattedSearch is referenced by:
- BlackListPlugin, EditTablePlugin, EmptyPlugin, FormatTokens, InterwikiPlugin, PreferencesPlugin, QuerySearch, RenderListPlugin, SearchHelp, SearchPatternCookbook, SlideShowPlugin, SmiliesPlugin, SpreadSheetPlugin, TWikiAccessControl, TWikiDocumentation, TWikiForms, TWikiHistory, TWikiMetaData, TWikiReferenceManual, TWikiReleaseNotes04x00, TWikiReleaseNotes04x01, TWikiScripts, TWikiSearchDotPm, TWikiSiteTools, TWikiUISearchDotPm, TwistyPlugin, VarMETA, VarMETASEARCH, VarSEARCH, VarURLPARAM, WebLeftBar, WelcomeGuest
- TWikiAccessControl is referenced by:
- EditTablePlugin, FileAttachment, MainFeatures, ManagingTopics, ManagingUsers, SitePermissions, SourceCode, TWikiAccessControl, TWikiDocumentation, TWikiForms, TWikiFuncDotPm, TWikiHistory, TWikiPreferences, TWikiReferenceManual, TWikiReleaseNotes04x01, TWikiReleaseNotes04x02, TWikiScripts, TWikiSiteTools, TWikiTopics, TWikiTutorial, TWikiUserAuthentication, TWikiVariables, VarSEARCH, WebPreferences, WebPreferencesHelp, WikiCulture, WikiWord
- TWikiSite is referenced by:
- AdminToolsCategory, InstantEnhancements, InterwikiPlugin, ManagingWebs, StartingPoints, TWikiDocumentation, TWikiGlossary, TWikiI18NDotPm, TWikiInstallationGuide, TWikiPreferences, TWikiReferenceManual, TWikiReleaseNotes04x02, TWikiScripts, TWikiSite, TWikiTopics, TWikiTutorial, TWikiUserAuthentication, TWikiUsersGuide, WabiSabi, WebLeftBar, WebSiteTools, WebStatistics, WelcomeGuest, WhatDoesTWikiStandFor, WhatIsWikiWiki, WikiCulture, WikiReferences
- WabiSabi is referenced by:
- WhatIsWikiWiki is referenced by:
- WikiCulture is referenced by:
Note: Nested search can be slow, especially if you nest more then 3 times. Nesting is limited to 16 levels. For each new nesting level you need to "escape the escapes", e.g. write
$dollarpercntSEARCH{
for level three,
$dollardollarpercntSEARCH{
for level four, etc.
Most recently changed pages
Write this:
%SEARCH{ "\.*" scope="topic" type="regex" nosearch="on" nototal="on" order="modified" reverse="on" format="| [[$topic]] | $wikiusername | $date |" limit="7" }%
To get this:
Search with conditional output
A regular expression search is flexible, but there are limitations. For example, you cannot show all topics that are up to exactly one week old, or create a report that shows all records with invalid form fields or fields within a certain range, etc. You need some additional logic to format output based on a condition:
- Specify a search which returns more hits then you need
- For each search hit apply a spreadsheet formula to determine if the hit is needed
- If needed, format and output the result
- Else supress the search hit
This requires the
TWiki:Plugins.SpreadSheetPlugin. The following example shows all topics that are up to exactly one week old.
Write this:
%CALC{$SET(weekold, $TIMEADD($TIME(), -7, day))}%
%SEARCH{ "." scope="topic" type="regex" nosearch="on" nototal="on" order="modified" reverse="on" format="$percntCALC{$IF($TIME($date) < $GET(weekold), <nop>, | [[$topic]] | $wikiusername | $date | $rev |)}$percnt" limit="100" }%
- The first line sets the
weekold
variable to the serialized date of exactly one week ago
- The SEARCH has a deferred CALC. The
$percnt
makes sure that the CALC gets executed once for each search hit
- The CALC compares the date of the topic with the
weekold
date
- If topic is older, a
<nop>
is returned, which gets removed at the end of the TWiki rendering process
- Otherwise, the search hit is formatted and returned
To get this:
Embedding search forms to return a formatted result
Use an HTML form and an embedded formatted search on the same topic. You can link them together with an
%URLPARAM{"..."}%
variable. Example:
Write this:
<form action="%SCRIPTURLPATH{"view"}%/%WEB%/%TOPIC%">
Find Topics:
<input type="text" name="q" size="32" value="%URLPARAM{"q"}%" /> <input type="submit" class="twikiSubmit" value="Search" />
</form>
Result:
%SEARCH{ search="%URLPARAM{"q"}%" format=" * $web.$topic: %BR% $summary" nosearch="on" }%
To get this:
Result:
Related Topics: UserDocumentationCategory,
SearchHelp,
TWikiVariables#VarSEARCH,
SearchPatternCookbook,
RegularExpression
--
Contributors: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny,
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie
Back to top
File Attachments
Each topic can have one or more files of any type attached to it by using the Attach screen to upload (or download) files from your local PC. Attachments are stored under revision control: uploads are automatically backed up; all previous versions of a modified file can be retrieved.
What Are Attachments Good For?
File Attachments can be used to archive data, or to create powerful customized groupware solutions, like file sharing and document management systems, and quick Web page authoring.
Document Management System
- You can use Attachments to store and retrieve documents (in any format, with associated graphics, and other media files); attach documents to specific TWiki topics; collaborate on documents with full revision control; distribute documents on a need-to-know basis using web and topic-level access control; create a central reference library that's easy to share with an user group spread around the world.
File Sharing
- For file sharing, FileAttachments on a series of topics can be used to quickly create a well-documented, categorized digital download center for all types of files: documents; graphics and other media; drivers and patches; applications; anything you can safely upload!
Web Authoring
- Through your Web browser, you can easily upload graphics (or sound files, or anything else you want to link to on a page) and place them on a single page, or use them across a web, or site-wide.
- NOTE: You can also add graphics - any files - directly, typically by FTP upload. This requires FTP access, and may be more convenient if you have a large number of files to load. FTP-ed files can't be managed using browser-based Attachment controls. You can use your browser to create TWikiVariables shortcuts, like this %H% = .
Uploading Files
- Click on the
Attach
link at the bottom of the page. The Attach
screen lets you browse for a file, add a comment, and upload it. The uploaded file will show up in the File Attachment table.
- NOTE: The topic must already exist. It is a two step process if you want to attach a file to a non-existing topic; first create the topic, then add the file attachment.
- Any type of file can be uploaded. Some files that might pose a security risk are renamed, ex:
*.php
files are renamed to *.php.txt
so that no one can place code that would be read in a .php file.
- The previous upload path is retained for convenience. In case you make some changes to the local file and want to upload it, again you can copy the previous upload path into the Local file field.
- TWiki can limit the file size. This is defined by the
%ATTACHFILESIZELIMIT%
variable of the TWikiPreferences, currently set at 10000 KB.
- It's not recommended to upload files greater than a few hundred K through a browser. Large files can be extremely slow-loading, and often time out. Use an FTP site for large file uploads.
- Automatic attachments:
- When enabled, all files in a topic's attachment directory are shown as attachments to the topic - even if they were directly copied to the directory and never attached by using an 'Attach' link. This is a convenient way to quickly "attach" files to a topic without uploading them one by one; although at the cost of losing audit trail and version control.
- To enable this feature, set the {AutoAttachPubFiles} configuration option.
- NOTE: The automatic attachment feature can only be used by an administrator who has access to the server's file system.
Downloading Files
- NOTE: There is no access control on individual attachments. If you need control over single files, create a separate topic per file and set topic-level access restrictions for each.
Moving Attachment Files
An attachment can be moved between topics.
- Click
Manage
on the Attachment to be moved.
- On the control screen, select the new web and/or topic.
- Click
Move
. The attachment and its version history are moved. The original location is stored as topic Meta Data.
Deleting Attachments
Move unwanted Attachments to web
Trash
, topic
TrashAttachment
.
Linking to Attached Files
- Once a file is attached it can be referenced in the topic. Example:
-
Attach
file: Sample.txt
-
Edit
topic and enter: %ATTACHURL%/Sample.txt
-
Preview
: %ATTACHURL%/Sample.txt
text appears as: /pub/TWiki/FileAttachment/Sample.txt, a link to the text file.
- To reference an attachment located in another topic, enter:
-
%PUBURLPATH%/%WEB%/OtherTopic/Sample.txt
(if it's within the same web)
-
%PUBURLPATH%/Otherweb/OtherTopic/Sample.txt
(if it's in a different web)
- Attached HTML files and text files can be inlined in a topic. Example:
-
Attach
file: Sample.txt
-
Edit
topic and write text: %INCLUDE{"%ATTACHURL%/Sample.txt"}%
- Content of attached file is shown inlined.
- Read more about INCLUDE in TWikiVariables
- GIF, JPG and PNG images can be attached and shown embedded in a topic. Example:
-
Attach
file: Smile.gif
-
Edit
topic and write text: %ATTACHURL%/Smile.gif
-
Preview
: text appears as /pub/TWiki/FileAttachment/Smile.gif, an image.
File Attachment Contents Table
Files attached to a topic are displayed in a directory table, displayed at the bottom of the page, or optionally, hidden and accessed when you click
Attach.
File Attachment Controls
Clicking on a
Manage
link takes you to a new page that looks a bit like this (depending on what
skin is selected):
- The first table is a list of all attachments, including their attributes. An
h
means the attachment is hidden, it isn't listed when viewing a topic.
- The second table is all the versions of the attachment. Click on View to see that version. If it's the most recent version, you'll be taken to an URL that always displays the latest version, which is usually what you want.
- To change the comment on an attachment, enter a new comment and then click Change properties. Note that the comment listed against the specific version will not change, however the comment displayed when viewing the topic does change.
- To hide/unhide an attachment, enable the
Hide file
checkbox, then click Change properties
.
Known Issues
- Unlike topics, attachments are not locked during editing. As a workaround, you can change the comment to indicate an attachment file is being worked on - the comment on the specific version isn't lost, it's there when you list all versions of the attachment.
- Attachments are not secured. Anyone can read them if they know the name of the web, topic and attachment.
Back to top
TWiki Forms
Add structure to content with forms attached to twiki topics. TWiki forms (with form fields) and formatted search are the base for building database applications.
Overview
By adding form-based input to freeform content, you can structure topics with unlimited, easily searchable categories. A form is enabled for a web and can be added to a topic. The form data is shown in tabular format when the topic is viewed, and can be changed in edit mode using edit fields, radio buttons, check boxes and list boxes. Many different form types can be defined in a web, though a topic can only have one form attached to it at a time.
Typical steps to build an application based on TWiki forms:
- Define a form template
- Enable the form for a web
- Add the form to a template topic
- Build an HTML form to create new topics based on that template topic
- Build a FormattedSearch to list topics that share the same form
Defining a Form
A Form Template specifies the fields in a form. A Form Template is simply a page containing a TWiki table, where each row of the table specifies one form field.
- Create a new topic with your form name:
YourForm
, ExpenseReportForm
, InfoCategoryForm
, RecordReviewForm
, whatever you need.
- Create a TWiki table, with each column representing one element of an entry field:
Name
, Type
, Size
, Values
, Tooltip message
, and Attributes
(see sample below).
- For each field, fill in a new line; for the type of field, select from the list.
- Save the topic (you can later choose to enable/disable individual forms).
Example:
| *Name* | *Type* | *Size* | *Values* | *Tooltip message* | *Attributes* |
| TopicClassification | select | 1 | NoDisclosure, PublicSupported, PublicFAQ | blah blah... | |
| OperatingSystem | checkbox | 3 | OsHPUX, OsLinux, OsSolaris, OsWin | blah blah... | |
| OsVersion | text | 16 | | blah blah... | |
See
structure of a form for full details of what types are available and what all the columns mean.
You can also retrieve possible values for
select
,
checkbox
or
radio
types from other topics:
Example:
- In the WebForm topic, define the form:
Leave the Values
field blank.
- Then in the TopicClassification topic, define the possible values:
| *Name* |
| NoDisclosure |
| Public Supported |
| Public FAQ |
Name |
NoDisclosure |
Public Supported |
Public FAQ |
Field values can also be set using the result of expanding other TWiki variables. For example,
%SEARCH{"Office$" scope="topic" web="%USERSWEB%" nonoise="on" type="regex" format="$web.$topic" separator=", " }%
When used in the value field of the form definition, this will find all topic names in the Main web which end in "Office" and use them as the legal field values.
Enabling Forms by Web
Forms have to be enabled for each individual web. The
WEBFORMS
variable in
WebPreferences is optional and defines a list of possible form templates.
Example:
- Set WEBFORMS = BugForm, FeatureForm, Books.BookLoanForm
- With
WEBFORMS
enabled, an extra button is added to the edit view. If the topic doesn't have a Form, an Add Form button appears at the end of the topic. If a Form is present, a Change button appears in the top row of the Form. The buttons open a screen that enables selection of a form specified in WEBFORMS
, or the No form option.
- You have to list the available form topics explicitly. You cannot use a
SEARCH
to define WEBFORMS
.
Adding a form to a topic
- Edit the topic and follow the "Add form" button to add a Form. This is typically done to a template topic, either to the
WebTopicEditTemplate
topic in a web, or a new topic that serves as an application specific template topic. Initial Form values can be set there.
- Additionally a new topic can be given a Form using the
formtemplate
parameter in the (edit or save) URL. Initial values can then be provided in the URLs or as form values:
- Tip: For TWiki applications you can automatically generate unique topicnames.
- Note: Initial values will not be set in the form of a new topic if you only use the formtemplate parameter.
Changing a form
- You can change a form definition, and TWiki will try to make sure you don't lose any data from the topics that use that form.
- If you change the form definition, the changes will not take affect in a topic that uses that form until you edit and save it.
- If you add a new field to the form, then it will appear next time you edit a topic that uses the form.
- If you delete a field from the form, or change a field name, then the data will not be visible when you edit the topic (the changed form definition will be used). If you save the topic, the old data will be lost (though thanks to revision control, you can always see it in older versions of the topic)
- If two people edit the same topic containing a form at exactly the same time, and both change fields in the form, TWiki will try to merge the changes so that no data is lost.
Structure of a Form Template
A Form Template specifies the fields in a form. A Form Template is simply a page containing a TWiki table, where each row of the table specifies one form field.
Each
column of the table is one element of an entry field:
Name
,
Type
,
Size
,
Values
,
Tooltip message
, and
Attributes
.
The
Name
,
Type
and
Size
columns are required. Other columns are optional. The form
must have a header row (e.g.
| *Name* | *Type* | *Size* |
).
Name
is the name of the form field.
The
Type
,
Size
and
Value
fields describe the legal values for this field, and how to display them.
-
Type
checkbox
specifies one or more checkboxes. The Size
field specifies how many checkboxes will be displayed on each line. The Value
field should be a comma-separated list of item labels.
-
Type
checkbox+buttons
will add Set and Clear buttons to the basic checkbox
type.
-
Type
radio
is like checkbox
except that radio buttons are mutually exclusive; only one can be selected.
-
Type
label
specifies read-only label text. The Value
field should contain the text of the label.
-
Type
select
specifies a select box. The Value
field should contain a comma-separated list of options for the box. The Size
field can specify a fixed size for the box (e.g. 1
, or a range e.g. 3..10
. If you specify a range, then the box will never be smaller than 3 items, never larger than 10, and will be 5 high if there are only 5 options.
- There are two modifiers that can be applied to the
select
type:
-
Type
text
specifies a one-line text field. Size
specifies the text box width in number of characters. Value
is the initial (default) content when a new topic is created with this form template.
-
Type
textarea
specifies a multi-line text box. The Size
field should specify columns x rows, e.g. 80x6
; default size is 40x5. As for text
, the Value
field specifies the initial text
-
Type
date
specifies a single-line text box and a button next to it; clicking on the button will bring up a calendar from which the user can select a date. The date can also be typed into the text box. Size
specifies the text box width in characters. As for text
, the Value
field specifies the initial text
Tooltip message
is a message that will be displayed when the cursor is hovered over the field in
edit
view.
Attributes
specifies special attributes for the field. Multiple attributes can be entered, separated by spaces.
- An attribute
H
indicates that this field should not be shown in view mode. However, the field is available for editing and storing information.
- An attribute
M
indicates that this field is mandatory. The topic cannot be saved unless a value is provided for this field. If the field is found empty during topic save, an error is raised and the user is redirected to an oops
page. Mandatory fields are indicated by an asterisks next to the field name.
For example, a simple form just supporting entry of a name and a date would look as follows:
| *Name* | *Type* | *Size* |
| Name | text | 80 |
| Date | date | 30 |
Field Name Notes:
- Field names have to be unique.
- A very few field names are reserved. If you try to use one of these names, TWiki will automatically append an underscore to the name when the form is used.
- You can space out the title of the field, and it will still find the topic e.g.
Aeroplane Manufacturers
is equivalent to AeroplaneManufacturers
.
- If a
label
field has no name, it will not be shown when the form is viewed, only when it is edited.
- Field names can in theory include any text, but you should stick to alphanumeric characters. If you want to use a non-wikiname for a
select
, checkbox
or radio
field, and want to get the values from another topic, you can use [[...]]
links. This notation can also be used when referencing another topic to obtain field values, but a name other than the topic name is required as the name of the field.
- Leading and trailing spaces are not significant.
Field Value Notes:
- The field value will be used to initialize a field when a form is created, unless specific values are given by the topic template or query parameters. The first item in the list for a select or radio type is the default item. For
label
, text
, and textarea
fields the value may also contain commas. checkbox
fields cannot be initialized through the form template.
- Leading and trailing spaces are not significant.
- Field values can also be generated through a FormattedSearch, which must yield a suitable table as the result.
- Variables in the initial values of a form definition get expanded when the form definition is loaded.
- If you want to use a
|
character in the initial values field, you have to precede it with a backslash, thus: \|
.
- You can use
<nop>
to prevent TWiki variables from being expanded.
- The FormatTokens can be used to prevent expansion of other characters.
General Notes:
- The topic definition is not read when a topic is viewed.
- Form definition topics can be protected in the usual manner, using TWikiAccessControl, to limit who can change the form template and/or individual value lists. Note that view access is required to be able to edit topics that use the form definition, though view access to the form definition is not required to view a topic where the form has been used.
Values in Other Topics
As described above, you can also retrieve possible values for select, checkbox or radio types from other topics. For example, if you have a rows defined like this:
| *Name* | *Type* | *Size* |
| AeroplaneManufacturers | select | |
the TWiki will look for the topic AeroplaneManufacturers to get the possible values for the
select
.
The AeroplaneManufacturers topic must contain a table, where each row of the table describes a possible value. The table only requires one column,
Name
. Other columns may be present, but are ignored.
For example:
| *Name* |
| Routan |
| Focke-Wulf |
| De Havilland |
Notes:
- The
Values
column must be empty in the referring form definition.
Extending the range of form data types
You can extend the range of data types accepted by forms by using
TWikiPlugins. All such extended data types are single-valued (can only have one value) with the following exceptions:
- any type name starting with
checkbox
- any type name with
+multi
anywhere in the name
Types with names like this can both take multiple values.
Hints and Tips
Build an HTML form to create new Form-based topics
- New topics with a form are created by simple HTML forms asking for a topic name. For example, you can have a
SubmitExpenseReport
topic where you can create new expense reports, a SubmitVacationRequest
topic, and so on. These can specify the required template topic with its associated form. Template topics has more.
A Form Template specifies the fields in a form. A Form Template is simply a page containing a TWiki table, where each row of the table specifies one form field.
Searching for Form Data
TWiki Forms accept user-input data, stored as
TWikiMetaData. Meta data also contains program-generated info about changes, attachments, etc. To find, format and display form and other meta data, see
TWikiMetaData,
FORMFIELD
,
SEARCH
and
METASEARCH
variables in
TWikiVariables, and
TWiki Formatted Search.
Example
TWiki users often want to have an overview of topics they contributed to. With the $formfield
parameter it is easy to display the value of a classification field next to the topic link:
| *Topic* | *Classification* |
%SEARCH{"%USERSWEB%.UserName" scope="text" nosearch="on" nototal="on" order="modified" reverse="on"
format="|<b>[[$web.$topic][$topic]]</b> |<nop>$formfield(TopicClassification) |" web="Sandbox"}%
Searching forms this way is obviously pretty inefficient, but it's easy to do. If you want better performance, take a look at some of the structured wiki extensions that support higher performance searching e.g.
TWiki:Plugins.DBCachePlugin.
Gotcha!
- Some browsers may strip linefeeds from
text
fields when a topic is saved. If you need linefeeds in a field, make sure it is a textarea
.
Back to top
TWiki Templates
Definition of the templates used to render all HTML pages displayed in TWiki
Overview
Templates are plain text with embedded
template directives that tell TWiki how to compose blocks of text together, to create something new.
There are two types of template:
- Master Templates: Define the HTML used to display TWiki pages.
- Template Topics: Define default text when you create a new topic
Tip: TWiki:TWiki.TWikiTemplatesSupplement on TWiki.org has supplemental documentation on TWiki templates.
Master Templates
TWiki uses master templates when composing the output from all actions, like topic view, edit, and preview. This allows you to change the look and feel of all pages by editing just a few template files.
Master templates are also used in the definition of
TWikiSkins.
Master templates are stored as text files with the extension
.tmpl
. They are usually HTML with embedded
template directives. The directives are expanded when TWiki wants to generate a user interface screen.
How Template Directives Work
- Directives are of the form
%TMPL:<key>%
and %TMPL:<key>{"attr"}%
.
- Directives:
-
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"file"}%
: Includes a template file. The file is found as described below.
-
%TMPL:DEF{"block"}%
: Define a block. All text between this and the next %TMPL:END%
directive is removed and saved for later use with %TMPL:P
.
-
%TMPL:END%
: Ends a block definition.
-
%TMPL:P{"var"}%
: Includes a previously defined block.
-
%{...}%
: is a comment.
- Two-pass processing lets you use a variable before or after declaring it.
- Templates and TWikiSkins work transparently and interchangeably. For example, you can create a skin that overloads only the
twiki.tmpl
master template, like twiki.print.tmpl
, that redefines the header and footer.
- Use of template directives is optional: templates work without them.
- NOTE: Template directives work only for templates: they do not get processed in normal topic text.
TMPL:P also supports simple parameters. For example, given the definition
%TMPL:DEF{"x"}% x%P%z%TMPL:END%
then
%TMPL:P{"x" P="y"}%
will expand to
xyz
.
Note that parameters can simply be ignored; for example,
%TMPL:P{"x"}%
will expand to x%P%z.
Any alphanumeric characters can be used in parameter names. You are highly recommended to use parameter names that cannot be confused with
TWikiVariables.
Note that three parameter names,
context
,
then
and
else
are
reserved. They are used to support a limited form of "if" condition that you can use to select which of two templates to use, based on a
context identifier:
%TMPL:DEF{"link_inactive"}%<input type="button" disabled value="Link>%TMPL:END%
%TMPL:DEF{"link_active"}%<input type="button" onclick="link()" value="Link" />%TMPL:END%
%TMPL:P{context="inactive" then="inactive_link" else="active_link"}% for %CONTEXT%
When the "inactive" context is set, then this will expand the "link_inactive" template; otherwise it will expand the "link_active" template.
See
IfStatements for details of supported context identifiers.
Finding Templates
The master templates shipped with a twiki release are stored in the twiki/templates directory. As an example,
twiki/templates/view.tmpl
is the default template file for the
twiki/bin/view
script.
You can save templates in other directories as long as they are listed in the
{TemplatePath}
configuration setting. The
{TemplatePath}
is defined in the Miscellaneous section of the
configure page.
You can also save templates in user topics. The
{TemplatePath}
configuration setting defines which topics will be accepted as templates.
Templates that are included with an explicit
'.tmpl'
extension are looked for only in the
templates/
directory. For instance
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"example.tmpl"}%
will only return
templates/example.tmpl
, regardless of
{TemplatePath}
and SKIN settings.
The out-of-the-box setting of
{TemplatePath}
supports the following search order to determine which template file or topic to use for a particular script or
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"script"}%
statement. The
skin path is set as described in
TWikiSkins.
- templates/web/script.skin.tmpl for each skin on the skin path
- this usage is supported for compatibility only and is deprecated. Store web-specific templates in TWiki topics instead.
- templates/script.skin.tmpl for each skin on the skin path
- templates/web/script.tmpl
- this usage is supported for compatibility only and is deprecated. Store web-specific templates in TWiki topics instead.
- templates/script.tmpl
- The TWiki topic aweb.atopic if the template name can be parsed into aweb.atopic
- The TWiki topic web.SkinSkinScriptTemplate for each skin on the skin path
- The TWiki topic web.ScriptTemplate
- The TWiki topic %SYSTEMWEB%.SkinSkinScriptTemplate for each skin on the skin path
- The TWiki topic %SYSTEMWEB%.ScriptTemplate
Legend:
- script refers to the script name, e.g
view
, edit
- Script refers to the same, but with the first character capitalized, e.g
View
- skin refers to a skin name, e.g
dragon
, pattern
. All skins are checked at each stage, in the order they appear in the skin path.
- Skin refers to the same, but with the first character capitalized, e.g
Dragon
- web refers to the current web
For example, the
example
template file will be searched for in the following places, when the current web is
Thisweb
and the skin path is
print,pattern
:
-
templates/Thisweb/example.print.tmpl
deprecated; don't rely on it
-
templates/Thisweb/example.pattern.tmpl
deprecated; don't rely on it
-
templates/example.print.tmpl
-
templates/example.pattern.tmpl
-
templates/Thisweb/example.tmpl
deprecated; don't rely on it
-
templates/example.tmpl
-
Thisweb.PrintSkinExampleTemplate
-
Thisweb.PatternSkinExampleTemplate
-
Thisweb.ExampleTemplate
-
TWiki.PrintSkinExampleTemplate
-
TWiki.PatternSkinExampleTemplate
-
TWiki.ExampleTemplate
Template names are usually derived from the name of the currently executing script; however it is also possible to override these settings in the
view
and
edit
scripts, for example when a topic-specific template is required. Two preference variables can be used to override the templates used:
-
VIEW_TEMPLATE
sets the template to be used for viewing a topic
-
EDIT_TEMPLATE
sets the template for editing a topic.
If these preferences are set locally (using
Local instead of
Set) for a topic, in
WebPreferences, in
Main.TWikiPreferences, or
TWiki.TWikiPreferences (using
Set), the indicated templates will be chosen for
view
and
edit
respectively. The template search order is as specified above.
TMPL:INCLUDE recursion for piecewise customisation, or mixing in new features
If there is recursion in the TMPL:INCLUDE chain (eg twiki.classic.tmpl contains
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"twiki"}%
, the templating system will include the next twiki.SKIN in the skin path.
For example, to create a customisation of pattern skin, where you
only want to over-ride the breadcrumbs for the view script, you can create only a view.yourlocal.tmpl:
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"view"}%
%TMPL:DEF{"breadcrumb"}% We don't want any crumbs %TMPL:END%
and then set SKIN=yourlocal,pattern
The default
{TemplatePath}
will not give you the desired result if you put these statements in the topic
Thisweb.YourlocalSkinViewTemplate
. The default
{TemplatePath}
will resolve the request to the
template/view.pattern.tmpl
, before it gets to the
Thisweb.YourlocalSkinViewTemplate
resolution. You can make it work by prefixing the
{TemplatePath}
with:
$web.YourlocalSkin$nameTemplate
.
Default master template
twiki.tmpl
is the default master template. It defines the following sections.
Template variable: |
Defines: |
%TMPL:DEF{"sep"}% |
"|" separator |
%TMPL:DEF{"htmldoctype"}% |
Start of all HTML pages |
%TMPL:DEF{"standardheader"}% |
Standard header (ex: view, index, search) |
%TMPL:DEF{"simpleheader"}% |
Simple header with reduced links (ex: edit, attach, oops) |
%TMPL:DEF{"standardfooter"}% |
Footer, excluding revision and copyright parts |
Template Topics
The second type of template in TWiki are template topics. Template topics define the default text for new topics. There are four types of template topic:
Topic Name: |
What it is: |
WebTopicViewTemplate |
Alert page shown when you try to view a nonexistent topic. This page is usually used as a prompt to help you create a new topic. |
WebTopicNonWikiTemplate |
Alert page shown when you try to view a nonexistent topic with a non-WikiName. Again, this page is used as a prompt to help you create the new topic. |
WebTopicEditTemplate |
Default text used in a new topic. |
<MyCustomNamed>Template |
Whenever you create a topic ending in the word "Template", it is automatically added to the list of available templates in the "Use Template" drop down field on the WebCreateNewTopic page. |
When you create a new topic using the
edit
script, TWiki locates a topic to use as a content template according to the following search order:
- A topic name specified by the
templatetopic
CGI parameter
- if no web is specified, the current web is searched first and then the TWiki web
- WebTopicEditTemplate in the current web
- WebTopicEditTemplate in the TWiki web
Variable Expansion
When the following variables are used in a template topic, they automatically get expanded when new topic is created based on it:
Variable: |
Description: |
%DATE% |
Signature format date. See VarDATE |
%GMTIME% |
Date/time. See VarGMTIME |
%GMTIME{...}% |
Formatted date/time. See VarGMTIME2 |
%NOP% |
A no-operation variable that gets removed. Useful to prevent a SEARCH from hitting an edit template topic; also useful to escape a variable, such as %URLPA%NOP%RAM{...}% escaping URLPARAM |
%STARTSECTION{type="templateonly"}% ... %ENDSECTION{type="templateonly"}% |
Text that gets removed when a new topic based on the template is created. See notes below. |
%SERVERTIME% |
Date/time. See VarSERVERTIME |
%SERVERTIME{...}% |
Formatted date/time. See VarSERVERTIME2 |
%USERNAME% |
Login name of user who is instantiating the new topic, e.g. guest |
%URLPARAM{"name"}% |
Value of a named URL parameter |
%WIKINAME% |
WikiName of user who is instantiating the new topic, e.g. TWikiGuest |
%WIKIUSERNAME% |
User name of user who is instantiating the new tpoic, e.g. Main.TWikiGuest |
%STARTSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
...
%ENDSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
markers are used to embed text that you
do not want expanded when a new topic based on the template topic is created. For example, you might want to write in the template topic:
%STARTSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
This template can only be changed by:
* Set ALLOWTOPICCHANGE = Main.TWikiAdminGroup
%ENDSECTION{type="templateonly"}%
This will restrict who can edit the template topic, but will get removed when a new topic based on that template topic is created.
%NOP%
can be used to prevent expansion of TWiki variables that would otherwise be expanded during topic creation e.g.i escape
%SERVERTIME%
with
%SER%NOP%VERTIME%
.
All other variables are unchanged, e.g. are carried over "as is" into the new topic.
Specifying a Form
When you create a new topic based on a template, you often want the new topic to have a form attached to it. You can attach a form to the template topic, in which case it will be copied into the new topic.
Sometimes this isn't quite what you want, as it copies all the existing data from the template topic into the new topic. To avoid this and use the default values specified in the form definition instead, you can use the
formtemplate
CGI parameter to the
edit
script to specify the name of a form to attach.
See
TWikiScripts for information about all the other parameters to
edit
.
Automatically Generated Topic Names
For TWiki applications it is useful to be able to automatically generate unique topicnames, such as BugID0001, BugID0002, etc. You can add
AUTOINC<n>
to the topic name in the edit and save scripts, and it will be replaced with an auto-incremented number on topic save.
<n>
is a number starting from 0, and may include leading zeros. Leading zeros are used to zero-pad numbers so that auto-incremented topic names can sort properly. Deleted topics are not re-used to ensure uniqueness of topic names. That is, the auto-incremented number is always higher than the existing ones, even if there are gaps in the number sequence.
Examples:
-
BugAUTOINC0
- creates topic names Bug0
, Bug1
, Bug2
, ... (does not sort properly)
-
ItemAUTOINC0000
- creates topic names Item0000
, Item0001
, Item0002
, ... (sorts properly up to 9999)
-
DocIDAUTOINC10001
- start with DocID10001
, DocID10002
, ... (sorts properly up to 99999; auto-links)
Example link to create a new topic:
[[%SCRIPTURLPATH{edit}%/%WEB%/BugIDAUTOINC00001?templatetopic=BugTemplate;topicparent=%TOPIC%;t=%SERVERTIME{"$day$hour$min$sec"}%][Create new item]]
Template Topics in Action
Here is an example for creating new topics (in the Sandbox web) based on a specific template topic and form:
The above form asks for a topic name. A hidden input tag named
templatetopic
specifies
ExampleTopicTemplate as the template topic to use. Here is the HTML source of the form:
<form name="new" action="%SCRIPTURLPATH{edit}%/Sandbox/">
* New example topic:
<input type="text" name="topic" value="ExampleTopicAUTOINC0001" size="30" />
<input type="hidden" name="templatetopic" value="ExampleTopicTemplate" />
<input type="hidden" name="topicparent" value="%TOPIC%" />
<input type="hidden" name="onlywikiname" value="on" />
<input type="hidden" name="onlynewtopic" value="on" />
<input type="submit" class="twikiSubmit" value="Create" />
</form>
See
TWikiScripts#edit for details of the parameters that the
edit
script understands.
TIP: You can use the
%WIKIUSERNAME%
and
%DATE%
variables in your topic templates to include the signature of the person creating a new topic. The variables are expanded into fixed text when a new topic is created. The standard signature is:
-- %WIKIUSERNAME% - %DATE%
Using Absolute vs Relative URLs in Templates
When you use
TWikiVariables such as %PUBURL% and %PUBURLPATH% in templates you should be aware that using %PUBURL% instead of %PUBURLPATH% puts absolute URLs in the produced HTML. This means that when a user saves a TWiki page in HTML and emails the file to someone outside a company firewall, the receiver has a severe problem viewing it. It is therefore recommended always to use the %PUBURLPATH% to refer to images, CSS, Javascript files etc so links become relative. This way browsers just give up right away and show a usable html file.
Related Topics: TWikiSkins,
DeveloperDocumentationCategory,
AdminDocumentationCategory
Back to top
TWiki Skins
Skins overlay regular templates to give different looks and feels to TWiki screens.
Overview
TWiki uses
TWikiTemplates files as the basis of all the screens it uses to interact with users. Each screen has an associated template file that contains the basic layout of the screen. This is then filled in by the code to generate what you see in the browser.
TWiki ships with a default set of template files that give a very basic, CSS-themable, look-and-feel. TWiki also includes support for
skins that can be selected to give different, more sophisticated, look and feels. A default TWiki installation will usually start up with the
PatternSkin already selected. Skins may also be defined by third parties and loaded into a TWiki installation to give more options. To see how TWiki looks when
no skin is selected,
view this topic with a non-existant skin.
Topic text is not affected by the choice of skin, though a skin can be defined to use a CSS (Cascading Style Sheet), which can sometimes give a radically different appearance to the text.
Relevant links on TWiki.org:
See other types of extensions: TWikiAddOns,
TWikiContribs,
TWikiPlugins
Changing the default TWiki skin
TWiki default ships with the skin
PatternSkin activated. You can set the skin for the whole site, a single web or topic, or for each user individually, by setting the SKIN variable to the name of a skin. If the skin you select doesn't exist, then TWiki will pick up the default templates.
Defining Skins
You may want to define your own skin, for example to comply with corporate web guidelines, or because you have a aesthetic vision that you want to share. There are a couple of places you an start doing this.
The
TWikiTemplates files used for skins are located in the
twiki/templates
directory and are named according to the skin:
<scriptname>.<skin>.tmpl
. Skin files may also be defined in TWiki topics - see
TWikiTemplates for details.
To start creating a new skin, copy the default
TWikiTemplates (like
view.tmpl
), or copy an existing skin to use as a base for your own skin. You should only need to copy the files you intend to customise, as TWiki can be configured to fall back to another skin if a template is not defined in your skin. Name the files as described above (for example
view.myskin.tmpl
.
If you use
PatternSkin as your starting point, and you want to modify the layout, colors or even the templates to suit your own needs, have a look first at the topics
PatternSkinCustomization and
PatternSkinCssCookbook.
For your own TWiki skin you are encouraged to show a small 80x31 pixel
logo at the bottom of your skin:
<a href="http://twiki.org/"><img src="%PUBURL%/%SYSTEMWEB%/TWikiLogos/T-logo-80x15.gif" alt="This site is powered by the TWiki collaboration platform" width="80" height="15" title="This site is powered by the TWiki collaboration platform" border="0" /></a>
The standard TWiki skins show the logo in the
%WEBCOPYRIGHT%
variable.
Note: Two skin names have
reserved meanings;
text
skin, and skin names starting with
rss
have
hard-coded meanings.
The following template files are used for TWiki screens, and are referenced in the TWiki core code. If a skin doesn't define its own version of a template file, then TWiki will fall back to the next skin in the skin path, or finally, to the default version of the template file.
(Certain template files are expected to provide certain TMPL:DEFs - these are listed in sub-bullets)
-
addform
- used to select a new form for a topic
-
attachagain
- used when refreshing an existing attachment
-
attachnew
- used when attaching a new file to a topic
-
attachtables
- defines the format of attachments at the bottom of the standard topic view
-
ATTACH:files:footer
, ATTACH:files:header
, ATTACH:files:row
, ATTACH:versions:footer
, ATTACH:versions:header
, ATTACH:versions:row
-
changeform
- used to change the form in a topic
-
changes
- used by the changes
script
-
edit
- used for the edit screen
-
form
-
formtables
- used to defined the format of forms
-
FORM:display:footer
, FORM:display:header
, FORM:display:row
-
login
- used for loggin in when using the TemplateLoginManager
-
LOG_IN
, LOG_IN_BANNER
, LOG_OUT
, LOGGED_IN_BANNER
, NEW_USER_NOTE
, UNRECOGNISED_USER
-
moveattachment
- used when moving an attachment
-
oopsaccessdenied
- used to format Access Denied messages
-
no_such_topic
, no_such_web
, only_group
, topic_access
-
oopsattention
- used to format Attention messages
-
already_exists
, bad_email
, bad_ver_code
, bad_wikiname
, base_web_missing
, confirm
, created_web
, delete_err
, invalid_web_color
, invalid_web_name
, in_a_group
, mandatory_field
, merge_notice
, missing_action
, missing_fields
, move_err
, missing_action
, no_form_def
, no_users_to_reset
, notwikiuser
, oversized_upload
, password_changed
, password_mismatch
, problem_adding
, remove_user_done
, rename_err
, rename_not_wikiword
, rename_topic_exists
, rename_web_err
, rename_web_exists
, rename_web_prerequisites
, reset_bad
, reset_ok
, save_error
, send_mail_error
, thanks
, topic_exists
, unrecognized_action
, upload_name_changed
, web_creation_error
, web_exists
, web_missing
, wrong_password
, zero_size_upload
-
oopschangelanguage
- used to prompt for a new language when internationalisation is enabled
-
oopsgeneric
- a basic dialog for user information; provides "ok" button only
-
oopslanguagechanged
- used to confirm a new language when internationalisation is enabled
-
oopsleaseconflict
- used to format lease Conflict messages
-
preview
- used for previewing edited topics before saving
-
rdiff
- used for viewing topic differences
-
registernotify
- used by the user registration system
-
registernotifyadmin
- used by the user registration system
-
rename
- used when renaming a topic
-
renameconfirm
- used when renaming a topic
-
renamedelete
- used when renaming a topic
-
renameweb
- used when renaming a web
-
renamewebconfirm
- used when renaming a web
-
renamewebdelete
- used when renaming a web
-
searchbookview
- used to format inline search results in book view
-
searchformat
- used to format inline search results
-
search
- used by the search
CGI script
-
settings
-
view
- used by the view
CGI script
-
viewprint
- used to create the printable view
twiki.tmpl
is a master template conventionally used by other templates, but not used directly by code.
Note: Make sure templates do not end with a newline. Any newline will expand to an empty
<p />
in the generated html. It will produce invalid html, and may break the page layout.
Partial customisation, or adding in new features to an existing skin
You can use recusion in the TMPL:INCLUDE chain (eg twiki.classic.tmpl contains
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"twiki"}%
, the templating system will include the next twiki.SKIN in the skin path.
For example, to create a customisation of pattern skin, where you
only want to remove the edit & WYSIWYG buttons from view page, you create only a
view.yourlocal.tmpl
:
%TMPL:INCLUDE{"view"}%
%TMPL:DEF{"edit_topic_link"}%%TMPL:END%
%TMPL:DEF{"edit_wysiwyg_link"}%%TMPL:END%
and then set
SKIN=yourlocal,pattern
.
Because
ClassicSkin and the default templates use the same Template definition names, you can over-ride the edit links in them (or any skin derived from them) using the same
view.yourlocal.tmpl
(just set SKIN=yourlocal,classic either in
TWikiPreferences for globally, or a Web's Webname.WebPreferences for a particular web)
Variables in Skins
You can use
template variables,
TWikiVariables, and other predefined variables to compose your skins. Some commonly used variables in skins:
Variable: |
Expanded to: |
%WEBLOGONAME% |
Filename of web logo |
%WEBLOGOIMG% |
Image URL of web logo |
%WEBLOGOURL% |
Link of web logo |
%WEBLOGOALT% |
Alt text of web logo |
%WIKILOGOURL% |
Link of page logo |
%WIKILOGOIMG% |
Image URL of page logo |
%WIKILOGOALT% |
Alt text of page logo |
%WEBBGCOLOR% |
Web-specific background color, defined in the WebPreferences |
%WIKITOOLNAME% |
The name of your TWiki site |
%SCRIPTURL% |
The script URL of TWiki |
%SCRIPTURLPATH% |
The script URL path |
%SCRIPTSUFFIX% |
The script suffix, ex: .pl , .cgi |
%WEB% |
The name of the current web. |
%TOPIC% |
The name of the current topic. |
%WEBTOPICLIST% |
Common links of current web, defined in the WebPreferences. It includes a Go box |
%TEXT% |
The topic text, e.g. the content that can be edited |
%META{"form"}% |
TWikiForm, if any |
%META{"attachments"}% |
FileAttachment table |
%META{"parent"}% |
The topic parent |
%EDITTOPIC% |
Edit link |
%REVTITLE% |
The revision title, if any, ex: (r1.6) |
%REVINFO% |
Revision info, ex: r1.6 - 24 Dec 2002 - 08:12 GMT - TWikiGuest |
%WEBCOPYRIGHT% |
Copyright notice, defined in the WebPreferences |
%BROADCASTMESSAGE% |
Broadcast message at the beginning of your view template, can be used to alert users of scheduled downtimes; can be set in TWikiPreferences |
The "Go" Box and Navigation Box
The default skins include a
"Go" box, also called "Jump" box, to jump to a topic.
The box also understands URLs, e.g. you can type
http://www.google.com/
to jump to an external web site. The feature is handy if you build a skin that has a select box of frequently used links, like Intranet home, employee database, sales database and such. A little JavaScript gets into action on the
onchange
method of the select tag to fill the selected URL into the "Go" box field, then submits the form.
Here is an example form that has a select box and the "Go" box for illustration purposes. You need to have JavaScript enabled for this to work:
Note: Redirect to a URL only works if it is enabled in
configure
(Miscellaneous,
{AllowRedirectUrl}
).
Using Cascading Style Sheets
CSS files are gererally attachments to the skin topic that are included in the the skin templates - in the case of
PatternSkin in the template
styles.pattern.tmpl
.
- To see how CSS is used in the default TWiki skin, see: PatternSkin
- If you write a complete new skin, this is the syntax to use in a template file:
<style type='text/css' media='all'>@import url('%PUBURLPATH%/%SYSTEMWEB%/MySkin/mystyle.css');</style>
Attachment Tables
Controlling the look and feel of attachment tables is a little bit more complex than for the rest of a skin. By default, the attachment table is a standard TWiki table, and the look is controlled in the same way as other tables. In a very few cases you may want to change the
content of the table as well.
The format of standard attachment tables is defined through the use of special
TWiki template macros which by default, are defined in the
attachtables.tmpl
template using the
%TMPL:DEF
macro syntax described in
TWikiTemplates. These macros are:
Macro |
Description |
ATTACH:files:header |
Standard title bar |
ATTACH:files:row |
Standard row |
ATTACH:files:footer |
Footer for all screens |
ATTACH:files:header:A |
Title bar for upload screens, with attributes column |
ATTACH:files:row:A |
Row for upload screen |
ATTACH:files:footer:A |
Footer for all screens |
The format of tables of file versions in the Upload screen can also be changed, using the macros:
Macro |
Description |
ATTACH:versions:header |
Header for versions table on upload screen |
ATTACH:versions:row |
Row format for versions table on upload screen |
ATTACH:versions:footer |
Footer for versions table on upload screen |
The
ATTACH:row
macros are expanded for each file in the attachment table, using the following special tags:
Tag |
Description |
%A_URL% |
viewfile URL that will recover the file |
%A_REV% |
Revision of this file |
%A_ICON% |
A file icon suitable for representing the attachment content |
%A_FILE% |
The name of the file. To get the 'pub' url of the file, use %PUBURL%/%WEB%/%TOPIC%/%A_FILE% |
%A_SIZE% |
The size of the file |
%A_DATE% |
The date the file was uploaded |
%A_USER% |
The user who uploaded it |
%A_COMMENT% |
The comment they put in when uploading it |
%A_ATTRS% |
The attributes of the file as seen on the upload screen e.g "h" for a hidden file |
Packaging and Publishing Skins
See
TWiki:Plugins/SkinPackagingHowTo and
TWiki:Plugins/SkinDeveloperFAQ
Browsing Installed Skins
You can try out all installed skins in the
TWikiSkinBrowser.
Activating Skins
TWiki uses a
skin search path, which lets you combine skins additively. The skin path is defined using a combination of
TWikiVariables and URL parameters.
TWiki works by asking for a template for a particular function - for example, 'view'. The detail of how templates are searched for is described in
TWikiTemplates, but in summary, the templates directory is searched for a file called
view.
skin.tmpl
, where
skin is the name of the skin e.g.
pattern
. If no template is found, then the fallback is to use
view.tmpl
. Each skin on the path is searched for in turn. For example, if you have set the skin path to
local,pattern
then
view.local.tmpl
will be searched for first, then
view.pattern.tmpl
and finally
view.tmpl
.
The basic skin is defined by a
SKIN
setting:
-
Set SKIN = catskin, bearskin
You can also add a parameter to the URL, such as
?skin=catskin,bearskin
:
Setting
SKIN
(or the
?skin
parameter in the URL) replaces the existing skin path setting, for the current page only. You can also
extend the existing skin path as well, using
covers.
This pushes a different skin to the front of the skin search path (so for our example above, that final skin path will be
ruskin, catskin, bearskin
). There is also an equivalent
cover
URL parameter. The difference between setting
SKIN
vs.
COVER
is that if the chosen template is not found (e.g., for included templates),
SKIN
will fall back onto the next skin in line, or the default skin, if only one skin was present, while
COVER
will always fall back onto the current skin.
An example would be invoking the printable mode, which is achieved by applying
?cover=print
. The
view.print.tmpl
simply invokes the
viewprint
template for the current skin which then can appropriately include all other used templates for the current skin. Where the printable mode be applied by using
SKIN
, all skins would have the same printable appearance.
The full skin path is built up as follows:
SKIN
setting (or
?skin
if it is set), then
COVER
setting is added, then
?cover
.
Hard-Coded Skins
The
text
skin is reserved for TWiki internal use.
Skin names starting with
rss
also have a special meaning; if one or more of the skins in the skin path starts with 'rss' then 8-bit characters will be encoded as XML entities in the output, and the
content-type
header will be forced to
text/xml
.
Related Topics: TWikiSkinBrowser,
AdminDocumentationCategory,
DeveloperDocumentationCategory,
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiSkinsSupplement
--
Contributors: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny,
TWiki:Main.MikeMannix,
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie
Back to top
TWiki Meta Data
Additional topic data, program-generated or from TWikiForms, is stored embedded in the topic text using META:
tags
Overview
By default, TWiki stores topics in files on disk, in a really simple and obvious directory structure. The big advantage of this approach is that it makes it really easy to manipulate topics from outside TWiki, and is also very safe; there are no complex binary indexes to maintain, and moving a topic from one TWiki to another is as simple as copying a couple of text files.
To keep eveything together in one place, TWiki uses a simple method for embedding additional data (program-generated or from
TWikiForms) in topics. It does this using
META:
tags.
META:
data includes program-generated info like
FileAttachment and topic movement data, and user-defined
TWikiForms info.
Meta Data Syntax
- Format is the same as in TWikiVariables, except all fields have a key.
-
%META:<type>{key1="value1" key2="value2" ...}%
- Order of fields within the meta variables is not defined, except that if there is a field with key
name
, this appears first for easier searching (note the order of the variables themselves is defined).
- Each meta variable is on one line.
- Values in meta-data are URL encoded so that characters such as \n can be stored.
Example of Format
%META:TOPICINFO{version="1.6" date="976762663" author="LastEditorWikiName" format="1.0"}%
text of the topic
%META:TOPICMOVED{from="Codev.OldName" to="Codev.NewName"
by="TopicMoverWikiName" date="976762680"}%
%META:TOPICPARENT{name="NavigationByTopicContext"}%
%META:FILEATTACHMENT{name="Sample.txt" version="1.3" ... }%
%META:FILEATTACHMENT{name="Smile.gif" version="1.1" ... }%
%META:FORM{name="WebFormTemplate"}%
%META:FIELD{name="OperatingSystem" value="OsWin"}%
%META:FIELD{name="TopicClassification" value="PublicFAQ"}%
Meta Data Specifications
The current version of Meta Data is 1.0, with support for the following variables.
META:TOPICINFO
Key |
Comment |
version |
Same as RCS version |
date |
integer, unix time, seconds since start 1970 |
author |
last to change topic, is the REMOTE_USER |
format |
Format of this topic, will be used for automatic format conversion |
META:TOPICMOVED
This is optional, exists if topic has ever been moved. If a topic is moved more than once, only the most recent META:TOPICMOVED meta variable exists in the topic, older ones are to be found in the rcs history.
%META:TOPICMOVED{from="Codev.OldName" to="Codev.NewName" by="talintj" date="976762680"}%
Key |
Comment |
from |
Full name, i.e., web.topic |
to |
Full name, i.e., web.topic |
by |
Who did it, is the REMOTE_USER, not WikiName |
date |
integer, unix time, seconds since start 1970 |
Notes:
- at present version number is not supported directly, it can be inferred from the RCS history.
- there is only one META:TOPICMOVED in a topic, older move information can be found in the RCS history.
META:TOPICPARENT
Key |
Comment |
name |
The topic from which this was created, typically when clicking on a ? questionmark link, or by filling out a form. Normally just TopicName , but it can be a full Web.TopicName format if the parent is in a different Web. |
META:FILEATTACHMENT
Key |
Comment |
name |
Name of file, no path. Must be unique within topic |
version |
Same as RCS revision |
path |
Full path file was loaded from |
size |
In bytes |
date |
integer, unix time, seconds since start 1970 |
user |
the REMOTE_USER, not WikiName |
comment |
As supplied when file uploaded |
attr |
h if hidden, optional |
Extra fields that are added if an attachment is moved:
Key |
Comment |
movedfrom |
full topic name - web.topic |
movedby |
the REMOTE_USER, not WikiName |
movedto |
full topic name - web.topic |
moveddate |
integer, unix time, seconds since start 1970 |
META:FORM
Key |
Comment |
name |
A topic name - the topic represents one of the TWikiForms. Can optionally include the web name (i.e., web.topic), but doesn't normally |
META:FIELD
Should only be present if there is a META:FORM entry. Note that this data is used when viewing a topic, the form template definition is not read.
Key |
Name |
name |
Ties to entry in TWikiForms template, is title with all bar alphanumerics and . removed |
title |
Full text from TWikiForms template |
value |
Value user has supplied via form |
Recommended Sequence
There is no absolute need for Meta Data variables to be listed in a specific order within a topic, but it makes sense to do so a couple of good reasons:
- form fields remain in the order they are defined
- the
diff
function output appears in a logical order
The recommended sequence is:
-
META:TOPICINFO
-
META:TOPICPARENT
(optional)
- text of topic
-
META:TOPICMOVED
(optional)
-
META:FILEATTACHMENT
(0 or more entries)
-
META:FORM
(optional)
-
META:FIELD
(0 or more entries; FORM required)
Viewing Meta Data in Page Source
When viewing a topic the
Raw Text
link can be clicked to show the text of a topic (i.e., as seen when editing). This is done by adding
raw=on
to URL.
raw=debug
shows the meta data as well as the topic data, ex:
debug view for this topic
Rendering Meta Data
Meta Data is rendered with the %META% variable. This is mostly used in the
view
,
preview
and
edit
scripts.
You can render form fields in topic text by using the FORMFIELD variable. Example:
%FORMFIELD{"TopicClassification"}%
For details, see
VarFORMFIELD.
Current support covers:
Variable usage: |
Comment: |
%META{"form"}% |
Show form data, see TWikiForms. |
%META{"formfield"}% |
Show form field value. Parameter: name="field_name" . Example: %META{ "formfield" name="TopicClassification" }% |
%META{"attachments"}% |
Show attachments, except for hidden ones. Options: all="on" : Show all attachments, including hidden ones. |
%META{"moved"}% |
Details of any topic moves. |
%META{"parent"}% |
Show topic parent. Options: dontrecurse="on" : By default recurses up tree, at some cost. nowebhome="on" : Suppress WebHome. prefix="..." : Prefix for parents, only if there are parents, default "" . suffix="..." : Suffix, only appears if there are parents, default "" . separator="..." : Separator between parents, default is " > " . |
Note: SEARCH can also be used to render meta data, see examples in
FormattedSearch and
SearchPatternCookbook.
Related Topics: DeveloperDocumentationCategory,
UserDocumentationCategory
Back to top
TWiki Add-Ons
Add functionality to TWiki with extensions not based on the TWiki scripts.
Overview
An add-on runs separately from the TWiki scripts, e.g. for data import, export to static HTML, etc. Add-Ons normally do not call any TWiki code directly, though may invoke TWiki scripts. There are different types of add-ons, they may be stand alone scripts, browser plugins, office tool extensions, or even a set of TWiki topics that form a TWiki application.
Relevant links on TWiki.org:
See other types of extensions: TWikiContribs,
TWikiPlugins,
TWikiSkins
Add-Ons Installed on this TWiki
Number of topics: 0
Installing Add-Ons
Creating new Add-Ons
Back to top
TWiki Contribs
Reusable code that may be used over several plugins and add-ons.
Overview
TWiki contribs extend the functionality of TWiki, typically used by plugins and add-ons. They may also provide alternative implementations for sections of the TWiki core e.g. user management, or when an extension just can't be implemented as a plugin because it requires very close access to TWiki internals.
Relevant links on TWiki.org:
See other types of extensions: TWikiAddOns,
TWikiPlugins,
TWikiSkins
TWiki Contribs Installed on this TWiki
Number of topics: 6
Installing Contribs
Creating new Contribs
Back to top
TWiki Plugins
Add functionality to TWiki with readily available plugins; create plugins based on APIs
Overview
You can add plugins to extend TWiki functionality, without altering the core code. A plug-in approach lets you:
- add virtually unlimited features while keeping the main TWiki code compact and efficient;
- heavily customize an installation and still do clean updates to new versions of TWiki;
- rapidly develop new TWiki functions in Perl using the plugin API.
Everything to do with TWiki plugins - demos, new releases, downloads, development, general discussion - is available at TWiki.org, in the
TWiki:Plugins web.
TWiki plugins are developed and contributed by interested members of the community. Plugins are provided on an 'as is' basis; they are not a part of TWiki, but are independently developed and maintained.
Relevant links on TWiki.org:
See other types of extensions: TWikiAddOns,
TWikiContribs,
TWikiSkins
Installing Plugins
Each TWiki plugin comes with its own documentation: step-by-step installation instructions, a detailed description of any special requirements, version details, and a working example for testing. Many plugins have an install script that automates these steps for you.
Special Requirements: Some plugins need certain Perl modules to be preinstalled on the host system. Plugins may also use other resources, like graphics, other modules, applications, and templates. You should be able to find detailed instructions in the plugin's documentation.
Each plugin has a standard release topic, located in the
TWiki:Plugins web at TWiki.org. There's usually a number of other related topics, such as a developers page, and an appraisal page.
On-Site Pretesting
The recommended approach to testing new plugins before making them public is to create a second local TWiki installation, and test the plugin there. You can allow selected users access to the test area. Once you are satisfied that it won't compromise your main installation, you can install it there as well.
InstalledPlugins shows which plugins are: 1) installed, 2) loading properly, and 3) what
TWiki:Codev.PluginHandlers they invoke. Any failures are shown in the Errors section. The
%FAILEDPLUGINS%
variable can be used to debug failures. You may also want to check your webserver error log and the various TWiki log files.
Some Notes on Plugin Performance
The performance of the system depends to some extent on the number of plugins installed and on the plugin implementation. Some plugins impose no measurable performance decrease, some do. For example, a Plugin might use many Perl libraries that need to be initialized with each page view (unless you run mod_perl). You can only really tell the performance impact by installing the plugin and by measuring the performance with and without the new plugin. Use the
TWiki:Plugins.PluginBenchmarkAddOn, or test manually with the Apache
ab
utility. Example on Unix:
time wget -qO /dev/null /bin/view/TWiki/AbcPlugin
If you need to install an "expensive" plugin, but you only need its functionality only in a subset of your data, you can disable it elsewhere by defining the %DISABLEDPLUGINS% TWiki variable.
Define
DISABLEDPLUGINS
to be a comma-separated list of names of plugins to disable. Define it in Main.TWikiPreferences to disable those plugins everywhere, in the WebPreferences topic to disable them in an individual web, or in a topic to disable them in that topic. For example,
* Set DISABLEDPLUGINS = SpreadSheetPlugin, EditTablePlugin
Managing Installed Plugins
Some plugins require additional settings or offer extra options that you have to select. Also, you may want to make a plugin available only in certain webs, or temporarily disable it. And may want to list all available plugins in certain topics. You can handle all of these management tasks with simple procedures:
Enabling Plugins
Plugins can be enabled and disabled with the
configure script. An installed plugin needs to be enabled before it can be used.
Plugin Evaluation Order
By default, TWiki executes plugins in alphabetical order on plugin name. It is possible to change the order, for example to evaluate database variables before the spreadsheet CALCs. This can be done with
{PluginsOrder}
in the plugins section of
configure.
Plugin-Specific Settings
Some plugins are configured with plugin preferences variables, newer plugins with configure variables.
Configure variables are accessible though the
configure interface.
Plugin preferences variables are defined in the plugin topic and can be overloaded. The SHORTDESCRIPTION preferences variable is always present, it is needed for the
TWiki:Plugins repository on twiki.org. Example preferences variable defined in the
TablePlugin topic:
-
Set SHORTDESCRIPTION = Control attributes of tables and sorting of table columns
Preferences variables of active plugins can be retrieved anywhere in TWiki with
%<pluginname>_<var>%
, such as
%TABLEPLUGIN_SHORTDESCRIPTION%
. They can also be redefined with the
%<pluginname>_<var>%
setting at a lower level in the
Main.TWikiPreferences or at the web level. For an easier upgrade it is recommended to customize plugin preferences variables in Main.TWikiPreferences only.
Listing Active Plugins
Plugin status variables let you list all active plugins wherever needed.
This site is running TWiki version
TWiki-4.2.3, Wed, 06 Aug 2008, build 17396, plugin API version
1.2
%ACTIVATEDPLUGINS%
On this TWiki site, the enabled plugins are:
SpreadSheetPlugin,
CommentPlugin,
EditTablePlugin,
GoogleAnalyticsPlugin,
InterwikiPlugin,
PreferencesPlugin,
SlideShowPlugin,
SmiliesPlugin,
TablePlugin,
TinyMCEPlugin,
TwistyPlugin,
WysiwygPlugin.
%PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS%
- SpreadSheetPlugin (any TWiki, $Rev: 17387 (11 Aug 2008) $): Add spreadsheet calculation like
"$SUM( $ABOVE() )"
to TWiki tables and other topic text - CommentPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Allows users to quickly post comments to a page without an edit/preview/save cycle
- EditTablePlugin (4.8.4, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Edit TWiki tables using edit fields, date pickers and drop down boxes
- GoogleAnalyticsPlugin (2011-05-14, $Rev: 21272 (2011-05-14) $): Adds Google Analytics javascript code to specified pages
- InterwikiPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 14913 (17 Sep 2007) $): Link
ExternalSite:Page
text to external sites based on aliases defined in a rules topic - PreferencesPlugin (TWiki-4.2, $Rev: 15487 (11 Aug 2008) $): Allows editing of preferences using fields predefined in a form
- SlideShowPlugin (02 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17260 (11 Aug 2008) $): Create web based presentations based on topics with headings.
- SmiliesPlugin (Dakar, $Rev: 16049 (11 Aug 2008) $): Render smilies as icons, like for
:-)
or for :eek:
- TablePlugin (2014-01-21, $Rev: 26934 (2014-01-21) $): Control attributes of tables and sorting of table columns
- TinyMCEPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17302 (11 Aug 2008) $): Integration of TinyMCE? with WysiwygPlugin
- TwistyPlugin (1.4.10, $Rev: 15653 (19 Nov 2007) $): Twisty section JavaScript library to open/close content dynamically
- WysiwygPlugin (03 Aug 2008, $Rev: 17359 (11 Aug 2008) $): Translator framework for Wysiwyg editors
%FAILEDPLUGINS%
Handler | Plugins |
---|
afterEditHandler | WysiwygPlugin |
beforeCommonTagsHandler | EditTablePlugin PreferencesPlugin WysiwygPlugin |
beforeEditHandler | TinyMCEPlugin WysiwygPlugin |
beforeMergeHandler | WysiwygPlugin |
beforeSaveHandler | CommentPlugin WysiwygPlugin |
commonTagsHandler | SpreadSheetPlugin CommentPlugin EditTablePlugin SlideShowPlugin SmiliesPlugin |
initPlugin | SpreadSheetPlugin CommentPlugin EditTablePlugin GoogleAnalyticsPlugin InterwikiPlugin PreferencesPlugin SlideShowPlugin SmiliesPlugin TablePlugin TinyMCEPlugin TwistyPlugin WysiwygPlugin |
modifyHeaderHandler | WysiwygPlugin |
postRenderingHandler | EditTablePlugin GoogleAnalyticsPlugin PreferencesPlugin WysiwygPlugin |
preRenderingHandler | InterwikiPlugin SmiliesPlugin TablePlugin |
startRenderingHandler | WysiwygPlugin This handler is deprecated - please check for updated versions of the plugins that use it! |
12 plugins
The TWiki Plugin API
The Application Programming Interface (API) for TWiki plugins provides the specifications for hooking into the core TWiki code from your external Perl plugin module.
Available Core Functions
The
TWikiFuncDotPm module (
lib/TWiki/Func.pm
) describes
all the interfaces available to plugins. Plugins should
only use the interfaces described in this module.
Note: If you use other core functions not described in
Func.pm
, you run the risk of creating security holes. Also, your plugin will likely break and require updating when you upgrade to a new version of TWiki.
Predefined Hooks
In addition to TWiki core functions, plugins can use
predefined hooks, or
callbacks, as described in the
lib/TWiki/Plugins/EmptyPlugin.pm
module.
- All but the initPlugin are disabled. To enable a callback, remove
DISABLE_
from the function name.
TWiki:Codev/StepByStepRenderingOrder helps you decide which rendering handler to use.
Hints on Writing Fast Plugins
- Delay initialization as late as possible. For example, if your plugin is a simple syntax processor, you might delay loading extra Perl modules until you actually see the syntax in the text.
- For example, use an
eval
block like this:
eval { require IPC::Run }
return "<font color=\"red\">SamplePlugin: Can't load required modules ($@)</font>" if $@;
- Keep the main plugin package as small as possible; create other packages that are loaded if and only if they are used. For example, create sub-packages of BathPlugin in
lib/TWiki/Plugins/BathPlugin/
.
- Avoid using preferences in the plugin topic; set
$NO_PREFS_IN_TOPIC
if you possibly can, as that will stop TWiki from reading the plugin topic for every page. Use Config.spec instead.
- Use registered tag handlers
- Measure the performance to see the difference
Version Detection
To eliminate the incompatibility problems that are bound to arise from active open plugin development, a plugin versioning system is provided for automatic compatibility checking.
- All plugin packages require a
$VERSION
variable. This should be an integer, or a subversion version id.
- The
initPlugin
handler should check all dependencies and return 1 if the initialization is OK or 0 if something went wrong.
- The plugin initialization code does not register a plugin that returns 0 (or that has no
initPlugin
handler).
-
$TWiki::Plugins::VERSION
in the TWiki::Plugins
module contains the TWiki plugin API version, currently 1.2.
- You can also use the
%PLUGINVERSION{}%
variable to query the plugin API version or the version of installed plugins.
Security
- Badly written plugins can open huge security holes in TWiki. This is especially true if care isn't taken to prevent execution of arbitrary commands on the server.
- Don't allow sensitive configuration data to be edited by users. it is better to add sensitive configuration options to the
%TWiki::cfg
hash than adding it as preferences in the plugin topic.
- Always use the TWiki::Sandbox to execute commands.
- Always audit the plugins you install, and make sure you are happy with the level of security provided. While every effort is made to monitor plugin authors activities, at the end of the day they are uncontrolled user contributions.
Creating Plugins
With a reasonable knowledge of the Perl scripting language, you can create new plugins or modify and extend existing ones. Basic plug-in architecture uses an Application Programming Interface (API), a set of software instructions that allow external code to interact with the main program. The
TWiki Plugin API provides the programming interface for TWiki.
Anatomy of a Plugin
A (very) basic TWiki plugin consists of two files:
- a Perl module, e.g.
MyFirstPlugin.pm
- a documentation topic, e.g.
MyFirstPlugin.txt
The Perl module can be a block of code that talks to with TWiki alone, or it can include other elements, like other Perl modules (including other plugins), graphics, TWiki templates, external applications (ex: a Java applet), or just about anything else it can call.
In particular, files that should be web-accessible (graphics, Java applets ...) are best placed as attachments of the
MyFirstPlugin
topic. Other needed Perl code is best placed in a
lib/TWiki/Plugins/MyFirstPlugin/
directory.
The plugin API handles the details of connecting your Perl module with main TWiki code. When you're familiar with the
Plugin API, you're ready to develop plugins.
The TWiki:Plugins.BuildContrib module provides a lot of support for plugins development, including a plugin creator, automatic publishing support, and automatic installation script writer. If you plan on writing more than one plugin, you probably need it.
Creating the Perl Module
Copy file
lib/TWiki/Plugins/EmptyPlugin.pm
to
<name>Plugin.pm
. The
EmptyPlugin.pm
module contains mostly empty functions, so it does nothing, but it's ready to be used. Customize it. Refer to the
Plugin API specs for more information.
If your plugin uses its own modules and objects, you must include the name of the plugin in the package name. For example, write
Package MyFirstPlugin::Attrs;
instead of just
Package Attrs;
. Then call it using:
use TWiki::Plugins::MyFirstPlugin::Attrs;
$var = MyFirstPlugin::Attrs->new();
Writing the Documentation Topic
The plugin documentation topic contains usage instructions and version details. It serves the plugin files as
FileAttachments for downloading. (The doc topic is also included
in the
distribution package.) To create a documentation topic:
- Copy the plugin topic template from TWiki.org. To copy the text, go to TWiki:Plugins/PluginPackage and:
- enter the plugin name in the "How to Create a Plugin" section
- click Create
- select all in the Edit box & copy
- Cancel the edit
- go back to your site to the TWiki web
- In the GoBox enter your plugin name, for example
MyFirstPlugin
, press enter and create the new topic
- paste & save new plugin topic on your site
- Customize your plugin topic.
- Important: In case you plan to publish your plugin on TWiki.org, use Interwiki names for author names and links to TWiki.org topics, such as TWiki:Main/TWikiGuest. This is important because links should work properly in a plugin topic installed on any TWiki, not just on TWiki.org.
- Document the performance data you gathered while measuring the performance
- Save your topic, for use in packaging and publishing your plugin.
OUTLINE: Doc Topic Contents
Check the plugins web on TWiki.org for the latest plugin doc topic template. Here's a quick overview of what's covered:
Syntax Rules: <Describe any special text formatting that will be rendered.>"
Example: <Include an example of the plugin in action. Possibly include a static HTML version of the example to compare if the installation was a success!>"
Plugin Settings: <Description and settings for custom plugin %VARIABLES%, and those required by TWiki.>"
- Plugins Preferences <If user settings are needed, explain... Entering values works exactly like TWikiPreferences and WebPreferences: six (6) spaces and then:>"
- Set <EXAMPLE = value added>
Plugin Installation Instructions: <Step-by-step set-up guide, user help, whatever it takes to install and run, goes here.>"
Plugin Info: <Version, credits, history, requirements - entered in a form, displayed as a table. Both are automatically generated when you create or edit a page in the TWiki:Plugins web.>"
Packaging for Distribution
The
TWiki:Plugins.BuildContrib is a powerful build environment that is used by the TWiki project to build TWiki itself, as well as many of the plugins. You don't
have to use it, but it is highly recommended!
If you don't want (or can't) use the BuildContrib, then a minimum plugin release consists of a Perl module with a
WikiName that ends in
Plugin
, ex:
MyFirstPlugin.pm
, and a documentation page with the same name(
MyFirstPlugin.txt
).
- Distribute the plugin files in a directory structure that mirrors TWiki. If your plugin uses additional files, include them all:
-
lib/TWiki/Plugins/MyFirstPlugin.pm
-
data/TWiki/MyFirstPlugin.txt
-
pub/TWiki/MyFirstPlugin/uparrow.gif
[a required graphic]
- Create a zip archive with the plugin name (
MyFirstPlugin.zip
) and add the entire directory structure from Step 1. The archive should look like this:
-
lib/TWiki/Plugins/MyFirstPlugin.pm
-
data/TWiki/MyFirstPlugin.txt
-
pub/TWiki/MyFirstPlugin/uparrow.gif
Measuring and Improving the Plugin Performance
A high quality plugin performs well. You can use the
TWiki:Plugins.PluginBenchmarkAddOn to measure your
TWiki:Plugins.PluginBenchmarks. The data is needed as part of the Documentation Topic.
See also
Hints on Writing Fast Plugins.
Publishing for Public Use
You can release your tested, packaged plugin to the TWiki community through the
TWiki:Plugins web. All plugins submitted to TWiki.org are available for download and further development in
TWiki:Plugins/PluginPackage.
Publish your plugin by following these steps:
- Post the plugin documentation topic in the TWiki:Plugins/PluginPackage:
- enter the plugin name in the "How to Create a Plugin" section, for example
MyFirstPlugin
- paste in the topic text from Writing the Documentation Topic and save
- Attach the distribution zip file to the topic, ex:
MyFirstPlugin.zip
- Link from the doc page to a new, blank page named after the plugin, and ending in
Dev
, ex: MyFirstPluginDev
. This is the discussion page for future development. (User support for plugins is handled in TWiki:Support.)
- Put the plugin into the SVN repository, see TWiki:Plugins/ReadmeFirst (optional)
Once you have done the above steps once, you can use the BuildContrib to upload updates to your plugin.
Thank you very much for sharing your plugin with the TWiki community
Recommended Storage of Plugin Specific Data
Plugins sometimes need to store data. This can be plugin internal data such as cache data, or data generated for browser consumption such as images. Plugins should store data using
TWikiFuncDotPm functions that support saving and loading of topics and attachments.
Plugin Internal Data
You can create a plugin "work area" using the
TWiki::Func::getWorkArea()
function, which gives you a persistent directory where you can store data files. By default they will not be web accessible. The directory is guaranteed to exist, and to be writable by the webserver user. For convenience,
TWiki::Func::storeFile()
and
TWiki::Func::readFile()
are provided to persistently store and retrieve simple data in this area.
Web Accessible Data
Topic-specific data such as generated images can be stored in the topic's attachment area, which is web accessible. Use the
TWiki::Func::saveAttachment()
function to store the data.
Recommendation for file name:
- Prefix the filename with an underscore (the leading underscore avoids a name clash with files attached to the same topic)
- Identify where the attachment originated from, typically by including the plugin name in the file name
- Use only alphanumeric characters, underscores, dashes and periods to avoid platform dependency issues and URL issues
- Example:
_GaugePlugin_img123.gif
Web specific data can be stored in the plugin's attachment area, which is web accessible. Use the
TWiki::Func::saveAttachment()
function to store the data.
Recommendation for file names in plugin attachment area:
- Prefix the filename with an underscore
- Include the name of the web in the filename
- Use only alphanumeric characters, underscores, dashes and periods to avoid platform dependency issues and URL issues
- Example:
_Main_roundedge-ul.gif
Integrating with configure
Some TWiki extensions have setup requirements that are best integrated into
configure
rather than trying to use TWiki preferences variables. These extensions use
Config.spec
files to publish their configuration requirements.
Config.spec
files are read during TWiki configuration. Once a
Config.spec
has defined a configuration item, it is available for edit through the standard
configure
interface.
Config.spec
files are stored in the 'plugin directory' e.g.
lib/TWiki/Plugins/BathPlugin/Config.spec
.
Structure of a Config.spec
file
The
Config.spec
file for a plugin starts with the plugin announcing what it is:
# ---+ BathPlugin
# This plugin senses the level of water in your bath, and ensures the plug
# is not removed while the water is still warm.
This is followed by one or more configuration items. Each configuration item has a
type, a
description and a
default. For example:
# **SELECT Plastic,Rubber,Metal**
# Select the plug type
$TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{PlugType} = 'Plastic';
# **NUMBER**
# Enter the chain length in cm
$TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{ChainLength} = '30';
# **BOOLEAN EXPERT**
# Turn this option off to disable the water temperature alarm
$TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{TempSensorEnabled} = '1';
The type (e.g.
**SELECT**
) tells
configure
to how to prompt for the value. It also tells configure how to do some basic checking on the value you actually enter. All the comments between the type and the configuration item are taken as part of the description. The configuration item itself defines the default value for the configuration item. The above spec defines the configuration items
$TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{PlugType}
,
$TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{ChainLength}
, and
$TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{TempSensorEnabled}
for use in your plugin. For example,
if( $TWiki::cfg{BathPlugin}{TempSensorEnabled} && $curTemperature > 50 ) {
die "The bathwater is too hot for comfort";
}
The config.spec file is read by configure, and
configure
then writes
LocalSite.cfg
with the values chosen by the local site admin.
A range of types are available for use in
Config.spec
files:
BOOLEAN |
A true/false value, represented as a checkbox |
COMMAND length |
A shell command |
LANGUAGE |
A language (selected from {LocalesDir} |
NUMBER |
A number |
OCTAL |
An octal number |
PASSWORD length |
A password (input is hidden) |
PATH length |
A file path |
PERL |
A perl structure, consisting of arrays and hashes |
REGEX length |
A perl regular expression |
SELECT choices |
Pick one of a range of choices |
SELECTCLASS root |
Select a perl package (class) |
STRING length |
A string |
URL length |
A url |
URLPATH length |
A relative URL path |
All types can be followed by a comma-separated list of
attributes.
EXPERT |
means this an expert option |
M |
means the setting is mandatory (may not be empty) |
H |
means the option is not visible in configure |
See
lib/TWiki.spec
for many more examples.
Config.spec
files are also used for other (non-plugin) extensions. in this case they are stored under the
Contrib
directory instead of the
Plugins
directory.
TWiki:TWiki/SpecifyingConfigurationItemsForExtensions has supplemental documentation on configure settings.
Maintaining Plugins
Discussions and Feedback on Plugins
Each published plugin has a plugin development topic on TWiki.org. Plugin development topics are named after your plugin and end in
Dev
, such as
MyFirstPluginDev
. The plugin development topic is a great resource to discuss feature enhancements and to get feedback from the TWiki community.
Maintaining Compatibility with Earlier TWiki Versions
The plugin interface (
TWikiFuncDotPm functions and plugin handlers) evolve over time. TWiki introduces new API functions to address the needs of plugin authors. Plugins using unofficial TWiki internal functions may no longer work on a TWiki upgrade.
Organizations typically do not upgrade to the latest TWiki for many months. However, many administrators still would like to install the latest versions of a plugin on their older TWiki installation. This need is fulfilled if plugins are maintained in a compatible manner.
Tip: Plugins can be written to be compatible with older and newer TWiki releases. This can be done also for plugins using unofficial TWiki internal functions of an earlier release that no longer work on the latest TWiki codebase.
Here is an example; the
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiPluginsSupplement#MaintainPlugins has more details.
if( $TWiki::Plugins::VERSION >= 1.1 ) {
@webs = TWiki::Func::getListOfWebs( 'user,public' );
} else {
@webs = TWiki::Func::getPublicWebList( );
}
Handling deprecated functions
From time-to-time, the TWiki developers will add new functions to the interface (either to
TWikiFuncDotPm, or new handlers). Sometimes these improvements mean that old functions have to be deprecated to keep the code manageable. When this happens, the deprecated functions will be supported in the interface for at least one more TWiki release, and probably longer, though this cannot be guaranteed.
When a plugin defines deprecated handlers, a warning will be shown in the list generated by %FAILEDPLUGINS%. Admins who see these warnings should check TWiki.org and if necessary, contact the plugin author, for an updated version of the plugin.
Updated plugins may still need to define deprecated handlers for compatibility with old TWiki versions. In this case, the plugin package that defines old handlers can suppress the warnings in %FAILEDPLUGINS%.
This is done by defining a map from the handler name to the
TWiki::Plugins
version
in which the handler was first deprecated. For example, if we need to define the
endRenderingHandler
for compatibility with
TWiki::Plugins
versions before 1.1, we would add this to the plugin:
package TWiki::Plugins::SinkPlugin;
use vars qw( %TWikiCompatibility );
$TWikiCompatibility{endRenderingHandler} = 1.1;
If the currently-running TWiki version is 1.1
or later, then the
handler will not be called and
the warning will not be issued. TWiki with versions of
TWiki::Plugins
before 1.1 will still call the handler as required.
Back to top
Official list of stable TWiki functions for Plugin developers
This module defines official functions that
Plugins
can use to interact with the TWiki engine and content.
Refer to
EmptyPlugin and lib/TWiki/Plugins/EmptyPlugin.pm for a template Plugin and documentation on how to write a Plugin.
Plugins should
only use functions published in this module. If you use
functions in other TWiki libraries you might create a security hole and
you will probably need to change your Plugin when you upgrade TWiki.
Deprecated functions will still work in older code, though they should
not be called in new Plugins and should be replaced in older Plugins
as soon as possible.
The version of the TWiki::Func module is defined by the VERSION number of the
TWiki::Plugins module, currently 1.2. This can be shown
by the
%PLUGINVERSION%
TWiki variable, and accessed in code using
$TWiki::Plugins::VERSION
. The 'Since' field in the function
documentation refers to
$TWiki::Plugins::VERSION
.
Notes on use of
$TWiki::Plugins::VERSION
(from 1.2 forwards):
- If the major version (e.g.
1.
) is the same then any plugin coded to use any earlier revision of the 1.
API will still work. No function has been removed from the interface, nor has any API published in that version changed in such a way as to require plugins to be recoded.
- If the minor version (e.g. 1.1) is incremented there may be changes in the API that may help improve the coding of some plugins - for example, new interfaces giving access to previously hidden core functions. In addition, deprecation of functions in the interface trigger a minor version increment. Note that deprecated functions are not removed, they are merely frozen, and plugin authors are recommended to stop using them.
- Any additional digits in the version number relate to minor changes, such as the addition of parameters to the existing functions, or addition of utility functions that are unlikely to require significant changes to existing plugins.
-
TWiki::Plugins::VERSION
also applies to the plugin handlers. The handlers are documented in the EmptyPlugin, and that module indicates what version of TWiki::Plugins::VERSION
it relates to.
A full history of the changes to this API can be found at the end of this
topic.
Environment
getSkin( ) -> $skin
Get the skin path, set by the
SKIN
and
COVER
preferences variables or the
skin
and
cover
CGI parameters
Return:
$skin
Comma-separated list of skins, e.g.
'gnu,tartan'
. Empty string if none.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (29 Jul 2001)
getUrlHost( ) -> $host
Get protocol, domain and optional port of script URL
Return:
$host
URL host, e.g.
"http://example.com:80"
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getScriptUrl( $web, $topic, $script, ... ) -> $url
Compose fully qualified URL
-
$web
- Web name, e.g. 'Main'
-
$topic
- Topic name, e.g. 'WebNotify'
-
$script
- Script name, e.g. 'view'
-
...
- an arbitrary number of name=>value parameter pairs that will be url-encoded and added to the url. The special parameter name '#' is reserved for specifying an anchor. e.g. getScriptUrl('x','y','view','#'=>'XXX',a=>1,b=>2) will give .../view/x/y?a=1&b=2#XXX
Return:
$url
URL, e.g.
"http://example.com:80/cgi-bin/view.pl/Main/WebNotify"
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getViewUrl( $web, $topic ) -> $url
Compose fully qualified view URL
-
$web
- Web name, e.g. 'Main'
. The current web is taken if empty
-
$topic
- Topic name, e.g. 'WebNotify'
Return:
$url
URL, e.g.
"http://example.com:80/cgi-bin/view.pl/Main/WebNotify"
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getPubUrlPath( ) -> $path
Get pub URL path
Return:
$path
URL path of pub directory, e.g.
"/pub"
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (14 Jul 2001)
getExternalResource( $url ) -> $response
Get whatever is at the other end of a URL (using an HTTP GET request). Will
only work for encrypted protocols such as
https
if the
LWP
CPAN module is
installed.
Note that the
$url
may have an optional user and password, as specified by
the relevant RFC. Any proxy set in
configure
is honoured.
The
$response
is an object that is known to implement the following subset of
the methods of
LWP::Response
. It may in fact be an
LWP::Response
object,
but it may also not be if
LWP
is not available, so callers may only assume
the following subset of methods is available:
code() |
message() |
header($field) |
content() |
is_error() |
is_redirect() |
Note that if LWP is
not available, this function:
- can only really be trusted for HTTP/1.0 urls. If HTTP/1.1 or another protocol is required, you are strongly recommended to
require LWP
.
- Will not parse multipart content
In the event of the server returning an error, then
is_error()
will return
true,
code()
will return a valid HTTP status code
as specified in RFC 2616 and RFC 2518, and
message()
will return the
message that was received from
the server. In the event of a client-side error (e.g. an unparseable URL)
then
is_error()
will return true and
message()
will return an explanatory
message.
code()
will return 400 (BAD REQUEST).
Note: Callers can easily check the availability of other HTTP::Response methods
as follows:
my $response = TWiki::Func::getExternalResource($url);
if (!$response->is_error() && $response->isa('HTTP::Response')) {
... other methods of HTTP::Response may be called
} else {
... only the methods listed above may be called
}
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
getCgiQuery( ) -> $query
Get CGI query object. Important: Plugins cannot assume that scripts run under CGI, Plugins must always test if the CGI query object is set
Return:
$query
CGI query object; or 0 if script is called as a shell script
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getSessionKeys() -> @keys
Get a list of all the names of session variables. The list is unsorted.
Session keys are stored and retrieved using
setSessionValue
and
getSessionValue
.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
getSessionValue( $key ) -> $value
Get a session value from the client session module
Return:
$value
Value associated with key; empty string if not set
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (27 Feb 200)
setSessionValue( $key, $value ) -> $boolean
Set a session value.
-
$key
- Session key
-
$value
- Value associated with key
Return: true if function succeeded
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (17 Aug 2001)
clearSessionValue( $key ) -> $boolean
Clear a session value that was set using
setSessionValue
.
-
$key
- name of value stored in session to be cleared. Note that you cannot clear AUTHUSER
.
Return: true if the session value was cleared
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
getContext() -> \%hash
Get a hash of context identifiers representing the currently active
context.
The context is a set of identifiers that are set
during specific phases of TWiki processing. For example, each of
the standard scripts in the 'bin' directory each has a context
identifier - the view script has 'view', the edit script has 'edit'
etc. So you can easily tell what 'type' of script your Plugin is
being called within. The core context identifiers are listed
in the
TWikiTemplates topic. Please be careful not to
overwrite any of these identifiers!
Context identifiers can be used to communicate between Plugins, and between
Plugins and templates. For example, in
FirstPlugin? .pm, you might write:
sub initPlugin {
TWiki::Func::getContext()->{'MyID'} = 1;
...
This can be used in SecondPlugin.pm like this:
sub initPlugin {
if( TWiki::Func::getContext()->{'MyID'} ) {
...
}
...
or in a template, like this:
%TMPL:DEF{"ON"}% Not off %TMPL:END%
%TMPL:DEF{"OFF"}% Not on %TMPL:END%
%TMPL:P{context="MyID" then="ON" else="OFF"}%
or in a topic:
%IF{"context MyID" then="MyID is ON" else="MyID is OFF"}%
Note:
all plugins have an
automatically generated context identifier
if they are installed and initialised. For example, if the
FirstPlugin? is
working, the context ID 'FirstPlugin' will be set.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
pushTopicContext($web, $topic)
-
$web
- new web
-
$topic
- new topic
Change the TWiki context so it behaves as if it was processing
$web.$topic
from now on. All the preferences will be reset to those of the new topic.
Note that if the new topic is not readable by the logged in user due to
access control considerations, there will
not be an exception. It is the
duty of the caller to check access permissions before changing the topic.
It is the duty of the caller to restore the original context by calling
popTopicContext
.
Note that this call does
not re-initialise plugins, so if you have used
global variables to remember the web and topic in
initPlugin
, then those
values will be unchanged.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
popTopicContext()
Returns the TWiki context to the state it was in before the
pushTopicContext
was called.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
Preferences
getPreferencesValue( $key, $web ) -> $value
Get a preferences value from TWiki or from a Plugin
-
$key
- Preferences key
-
$web
- Name of web, optional. Current web if not specified; does not apply to settings of Plugin topics
Return:
$value
Preferences value; empty string if not set
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
- Example for Plugin setting:
- MyPlugin? topic has:
* Set COLOR = red
- Use
"MYPLUGIN_COLOR"
for $key
-
my $color = TWiki::Func::getPreferencesValue( "MYPLUGIN_COLOR" );
- Example for preferences setting:
- WebPreferences topic has:
* Set WEBBGCOLOR = #FFFFC0
-
my $webColor = TWiki::Func::getPreferencesValue( 'WEBBGCOLOR', 'Sandbox' );
NOTE: As of TWiki4.1, if
$NO_PREFS_IN_TOPIC
is enabled in the plugin, then
preferences set in the plugin topic will be ignored.
getPluginPreferencesValue( $key ) -> $value
Get a preferences value from your Plugin
-
$key
- Plugin Preferences key w/o PLUGINNAME_ prefix.
Return:
$value
Preferences value; empty string if not set
Note: This function will will
only work when called from the Plugin.pm file itself. it
will not work if called from a sub-package (e.g. TWiki::Plugins::MyPlugin::MyModule)
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.021 (27 Mar 2004)
NOTE: As of TWiki4.1, if
$NO_PREFS_IN_TOPIC
is enabled in the plugin, then
preferences set in the plugin topic will be ignored.
getPreferencesFlag( $key, $web ) -> $value
Get a preferences flag from TWiki or from a Plugin
-
$key
- Preferences key
-
$web
- Name of web, optional. Current web if not specified; does not apply to settings of Plugin topics
Return:
$value
Preferences flag
'1'
(if set), or
"0"
(for preferences values
"off"
,
"no"
and
"0"
)
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
- Example for Plugin setting:
- MyPlugin? topic has:
* Set SHOWHELP = off
- Use
"MYPLUGIN_SHOWHELP"
for $key
-
my $showHelp = TWiki::Func::getPreferencesFlag( "MYPLUGIN_SHOWHELP" );
NOTE: As of TWiki4.1, if
$NO_PREFS_IN_TOPIC
is enabled in the plugin, then
preferences set in the plugin topic will be ignored.
getPluginPreferencesFlag( $key ) -> $boolean
Get a preferences flag from your Plugin
-
$key
- Plugin Preferences key w/o PLUGINNAME_ prefix.
Return: false for preferences values
"off"
,
"no"
and
"0"
, or values not set at all. True otherwise.
Note: This function will will
only work when called from the Plugin.pm file itself. it
will not work if called from a sub-package (e.g. TWiki::Plugins::MyPlugin::MyModule)
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.021 (27 Mar 2004)
NOTE: As of TWiki4.1, if
$NO_PREFS_IN_TOPIC
is enabled in the plugin, then
preferences set in the plugin topic will be ignored.
setPreferencesValue($name, $val)
Set the preferences value so that future calls to getPreferencesValue will
return this value, and
%$name%
will expand to the preference when used in
future variable expansions.
The preference only persists for the rest of this request. Finalised
preferences cannot be redefined using this function.
Returns 1 if the preference was defined, and 0 otherwise.
getWikiToolName( ) -> $name
Get toolname as defined in TWiki.cfg
Return:
$name
Name of tool, e.g.
'TWiki'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (27 Feb 2001)
getMainWebname( ) -> $name
Get name of Main web as defined in TWiki.cfg
Return:
$name
Name, e.g.
'Main'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (27 Feb 2001)
getTwikiWebname( ) -> $name
Get name of TWiki documentation web as defined in TWiki.cfg
Return:
$name
Name, e.g.
'TWiki'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (27 Feb 2001)
User Handling and Access Control
getDefaultUserName( ) -> $loginName
Get default user name as defined in the configuration as
DefaultUserLogin
Return:
$loginName
Default user name, e.g.
'guest'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getCanonicalUserID( $user ) -> $cUID
-
$user
can be a login, wikiname or web.wikiname
Return the cUID of the specified user. A cUID is a unique identifier which
is assigned by TWiki for each user.
BEWARE: While the default
TWikiUserMapping? uses a cUID that looks like a user's
LoginName, some characters are modified to make them compatible with rcs.
Other usermappings may use other conventions - the JoomlaUserMapping
for example, has cUIDs like 'JoomlaeUserMapping_1234'.
If $user is undefined, it assumes the currently logged-in user.
Return:
$cUID
, an internal unique and portable escaped identifier for
registered users. This may be autogenerated for an authenticated but
unregistered user.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
getWikiName( $user ) -> $wikiName
return the
WikiName of the specified user
if $user is undefined Get Wiki name of logged in user
- $user can be a cUID, login, wikiname or web.wikiname
Return:
$wikiName
Wiki Name, e.g.
'JohnDoe'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getWikiUserName( $user ) -> $wikiName
return the userWeb.WikiName of the specified user
if $user is undefined Get Wiki name of logged in user
- $user can be a cUID, login, wikiname or web.wikiname
Return:
$wikiName
Wiki Name, e.g.
"Main.JohnDoe"
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
wikiToUserName( $id ) -> $loginName
Translate a Wiki name to a login name.
-
$id
- Wiki name, e.g. 'Main.JohnDoe'
or 'JohnDoe'
. Since TWiki 4.2.1, $id may also be a login name. This will normally be transparent, but should be borne in mind if you have login names that are also legal wiki names.
Return:
$loginName
Login name of user, e.g.
'jdoe'
, or undef if not
matched.
Note that it is possible for several login names to map to the same wikiname.
This function will only return the
first login name that maps to the
wikiname.
returns undef if the
WikiName is not found.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
userToWikiName( $loginName, $dontAddWeb ) -> $wikiName
Translate a login name to a Wiki name
-
$loginName
- Login name, e.g. 'jdoe'
. Since TWiki 4.2.1 this may also be a wiki name. This will normally be transparent, but may be relevant if you have login names that are also valid wiki names.
-
$dontAddWeb
- Do not add web prefix if "1"
Return:
$wikiName
Wiki name of user, e.g.
'Main.JohnDoe'
or
'JohnDoe'
userToWikiName will always return a name. If the user does not
exist in the mapping, the $loginName parameter is returned. (backward compatibility)
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
emailToWikiNames( $email, $dontAddWeb ) -> @wikiNames
-
$email
- email address to look up
-
$dontAddWeb
- Do not add web prefix if "1"
Find the wikinames of all users who have the given email address as their
registered address. Since several users could register with the same email
address, this returns a list of wikinames rather than a single wikiname.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
wikinameToEmails( $user ) -> @emails
-
$user
- wikiname of user to look up
Returns the registered email addresses of the named user. If $user is
undef, returns the registered email addresses for the logged-in user.
Since TWiki 4.2.1, $user may also be a login name, or the name of a group.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
isGuest( ) -> $boolean
Test if logged in user is a guest (
TWikiGuest? )
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
isAnAdmin( $id ) -> $boolean
Find out if the user is an admin or not. If the user is not given,
the currently logged-in user is assumed.
- $id can be either a login name or a WikiName
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
isGroupMember( $group, $id ) -> $boolean
Find out if $id is in the named group. e.g.
if( TWiki::Func::isGroupMember( "HesperionXXGroup", "jordi" )) {
...
}
If
$user
is
undef
, it defaults to the currently logged-in user.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
eachUser() -> $iterator
Get an iterator over the list of all the registered users
not including
groups. The iterator will return each wiki name in turn (e.g. 'FredBloggs').
Use it as follows:
my $iterator = TWiki::Func::eachUser();
while ($it->hasNext()) {
my $user = $it->next();
# $user is a wikiname
}
WARNING on large sites, this could be a long list!
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
eachMembership($id) -> $iterator
-
$id
- WikiName or login name of the user. If $id
is undef
, defaults to the currently logged-in user.
Get an iterator over the names of all groups that the user is a member of.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
eachGroup() -> $iterator
Get an iterator over all groups.
Use it as follows:
my $iterator = TWiki::Func::eachGroup();
while ($it->hasNext()) {
my $group = $it->next();
# $group is a group name e.g. TWikiAdminGroup
}
WARNING on large sites, this could be a long list!
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
isGroup( $group ) -> $boolean
Checks if
$group
is the name of a group known to TWiki.
eachGroupMember($group) -> $iterator
Get an iterator over all the members of the named group. Returns undef if
$group is not a valid group.
Use it as follows:
my $iterator = TWiki::Func::eachGroupMember('RadioheadGroup');
while ($it->hasNext()) {
my $user = $it->next();
# $user is a wiki name e.g. 'TomYorke', 'PhilSelway'
}
WARNING on large sites, this could be a long list!
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
checkAccessPermission( $type, $id, $text, $topic, $web, $meta ) -> $boolean
Check access permission for a topic based on the
TWiki.TWikiAccessControl rules
-
$type
- Access type, required, e.g. 'VIEW'
, 'CHANGE'
.
-
$id
- WikiName of remote user, required, e.g. "PeterThoeny"
. From TWiki 4.2.1, $id may also be a login name. If $id
is '', 0 or undef
then access is always permitted.
-
$text
- Topic text, optional. If 'perl false' (undef, 0 or ''), topic $web.$topic
is consulted. $text
may optionally contain embedded %META:PREFERENCE
tags. Provide this parameter if:
- You are setting different access controls in the text to those defined in the stored topic,
- You already have the topic text in hand, and want to help TWiki avoid having to read it again,
- You are providing a
$meta
parameter.
-
$topic
- Topic name, required, e.g. 'PrivateStuff'
-
$web
- Web name, required, e.g. 'Sandbox'
-
$meta
- Meta-data object, as returned by readTopic
. Optional. If undef
, but $text
is defined, then access controls will be parsed from $text
. If defined, then metadata embedded in $text
will be ignored. This parameter is always ignored if $text
is undefined. Settings in $meta
override Set
settings in $text.
A perl true result indicates that access is permitted.
Note the weird parameter order is due to compatibility constraints with
earlier TWiki releases.
Tip if you want, you can use this method to check your own access control types. For example, if you:
- Set ALLOWTOPICSPIN = IncyWincy?
in
ThatWeb.ThisTopic
, then a call to
checkAccessPermissions('SPIN', 'IncyWincy', undef, 'ThisTopic', 'ThatWeb', undef)
will return
true
.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (27 Feb 2001)
Webs, Topics and Attachments
getListOfWebs( $filter ) -> @webs
-
$filter
- spec of web types to recover
Gets a list of webs, filtered according to the spec in the $filter,
which may include one of:
- 'user' (for only user webs)
- 'template' (for only template webs i.e. those starting with "_")
$filter
may also contain the word 'public' which will further filter
out webs that have NOSEARCHALL set on them.
'allowed' filters out webs the current user can't read.
For example, the deprecated getPublicWebList function can be duplicated
as follows:
my @webs = TWiki::Func::getListOfWebs( "user,public" );
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
webExists( $web ) -> $boolean
Test if web exists
-
$web
- Web name, required, e.g. 'Sandbox'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (14 Jul 2001)
createWeb( $newWeb, $baseWeb, $opts )
-
$newWeb
is the name of the new web.
-
$baseWeb
is the name of an existing web (a template web). If the base web is a system web, all topics in it will be copied into the new web. If it is a normal web, only topics starting with 'Web' will be copied. If no base web is specified, an empty web (with no topics) will be created. If it is specified but does not exist, an error will be thrown.
-
$opts
is a ref to a hash that contains settings to be modified in
the web preferences topic in the new web.
use Error qw( :try );
use TWiki::AccessControlException;
try {
TWiki::Func::createWeb( "Newweb" );
} catch Error::Simple with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on Error::Simple
} catch TWiki::AccessControlException with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on TWiki::AccessControlException
} otherwise {
...
};
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
moveWeb( $oldName, $newName )
Move (rename) a web.
use Error qw( :try );
use TWiki::AccessControlException;
try {
TWiki::Func::moveWeb( "Oldweb", "Newweb" );
} catch Error::Simple with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on Error::Simple
} catch TWiki::AccessControlException with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on TWiki::AccessControlException
} otherwise {
...
};
To delete a web, move it to a subweb of
Trash
TWiki::Func::moveWeb( "Deadweb", "Trash.Deadweb" );
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
eachChangeSince($web, $time) -> $iterator
Get an iterator over the list of all the changes in the given web between
$time
and now. $time is a time in seconds since 1st Jan 1970, and is not
guaranteed to return any changes that occurred before (now -
{Store}{RememberChangesFor}). {Store}{RememberChangesFor}) is a
setting in
configure
. Changes are returned in
most-recent-first
order.
Use it as follows:
my $iterator = TWiki::Func::eachChangeSince(
$web, time() - 7 * 24 * 60 * 60); # the last 7 days
while ($iterator->hasNext()) {
my $change = $iterator->next();
# $change is a perl hash that contains the following fields:
# topic => topic name
# user => wikiname - wikiname of user who made the change
# time => time of the change
# revision => revision number *after* the change
# more => more info about the change (e.g. 'minor')
}
getTopicList( $web ) -> @topics
Get list of all topics in a web
-
$web
- Web name, required, e.g. 'Sandbox'
Return:
@topics
Topic list, e.g.
( 'WebChanges', 'WebHome', 'WebIndex', 'WebNotify' )
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
topicExists( $web, $topic ) -> $boolean
Test if topic exists
-
$web
- Web name, optional, e.g. 'Main'
.
-
$topic
- Topic name, required, e.g. 'TokyoOffice'
, or "Main.TokyoOffice"
$web and $topic are parsed as described in the documentation for
normalizeWebTopicName
.
Specifically, the Main is used if $web is not specified and $topic has no web specifier.
To get an expected behaviour it is recommened to specify the current web for $web; don't leave it empty.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (14 Jul 2001)
checkTopicEditLock( $web, $topic, $script ) -> ( $oopsUrl, $loginName, $unlockTime )
Check if a lease has been taken by some other user.
-
$web
Web name, e.g. "Main"
, or empty
-
$topic
Topic name, e.g. "MyTopic"
, or "Main.MyTopic"
Return:
( $oopsUrl, $loginName, $unlockTime )
- The
$oopsUrl
for calling redirectCgiQuery(), user's
$loginName
, and estimated
$unlockTime
in minutes, or ( '', '', 0 ) if no lease exists.
-
$script
The script to invoke when continuing with the edit
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.010 (31 Dec 2002)
setTopicEditLock( $web, $topic, $lock )
-
$web
Web name, e.g. "Main"
, or empty
-
$topic
Topic name, e.g. "MyTopic"
, or "Main.MyTopic"
-
$lock
1 to lease the topic, 0 to clear an existing lease
Takes out a "lease" on the topic. The lease doesn't prevent
anyone from editing and changing the topic, but it does redirect them
to a warning screen, so this provides some protection. The
edit
script
always takes out a lease.
It is
impossible to fully lock a topic. Concurrent changes will be
merged.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.010 (31 Dec 2002)
saveTopic( $web, $topic, $meta, $text, $options ) -> $error
-
$web
- web for the topic
-
$topic
- topic name
-
$meta
- reference to TWiki::Meta object
-
$text
- text of the topic (without embedded meta-data!!!
-
\%options
- ref to hash of save options \%options
may include: dontlog | don't log this change in twiki log |
forcenewrevision | force the save to increment the revision counter |
minor | True if this is a minor change, and is not to be notified |
Return: error message or undef.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (29 Jul 2001)
For example,
my( $meta, $text ) = TWiki::Func::readTopic( $web, $topic )
$text =~ s/APPLE/ORANGE/g;
TWiki::Func::saveTopic( $web, $topic, $meta, $text, { forcenewrevision => 1 } );
Note: Plugins handlers ( e.g.
beforeSaveHandler
) will be called as
appropriate.
saveTopicText( $web, $topic, $text, $ignorePermissions, $dontNotify ) -> $oopsUrl
Save topic text, typically obtained by readTopicText(). Topic data usually includes meta data; the file attachment meta data is replaced by the meta data from the topic file if it exists.
-
$web
- Web name, e.g. 'Main'
, or empty
-
$topic
- Topic name, e.g. 'MyTopic'
, or "Main.MyTopic"
-
$text
- Topic text to save, assumed to include meta data
-
$ignorePermissions
- Set to "1"
if checkAccessPermission() is already performed and OK
-
$dontNotify
- Set to "1"
if not to notify users of the change
Return:
$oopsUrl
Empty string if OK; the
$oopsUrl
for calling redirectCgiQuery() in case of error
This method is a lot less efficient and much more dangerous than
saveTopic
.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.010 (31 Dec 2002)
my $text = TWiki::Func::readTopicText( $web, $topic );
# check for oops URL in case of error:
if( $text =~ /^http.*?\/oops/ ) {
TWiki::Func::redirectCgiQuery( $query, $text );
return;
}
# do topic text manipulation like:
$text =~ s/old/new/g;
# do meta data manipulation like:
$text =~ s/(META\:FIELD.*?name\=\"TopicClassification\".*?value\=\")[^\"]*/$1BugResolved/;
$oopsUrl = TWiki::Func::saveTopicText( $web, $topic, $text ); # save topic text
moveTopic( $web, $topic, $newWeb, $newTopic )
-
$web
source web - required
-
$topic
source topic - required
-
$newWeb
dest web
-
$newTopic
dest topic
Renames the topic. Throws an exception if something went wrong.
If $newWeb is undef, it defaults to $web. If $newTopic is undef, it defaults
to $topic.
The destination topic must not already exist.
Rename a topic to the $TWiki::cfg{TrashWebName} to delete it.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
use Error qw( :try );
try {
moveTopic( "Work", "TokyoOffice", "Trash", "ClosedOffice" );
} catch Error::Simple with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on Error::Simple
} catch TWiki::AccessControlException with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on TWiki::AccessControlException
} otherwise {
...
};
getRevisionInfo($web, $topic, $rev, $attachment ) -> ( $date, $user, $rev, $comment )
Get revision info of a topic or attachment
-
$web
- Web name, optional, e.g. 'Main'
-
$topic
- Topic name, required, e.g. 'TokyoOffice'
-
$rev
- revsion number, or tag name (can be in the format 1.2, or just the minor number)
-
$attachment
-attachment filename
Return:
( $date, $user, $rev, $comment )
List with: ( last update date, login name of last user, minor part of top revision number ), e.g.
( 1234561, 'phoeny', "5" )
$date |
in epochSec |
$user |
Wiki name of the author (not login name) |
$rev |
actual rev number |
$comment |
WHAT COMMENT? |
NOTE: if you are trying to get revision info for a topic, use
$meta->getRevisionInfo
instead if you can - it is significantly
more efficient.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (29 Jul 2001)
getRevisionAtTime( $web, $topic, $time ) -> $rev
Get the revision number of a topic at a specific time.
-
$web
- web for topic
-
$topic
- topic
-
$time
- time (in epoch secs) for the rev
Return: Single-digit revision number, or undef if it couldn't be determined
(either because the topic isn't that old, or there was a problem)
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
readTopic( $web, $topic, $rev ) -> ( $meta, $text )
Read topic text and meta data, regardless of access permissions.
-
$web
- Web name, required, e.g. 'Main'
-
$topic
- Topic name, required, e.g. 'TokyoOffice'
-
$rev
- revision to read (default latest)
Return:
( $meta, $text )
Meta data object and topic text
$meta
is a perl 'object' of class
TWiki::Meta
. This class is
fully documented in the source code documentation shipped with the
release, or can be inspected in the
lib/TWiki/Meta.pm
file.
This method
ignores topic access permissions. You should be careful to use
checkAccessPermissions
to ensure the current user has read access to the
topic.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
readTopicText( $web, $topic, $rev, $ignorePermissions ) -> $text
Read topic text, including meta data
-
$web
- Web name, e.g. 'Main'
, or empty
-
$topic
- Topic name, e.g. 'MyTopic'
, or "Main.MyTopic"
-
$rev
- Topic revision to read, optional. Specify the minor part of the revision, e.g. "5"
, not "1.5"
; the top revision is returned if omitted or empty.
-
$ignorePermissions
- Set to "1"
if checkAccessPermission() is already performed and OK; an oops URL is returned if user has no permission
Return:
$text
Topic text with embedded meta data; an oops URL for calling redirectCgiQuery() is returned in case of an error
This method is more efficient than
readTopic
, but returns meta-data embedded in the text. Plugins authors must be very careful to avoid damaging meta-data. You are recommended to use readTopic instead, which is a lot safer.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.010 (31 Dec 2002)
attachmentExists( $web, $topic, $attachment ) -> $boolean
Test if attachment exists
-
$web
- Web name, optional, e.g. Main
.
-
$topic
- Topic name, required, e.g. TokyoOffice
, or Main.TokyoOffice
-
$attachment
- attachment name, e.g.=logo.gif=
$web and $topic are parsed as described in the documentation for
normalizeWebTopicName
.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
readAttachment( $web, $topic, $name, $rev ) -> $data
-
$web
- web for topic
-
$topic
- topic
-
$name
- attachment name
-
$rev
- revision to read (default latest)
Read an attachment from the store for a topic, and return it as a string. The
names of attachments on a topic can be recovered from the meta-data returned
by
readTopic
. If the attachment does not exist, or cannot be read, undef
will be returned. If the revision is not specified, the latest version will
be returned.
View permission on the topic is required for the
read to be successful. Access control violations are flagged by a
TWiki::AccessControlException. Permissions are checked for the current user.
my( $meta, $text ) = TWiki::Func::readTopic( $web, $topic );
my @attachments = $meta->find( 'FILEATTACHMENT' );
foreach my $a ( @attachments ) {
try {
my $data = TWiki::Func::readAttachment( $web, $topic, $a->{name} );
...
} catch TWiki::AccessControlException with {
};
}
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
saveAttachment( $web, $topic, $attachment, $opts )
-
$web
- web for topic
-
$topic
- topic to atach to
-
$attachment
- name of the attachment
-
$opts
- Ref to hash of options
$opts
may include:
dontlog |
don't log this change in twiki log |
comment |
comment for save |
hide |
if the attachment is to be hidden in normal topic view |
stream |
Stream of file to upload |
file |
Name of a file to use for the attachment data. ignored if stream is set. Local file on the server. |
filepath |
Client path to file |
filesize |
Size of uploaded data |
filedate |
Date |
Save an attachment to the store for a topic. On success, returns undef. If there is an error, an exception will be thrown.
try {
TWiki::Func::saveAttachment( $web, $topic, 'image.gif',
{ file => 'image.gif',
comment => 'Picture of Health',
hide => 1 } );
} catch Error::Simple with {
# see documentation on Error
} otherwise {
...
};
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
moveAttachment( $web, $topic, $attachment, $newWeb, $newTopic, $newAttachment )
-
$web
source web - required
-
$topic
source topic - required
-
$attachment
source attachment - required
-
$newWeb
dest web
-
$newTopic
dest topic
-
$newAttachment
dest attachment
Renames the topic. Throws an exception on error or access violation.
If $newWeb is undef, it defaults to $web. If $newTopic is undef, it defaults
to $topic. If $newAttachment is undef, it defaults to $attachment. If all of $newWeb, $newTopic and $newAttachment are undef, it is an error.
The destination topic must already exist, but the destination attachment must
not exist.
Rename an attachment to $TWiki::cfg{TrashWebName}.TrashAttament to delete it.
use Error qw( :try );
try {
# move attachment between topics
moveAttachment( "Countries", "Germany", "AlsaceLorraine.dat",
"Countries", "France" );
# Note destination attachment name is defaulted to the same as source
} catch TWiki::AccessControlException with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on TWiki::AccessControlException
} catch Error::Simple with {
my $e = shift;
# see documentation on Error::Simple
};
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
Assembling Pages
readTemplate( $name, $skin ) -> $text
Read a template or skin. Embedded
template directives get expanded
-
$name
- Template name, e.g. 'view'
-
$skin
- Comma-separated list of skin names, optional, e.g. 'print'
Return:
$text
Template text
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
loadTemplate ( $name, $skin, $web ) -> $text
-
$name
- template file name
-
$skin
- comma-separated list of skins to use (default: current skin)
-
$web
- the web to look in for topics that contain templates (default: current web)
Return: expanded template text (what's left after removal of all %TMPL:DEF% statements)
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
Reads a template and extracts template definitions, adding them to the
list of loaded templates, overwriting any previous definition.
How TWiki searches for templates is described in
TWikiTemplates.
If template text is found, extracts include statements and fully expands them.
expandTemplate( $def ) -> $string
Do a , only expanding the template (not expanding any variables other than %TMPL)
Return: the text of the expanded template
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
A template is defined using a %TMPL:DEF% statement in a template
file. See the documentation on TWiki templates for more information.
writeHeader( $query, $contentLength )
Prints a basic content-type HTML header for text/html to standard out
-
$query
- CGI query object. If not given, the default CGI query will be used (optional, in most cases you should not pass this parameter)
-
$contentLength
- Length of content (optional, in most cases you should not pass this parameter)
Return: none
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
redirectCgiQuery( $query, $url, $passthru )
Redirect to URL
-
$query
- CGI query object. Ignored, only there for compatibility. The session CGI query object is used instead.
-
$url
- URL to redirect to
-
$passthru
- enable passthrough.
Return: none
Print output to STDOUT that will cause a 302 redirect to a new URL.
Nothing more should be printed to STDOUT after this method has been called.
The
$passthru
parameter allows you to pass the parameters that were passed
to the current query on to the target URL, as long as it is another URL on the
same TWiki installation. If
$passthru
is set to a true value, then TWiki
will save the current URL parameters, and then try to restore them on the
other side of the redirect. Parameters are stored on the server in a cache
file.
Note that if
$passthru
is set, then any parameters in
$url
will be lost
when the old parameters are restored. if you want to change any parameter
values, you will need to do that in the current CGI query before redirecting
e.g.
my $query = TWiki::Func::getCgiQuery();
$query->param(-name => 'text', -value => 'Different text');
TWiki::Func::redirectCgiQuery(
undef, TWiki::Func::getScriptUrl($web, $topic, 'edit'), 1);
$passthru
does nothing if
$url
does not point to a script in the current
TWiki installation.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
addToHEAD( $id, $header )
Adds
$header
to the HTML header (the tag).
This is useful for Plugins that want to include some javascript custom css.
-
$id
- Unique ID to prevent the same HTML from being duplicated. Plugins should use a prefix to prevent name clashes (e.g EDITTABLEPLUGIN_JSCALENDAR)
-
$header
- the HTML to be added to the section. The HTML must be valid in a HEAD tag - no checks are performed.
All TWiki variables present in
$header
will be expanded before being inserted into the
section.
Note that this is
not the same as the HTTP header, which is modified through the Plugins
modifyHeaderHandler
.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
example:
TWiki::Func::addToHEAD('PATTERN_STYLE','<link id="twikiLayoutCss" rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="%PUBURL%/TWiki/PatternSkin/layout.css" media="all" />')
expandCommonVariables( $text, $topic, $web, $meta ) -> $text
Expand all common
%VARIABLES%
-
$text
- Text with variables to expand, e.g. 'Current user is %WIKIUSER%'
-
$topic
- Current topic name, e.g. 'WebNotify'
-
$web
- Web name, optional, e.g. 'Main'
. The current web is taken if missing
-
$meta
- topic meta-data to use while expanding (Since TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2)
Return:
$text
Expanded text, e.g.
'Current user is TWikiGuest'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
See also: expandVariablesOnTopicCreation
renderText( $text, $web ) -> $text
Render text from TWiki markup into XHTML as defined in
TWiki.TextFormattingRules
-
$text
- Text to render, e.g. '*bold* text and =fixed font='
-
$web
- Web name, optional, e.g. 'Main'
. The current web is taken if missing
Return:
$text
XHTML text, e.g.
'<b>bold</b> and <code>fixed font</code>'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
internalLink( $pre, $web, $topic, $label, $anchor, $createLink ) -> $text
Render topic name and link label into an XHTML link. Normally you do not need to call this funtion, it is called internally by
renderText()
-
$pre
- Text occuring before the TWiki link syntax, optional
-
$web
- Web name, required, e.g. 'Main'
-
$topic
- Topic name to link to, required, e.g. 'WebNotify'
-
$label
- Link label, required. Usually the same as $topic
, e.g. 'notify'
-
$anchor
- Anchor, optional, e.g. '#Jump'
-
$createLink
- Set to '1'
to add question linked mark after topic name if topic does not exist;
set to '0'
to suppress link for non-existing topics
Return:
$text
XHTML anchor, e.g.
'<a href='/cgi-bin/view/Main/WebNotify#Jump'>notify</a>'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
E-mail
sendEmail ( $text, $retries ) -> $error
-
$text
- text of the mail, including MIME headers
-
$retries
- number of times to retry the send (default 1)
Send an e-mail specified as MIME format content. To specify MIME
format mails, you create a string that contains a set of header
lines that contain field definitions and a message body such as:
To: liz@windsor.gov.uk
From: serf@hovel.net
CC: george@whitehouse.gov
Subject: Revolution
Dear Liz,
Please abolish the monarchy (with King George's permission, of course)
Thanks,
A. Peasant
Leave a blank line between the last header field and the message body.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
wikiToEmail( $wikiName ) -> $email
-
$wikiname
- wiki name of the user
Get the e-mail address(es) of the named user. If the user has multiple
e-mail addresses (for example, the user is a group), then the list will
be comma-separated.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
Deprecated in favour of wikinameToEmails, because this function only
returns a single email address, where a user may in fact have several.
Since TWiki 4.2.1, $wikiName may also be a login name.
Creating New Topics
expandVariablesOnTopicCreation ( $text ) -> $text
Expand the limited set of variables that are always expanded during topic creation
-
$text
- the text to process
Return: text with variables expanded
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
Expands only the variables expected in templates that must be statically
expanded in new content.
The expanded variables are:
-
%DATE%
Signature-format date
-
%SERVERTIME%
See TWikiVariables
-
%GMTIME%
See TWikiVariables
-
%USERNAME%
Base login name
-
%WIKINAME%
Wiki name
-
%WIKIUSERNAME%
Wiki name with prepended web
-
%URLPARAM{...}%
- Parameters to the current CGI query
-
%NOP%
No-op
See also: expandVariables
Special handlers
Special handlers can be defined to make functions in plugins behave as if they were built-in to TWiki.
registerTagHandler( $var, \&fn, $syntax )
Should only be called from initPlugin.
Register a function to handle a simple variable. Handles both %VAR% and %VAR{...}%. Registered variables are treated the same as TWiki internal variables, and are expanded at the same time. This is a
lot more efficient than using the
commonTagsHandler
.
-
$var
- The name of the variable, i.e. the 'MYVAR' part of %MYVAR%. The variable name must match /^[A-Z][A-Z0-9_]*$/ or it won't work.
-
\&fn
- Reference to the handler function.
-
$syntax
can be 'classic' (the default) or 'context-free'. 'classic' syntax is appropriate where you want the variable to support classic TWiki syntax i.e. to accept the standard %MYVAR{ "unnamed" param1="value1" param2="value2" }%
syntax, as well as an unquoted default parameter, such as %MYVAR{unquoted parameter}%
. If your variable will only use named parameters, you can use 'context-free' syntax, which supports a more relaxed syntax. For example, %MYVAR{param1=value1, value 2, param3="value 3", param4='value 5"}%
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
The variable handler function must be of the form:
sub handler(\%session, \%params, $topic, $web)
where:
-
\%session
- a reference to the TWiki session object (may be ignored)
-
\%params
- a reference to a TWiki::Attrs object containing parameters. This can be used as a simple hash that maps parameter names to values, with _DEFAULT being the name for the default parameter.
-
$topic
- name of the topic in the query
-
$web
- name of the web in the query
for example, to execute an arbitrary command on the server, you might do this:
sub initPlugin{
TWiki::Func::registerTagHandler('EXEC', \&boo);
}
sub boo {
my( $session, $params, $topic, $web ) = @_;
my $cmd = $params->{_DEFAULT};
return "NO COMMAND SPECIFIED" unless $cmd;
my $result = `$cmd 2>&1`;
return $params->{silent} ? '' : $result;
}
}
would let you do this:
%EXEC{"ps -Af" silent="on"}%
Registered tags differ from tags implemented using the old TWiki approach (text substitution in
commonTagsHandler
) in the following ways:
- registered tags are evaluated at the same time as system tags, such as %SERVERTIME.
commonTagsHandler
is only called later, when all system tags have already been expanded (though they are expanded again after commonTagsHandler
returns).
- registered tag names can only contain alphanumerics and _ (underscore)
- registering a tag
FRED
defines both %FRED{...}%
and also %FRED%
.
- registered tag handlers cannot return another tag as their only result (e.g.
return '%SERVERTIME%';
). It won't work.
registerRESTHandler( $alias, \&fn, )
Should only be called from initPlugin.
Adds a function to the dispatch table of the REST interface
-
$alias
- The name .
-
\&fn
- Reference to the function.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
The handler function must be of the form:
sub handler(\%session)
where:
-
\%session
- a reference to the TWiki session object (may be ignored)
From the REST interface, the name of the plugin must be used
as the subject of the invokation.
Example
The
EmptyPlugin has the following call in the initPlugin handler:
TWiki::Func::registerRESTHandler('example', \&restExample);
This adds the
restExample
function to the REST dispatch table
for the
EmptyPlugin under the 'example' alias, and allows it
to be invoked using the URL
http://server:port/bin/rest/EmptyPlugin/example
note that the URL
http://server:port/bin/rest/EmptyPlugin/restExample
(ie, with the name of the function instead of the alias) will not work.
decodeFormatTokens($str) -> $unencodedString
TWiki has an informal standard set of tokens used in
format
parameters that are used to block evaluation of paramater strings.
For example, if you were to write
%MYTAG{format="%WURBLE%"}%
then %WURBLE would be expanded
before %MYTAG is evaluated. To avoid
this TWiki uses escapes in the format string. For example:
%MYTAG{format="$percntWURBLE$percnt"}%
This lets you enter arbitrary strings into parameters without worrying that
TWiki will expand them before your plugin gets a chance to deal with them
properly. Once you have processed your tag, you will want to expand these
tokens to their proper value. That's what this function does.
Escape: |
Expands To: |
$n or $n() |
New line. Use $n() if followed by alphanumeric character, e.g. write Foo$n()Bar instead of Foo$nBar |
$nop or $nop() |
Is a "no operation". |
$quot |
Double quote (" ) |
$percnt |
Percent sign (% ) |
$dollar |
Dollar sign ($ ) |
Note thath $quot, $percnt and $dollar all work *even if they are followed by
alphanumeric characters*. You have been warned!
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
Searching
searchInWebContent($searchString, $web, \@topics, \%options ) -> \%map
Search for a string in the content of a web. The search is over all content, including meta-data. Meta-data matches will be returned as formatted lines within the topic content (meta-data matches are returned as lines of the format %META:\w+{.*}%)
-
$searchString
- the search string, in egrep format
-
$web
- The web to search in
-
\@topics
- reference to a list of topics to search
-
\%option
- reference to an options hash
The
\%options
hash may contain the following options:
-
type
- if regex
will perform a egrep-syntax RE search (default '')
-
casesensitive
- false to ignore case (defaulkt true)
-
files_without_match
- true to return files only (default false). If files_without_match
is specified, it will return on the first match in each topic (i.e. it will return only one match per topic, and will not return matching lines).
The return value is a reference to a hash which maps each matching topic
name to a list of the lines in that topic that matched the search,
as would be returned by 'grep'.
To iterate over the returned topics use:
my $result = TWiki::Func::searchInWebContent( "Slimy Toad", $web, \@topics,
{ casesensitive => 0, files_without_match => 0 } );
foreach my $topic (keys %$result ) {
foreach my $matching_line ( @{$result->{$topic}} ) {
...etc
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
Plugin-specific file handling
getWorkArea( $pluginName ) -> $directorypath
Gets a private directory for Plugin use. The Plugin is entirely responsible
for managing this directory; TWiki will not read from it, or write to it.
The directory is guaranteed to exist, and to be writable by the webserver
user. By default it will
not be web accessible.
The directory and it's contents are permanent, so Plugins must be careful
to keep their areas tidy.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1 (Dec 2005)
readFile( $filename ) -> $text
Read file, low level. Used for Plugin workarea.
-
$filename
- Full path name of file
Return:
$text
Content of file, empty if not found
NOTE: Use this function only for the Plugin workarea,
not for topics and attachments. Use the appropriate functions to manipulate topics and attachments.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (07 Dec 2002)
saveFile( $filename, $text )
Save file, low level. Used for Plugin workarea.
-
$filename
- Full path name of file
-
$text
- Text to save
Return: none
NOTE: Use this function only for the Plugin workarea,
not for topics and attachments. Use the appropriate functions to manipulate topics and attachments.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (07 Dec 2002)
General Utilities
getRegularExpression( $name ) -> $expr
Retrieves a TWiki predefined regular expression or character class.
-
$name
- Name of the expression to retrieve. See notes below
Return: String or precompiled regular expression matching as described below.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.020 (9 Feb 2004)
Note: TWiki internally precompiles several regular expressions to
represent various string entities in an I18N-compatible manner. Plugins
authors are encouraged to use these in matching where appropriate. The
following are guaranteed to be present. Others may exist, but their use
is unsupported and they may be removed in future TWiki versions.
In the table below, the expression marked type 'String' are intended for
use within character classes (i.e. for use within square brackets inside
a regular expression), for example:
my $upper = TWiki::Func::getRegularExpression('upperAlpha');
my $alpha = TWiki::Func::getRegularExpression('mixedAlpha');
my $capitalized = qr/[$upper][$alpha]+/;
Those expressions marked type 'RE' are precompiled regular expressions that can be used outside square brackets. For example:
my $webRE = TWiki::Func::getRegularExpression('webNameRegex');
my $isWebName = ( $s =~ m/$webRE/ );
Name |
Matches |
Type |
upperAlpha |
Upper case characters |
String |
upperAlphaNum |
Upper case characters and digits |
String |
lowerAlpha |
Lower case characters |
String |
lowerAlphaNum |
Lower case characters and digits |
String |
numeric |
Digits |
String |
mixedAlpha |
Alphabetic characters |
String |
mixedAlphaNum |
Alphanumeric characters |
String |
wikiWordRegex |
WikiWords |
RE |
webNameRegex |
User web names |
RE |
anchorRegex |
#AnchorNames |
RE |
abbrevRegex |
Abbreviations e.g. GOV, IRS |
RE |
emailAddrRegex |
email@addressNOSPAM.com |
RE |
tagNameRegex |
Standard variable names e.g. %THIS_BIT% (THIS_BIT only) |
RE |
normalizeWebTopicName($web, $topic) -> ($web, $topic)
Parse a web and topic name, supplying defaults as appropriate.
-
$web
- Web name, identifying variable, or empty string
-
$topic
- Topic name, may be a web.topic string, required.
Return: the parsed Web/Topic pair
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.1
Input |
Return |
( 'Web', 'Topic' ) |
( 'Web', 'Topic' ) |
( '', 'Topic' ) |
( 'Main', 'Topic' ) |
( '', '' ) |
( 'Main', 'WebHome' ) |
( '', 'Web/Topic' ) |
( 'Web', 'Topic' ) |
( '', 'Web/Subweb/Topic' ) |
( 'Web/Subweb', 'Topic' ) |
( '', 'Web.Topic' ) |
( 'Web', 'Topic' ) |
( '', 'Web.Subweb.Topic' ) |
( 'Web/Subweb', 'Topic' ) |
( 'Web1', 'Web2.Topic' ) |
( 'Web2', 'Topic' ) |
Note that hierarchical web names (
SubWeb? ) are only available if hierarchical webs are enabled in
configure
.
The symbols %USERSWEB%, %SYSTEMWEB% and %DOCWEB% can be used in the input to represent the web names set in $cfg{UsersWebName} and $cfg{SystemWebName}. For example:
Input |
Return |
( '%USERSWEB%', 'Topic' ) |
( 'Main', 'Topic' ) |
( '%SYSTEMWEB%', 'Topic' ) |
( 'TWiki', 'Topic' ) |
( '', '%DOCWEB%.Topic' ) |
( 'TWiki', 'Topic' ) |
StaticMethod sanitizeAttachmentName ($fname) -> ($fileName,$origName)
Given a file namer, sanitise it according to the rules for transforming
attachment names. Returns
the sanitised name together with the basename before sanitisation.
Sanitation includes filtering illegal characters and mapping client
file names to legal server names.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
spaceOutWikiWord( $word, $sep ) -> $text
Spaces out a wiki word by inserting a string (default: one space) between each word component.
With parameter $sep any string may be used as separator between the word components; if $sep is undefined it defaults to a space.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
writeWarning( $text )
Log Warning that may require admin intervention to data/warning.txt
-
$text
- Text to write; timestamp gets added
Return: none
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.020 (16 Feb 2004)
writeDebug( $text )
Log debug message to data/debug.txt
-
$text
- Text to write; timestamp gets added
Return: none
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.020 (16 Feb 2004)
formatTime( $time, $format, $timezone ) -> $text
Format the time in seconds into the desired time string
-
$time
- Time in epoc seconds
-
$format
- Format type, optional. Default e.g. '31 Dec 2002 - 19:30'
. Can be '$iso'
(e.g. '2002-12-31T19:30Z'
), '$rcs'
(e.g. '2001/12/31 23:59:59'
, '$http'
for HTTP header format (e.g. 'Thu, 23 Jul 1998 07:21:56 GMT'
), or any string with tokens '$seconds, $minutes, $hours, $day, $wday, $month, $mo, $year, $ye, $tz'
for seconds, minutes, hours, day of month, day of week, 3 letter month, 2 digit month, 4 digit year, 2 digit year, timezone string, respectively
-
$timezone
- either not defined (uses the displaytime setting), 'gmtime', or 'servertime'
Return:
$text
Formatted time string
Note: |
if you used the removed formatGmTime, add a third parameter 'gmtime' |
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.020 (26 Feb 2004)
isTrue( $value, $default ) -> $boolean
Returns 1 if
$value
is true, and 0 otherwise. "true" means set to
something with a Perl true value, with the special cases that "off",
"false" and "no" (case insensitive) are forced to false. Leading and
trailing spaces in
$value
are ignored.
If the value is undef, then
$default
is returned. If
$default
is
not specified it is taken as 0.
Since: $TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.2
isValidWikiWord ( $text ) -> $boolean
Check for a valid
WikiWord or
WikiName
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.100 (Dec 2005)
extractParameters($attr ) -> %params
Extract all parameters from a variable string and returns a hash of parameters
Return:
%params
Hash containing all parameters. The nameless parameter is stored in key
_DEFAULT
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.025 (26 Aug 2004)
- Example:
- Variable:
%TEST{ 'nameless' name1="val1" name2="val2" }%
- First extract text between
{...}
to get: 'nameless' name1="val1" name2="val2"
- Then call this on the text:
- params = TWiki::Func::extractParameters( $text );=
- The
%params
hash contains now:
_DEFAULT => 'nameless'
name1 => "val1"
name2 => "val2"
extractNameValuePair( $attr, $name ) -> $value
Extract a named or unnamed value from a variable parameter string
- Note: | Function TWiki::Func::extractParameters is more efficient for extracting several parameters
-
$attr
- Attribute string
-
$name
- Name, optional
Return:
$value
Extracted value
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
- Example:
- Variable:
%TEST{ 'nameless' name1="val1" name2="val2" }%
- First extract text between
{...}
to get: 'nameless' name1="val1" name2="val2"
- Then call this on the text:
my $noname = TWiki::Func::extractNameValuePair( $text );
my $val1 = TWiki::Func::extractNameValuePair( $text, "name1" );
my $val2 = TWiki::Func::extractNameValuePair( $text, "name2" );
Deprecated functions
From time-to-time, the TWiki developers will add new functions to the interface (either to
TWikiFuncDotPm, or new handlers). Sometimes these improvements mean that old functions have to be deprecated to keep the code manageable. When this happens, the deprecated functions will be supported in the interface for at least one more TWiki release, and probably longer, though this cannot be guaranteed.
Updated plugins may still need to define deprecated handlers for compatibility with old TWiki versions. In this case, the plugin package that defines old handlers can suppress the warnings in %FAILEDPLUGINS%.
This is done by defining a map from the handler name to the
TWiki::Plugins
version
in which the handler was first deprecated. For example, if we need to define the
endRenderingHandler
for compatibility with
TWiki::Plugins
versions before 1.1, we would add this to the plugin:
package TWiki::Plugins::SinkPlugin;
use vars qw( %TWikiCompatibility );
$TWikiCompatibility{endRenderingHandler} = 1.1;
If the currently-running TWiki version is 1.1
or later, then the
handler will not be called and
the warning will not be issued. TWiki with versions of
TWiki::Plugins
before 1.1 will still call the handler as required.
The following functions are retained for compatibility only. You should
stop using them as soon as possible.
getScriptUrlPath( ) -> $path
Get script URL path
DEPRECATED since 1.1 - use
getScriptUrl
instead.
Return:
$path
URL path of TWiki scripts, e.g.
"/cgi-bin"
WARNING: you are strongly recommended
not to use this function, as the
{ScriptUrlPaths} URL rewriting rules will not apply to urls generated
using it.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getOopsUrl( $web, $topic, $template, $param1, $param2, $param3, $param4 ) -> $url
Compose fully qualified 'oops' dialog URL
-
$web
- Web name, e.g. 'Main'
. The current web is taken if empty
-
$topic
- Topic name, e.g. 'WebNotify'
-
$template
- Oops template name, e.g. 'oopsmistake'
. The 'oops' is optional; 'mistake' will translate to 'oopsmistake'.
-
$param1
... $param4
- Parameter values for %PARAM1% ... %PARAMn% variables in template, optional
Return:
$url
URL, e.g.
"http://example.com:80/cgi-bin/oops.pl/ Main/WebNotify?template=oopslocked¶m1=joe"
DEPRECATED since 1.1, the recommended approach is to throw an
oops exception.
use Error qw( :try );
throw TWiki::OopsException(
'toestuckerror',
web => $web,
topic => $topic,
params => [ 'I got my toe stuck' ]);
(this example will use the
oopstoestuckerror
template.)
If this is not possible (e.g. in a REST handler that does not trap the exception)
then you can use
getScriptUrl
instead:
my $url = TWiki::Func::getScriptUrl($web, $topic, 'oops',
template => 'oopstoestuckerror',
param1 => 'I got my toe stuck');
TWiki::Func::redirectCgiQuery( undef, $url );
return 0;
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
permissionsSet( $web ) -> $boolean
Test if any access restrictions are set for this web, ignoring settings on
individual pages
-
$web
- Web name, required, e.g. 'Sandbox'
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (27 Feb 2001)
DEPRECATED since 1.2 - use
getPreferencesValue
instead to determine
what permissions are set on the web, for example:
foreach my $type qw( ALLOW DENY ) {
foreach my $action qw( CHANGE VIEW ) {
my $pref = $type . 'WEB' . $action;
my $val = getPreferencesValue( $pref, $web ) || '';
if( $val =~ /\S/ ) {
print "$pref is set to $val on $web\n";
}
}
}
getPublicWebList( ) -> @webs
DEPRECATED since 1.1 - use
getListOfWebs
instead.
Get list of all public webs, e.g. all webs that do not have the
NOSEARCHALL
flag set in the
WebPreferences
Return:
@webs
List of all public webs, e.g.
( 'Main', 'Know', 'TWiki' )
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (07 Dec 2002)
formatGmTime( $time, $format ) -> $text
DEPRECATED since 1.1 - use
formatTime
instead.
Format the time to GM time
-
$time
- Time in epoc seconds
-
$format
- Format type, optional. Default e.g. '31 Dec 2002 - 19:30'
, can be 'iso'
(e.g. '2002-12-31T19:30Z'
), 'rcs'
(e.g. '2001/12/31 23:59:59'
, 'http'
for HTTP header format (e.g. 'Thu, 23 Jul 1998 07:21:56 GMT'
)
Return:
$text
Formatted time string
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (7 Dec 2002)
getDataDir( ) -> $dir
DEPRECATED since 1.1 - use the "Webs, Topics and Attachments" functions to manipulate topics instead
Get data directory (topic file root)
Return:
$dir
Data directory, e.g.
'/twiki/data'
This function violates store encapsulation and is therefore
deprecated.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (07 Dec 2002)
getPubDir( ) -> $dir
DEPRECATED since 1.1 - use the "Webs, Topics and Attachments" functions to manipulateattachments instead
Get pub directory (file attachment root). Attachments are in
$dir/Web/TopicName
Return:
$dir
Pub directory, e.g.
'/htdocs/twiki/pub'
This function violates store encapsulation and is therefore
deprecated.
Use
readAttachment
and
saveAttachment
instead.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.000 (07 Dec 2002)
checkDependencies( $moduleName, $dependenciesRef ) -> $error
DEPRECATED since 1.1 - use
TWiki:Plugins.BuildContrib and define DEPENDENCIES that can be statically
evaluated at install time instead. It is a lot more efficient.
Since: TWiki::Plugins::VERSION 1.025 (01 Aug 2004)
Back to top
TWiki CGI and Command Line Scripts
Programs on the TWiki server performing actions such as rendering, saving and renaming topics.
The TWiki scripts are located in the
twiki/bin
and
twiki/tools
directories. This topic describes the interfaces to some of those scripts. All scripts in the
twiki/bin
directory can be called from the CGI (
Common Gateway Interface) environment or from the command line. The scripts in the
twiki/tools
directory can only be called from the command line.
CGI Scripts
Details on CGI scripts located in the
twiki/bin
directory.
General Information
CGI environment
In the CGI environment parameters are passed to the scripts via the URL and URL parameters. Environment variables are also used to determine the user performing the action. If the environment is not set up, the default TWiki user is used (usually
guest
).
Command-line
You
must be have the
twiki/bin
directory on the perl path to run the scripts from the command line. To avoid issues with file permissions, run the scripts as the web server user such as
nobody
or
www
.
Parameters are passed on the command line using '-name' - for example,
$ cd /usr/local/twiki/bin
$ save -topic MyWeb.MyTopic -user admin -action save -text "New text of the topic"
All parameters require a value, even if that is the empty string.
Common parameters
All the scripts accept a number of common parameters. The first two components of the URL after the script name are taken as the web and the topic, respectively. Standard URL parameters are:
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
topic |
If this is set to a URL, TWiki will immediately redirect to that URL. Otherwise it overrides the URL and is taken as the topic name (you can pass Web.TopicName) |
|
user |
Command-line only; set the name of the user performing the action. Note: this usage is inherently insecure, as it bypasses webserver login constraints. For this reason only authorised users should be allowed to execute scripts from the command line. |
|
skin |
Overrides the default skin path (see TWikiSkins) |
|
cover |
Specifies temporary skin path to prepend to the skin path for this script only (see TWikiSkins) |
|
attach
Despite the name, this script doesn't actually attach a file to a topic - for that, use
upload
. This script is part of the transactions sequence executed when a file is uploaded from the browser. it just generates the "new attachment" page for a topic.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
filename |
Name of existing attachment (if provided, this is a "manage attachment" action) |
none (in which case this is a "new attachment" action) |
changes
Shows all the changes in the given web.
The
changes
script can receive one parameter:
The main difference between invoking this script and using
WebChanges is that
WebChanges is based on a
%SEARCH%
, while this script reads the
changes
file in each web, making it much faster.
NOTE: The result from
changes
script and the topic
WebChanges can be different, if the
changes
file is deleted from a web. In particular, in new installations the
changes
script will return no results while the
WebChanges topic will.
configure
configure
is the browser script used for inspection and configuration of the TWiki configuration. None of the parameters to this script are useable for any purpose except
configure
. See
configure.
edit
The
edit
script understands the following parameters, typically supplied by HTML input fields:
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
action |
Optional. Use the editaction template instead of the standard edit. If action=text, then hide the form. If action=form hide the normal text area and only edit the form. You can change the Edit/Edit Raw buttons to always append the action parameter in skins like Pattern and Classic by setting the topic or preference variable EDITACTION to the value text or form . To edit the topic once the EDITACTION is defined as form simply remove the action=form from the browser URL of the edit script and reload the edit window |
|
onlynewtopic |
If set, error if topic already exists |
|
onlywikiname |
If set, error if topic name is not a WikiWord |
|
templatetopic |
The name of the template topic, copied to get the initial content (new topic only) |
|
text |
Initial text for the topic |
|
topicparent |
The parent topic |
|
formtemplate |
Name of the form to instantiate in the topic. Overrides the form set in the templatetopic if defined. (will remove the form is set to 'none') |
|
contenttype |
Optional parameter that defines the application type to write into the CGI header. Defaults to text/html . May be used to invoke alternative client applications |
|
anyname |
Any parameter can passed to the new topic; if the template topic contains %URLPARAM{"anyname"}% , it will be replaced by its value |
|
breaklock |
If set, any lease conflicts will be ignored, and the edit will proceed even if someone is already editing the topic. |
|
redirectto |
If the user continues from edit to save, and if the save (or cancels the edit) process is successful, save will redirect to this topic or URL. The parameter value can be a TopicName , a Web.TopicName , or a URL. Note: Redirect to a URL only works if it is enabled in configure (Miscellaneous {AllowRedirectUrl} ). |
|
Form field values are passed in parameters named 'field' - for example, if I have a field
Status
the parameter name is
Status
.
- The first sequence of ten or more
X
characters in the topic name will be converted on save to a number such that the resulting topic name is unique in the target web.
NOTE: most skins support the definition of
EDIT_SKIN
, which is used as the value of the
cover
parameter in
edit
URLs. This allows you to override the default edit skin on a web, topic or user basis.
login
Used for logging in when TWiki login is being used (e.g TemplateLoginManager).
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
origurl |
URL that was being accessed when an access violation occurred. the login process will redirect to this URL if it is successful |
none |
username |
username of user logging in |
none |
password |
password of user logging in |
none |
logon
Used for logging in when Web Server authentication is being used (e.g. ApacheLoginManager). The script does nothing; it is purely a placeholder for triggering the login process. The webserver will be set up to require a valid user to access this script, thus triggering the webserver login process.
manage
Performs a range of management functions.
action=createweb
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
newweb |
Name of the new web |
'' |
baseweb |
Name of the web to copy to create the new web |
'' |
webbgcolor |
value for WEBBGCOLOR |
'' |
sitemapwhat |
Value for SITEMAPWHAT |
'' |
sitemapuseto |
Value for SITEMAPUSETO |
'' |
nosearchall |
Value for NOSEARCHALL |
'' |
action=editSettings
No parameters
action=saveSettings
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
text |
Text of the topic |
'' |
originalrev |
Revision that the edit started on |
Most recent revision |
redirectto |
If the savesettings process is successful, save will redirect to this topic or URL. The parameter value can be a TopicName , a Web.TopicName , or a URL. Note: Redirect to a URL only works if it is enabled in configure (Miscellaneous {AllowRedirectUrl} ). |
All other parameters may be interpreted as form fields, depending on the current form definition in the topic.
action=bulkRegister
See
BulkRegistration.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
OverwriteHomeTopics |
Whether to overwrite existing home topics or not |
false |
EmailUsersWithDetails |
Whether to mail registered users or not |
false |
LogTopic |
Topic to save the log in |
Same as topic name, with 'Result' appended. |
action=changePassword
Change password, email address, or both, of a user.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
username |
god alone knows |
none |
oldpassword |
current password |
none |
password |
new password |
none |
passwordA |
new password confirmation |
none |
email |
new email address |
none |
password, =passwordA
and
email
are optional. If neither or
password
and
passwordA
is set, then the user password is left unchanged. If
email
is unset, their email is left unchanged.
action=resetPassword
Reset the password for a single or multiple users
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
LoginName |
list of usernames to reset |
none - error if not set |
Introduction |
message to be sent alongside the reset, most often used to announce to the user that they have been given an account. |
'' |
This is used by
BulkResetPassword and
ResetPassword. Only administrators can provide a list of
LoginNames, non-admins can only provide a single
LoginName.
BulkRegistration provides the means to create multiple accounts but it does not announce those accounts to the users who own them.
BulkResetPassword is used to assign the passwords, the Introduction is used to explain why they are receiving the mail.
action=deleteUserAccount
Unregisters (removes) the currently logged-in user.
oops
This script is mainly used for rendering pages containing error messages, though it is also used for some functional actions such as manage pages (move topic etc).
oops
templates are used with the
oops
script to generate system messages. This is done to make internationalisation or other local customisations simple.
The
oops
script supports the following parameters:
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
template |
Name of the template file to display |
|
def |
Optional, can be set to the name of a single definition within template . This definition will be instantiated in the template wherever %INSTANTIATE% is seen. This lets you use a single template file for many messages. For an example, see oopsmanagebad.tmpl . |
|
paramN |
Where N is an integer from 1 upwards. These values will be substituted into template for %PARAM1% etc. |
|
preview
This script is
deprecated. Its functions are covered by the
save
script.
rdiff
Renders the differences between version of a TWiki topic
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
rev1 |
the higher revision |
|
rev2 |
the lower revision |
|
render |
the rendering style {sequential, sidebyside, raw, debug} |
DIFFRENDERSTYLE, sequential |
type |
{history, diff, last} history diff, version to version, last version to previous |
diff |
context |
number of lines of context |
|
TODO:
- add a {word} render style
register
rename
Used for renaming topics.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
skin |
skin(s) to use |
|
newweb |
new web name |
|
newtopic |
new topic name |
|
breaklock |
|
|
attachment |
|
|
confirm |
if defined, requires a second level of confirmation |
|
currentwebonly |
if defined, searches current web only for links to this topic |
|
nonwikiword |
if defined, a non-wikiword is acceptable for the new topic name |
|
redirectto |
If the rename process is successful, rename will redirect to this topic or URL. The parameter value can be a TopicName , a Web.TopicName , or a URL. Note: Redirect to a URL only works if it is enabled in configure (Miscellaneous {AllowRedirectUrl} ). |
|
rest
This REST (
Representational State Transfer) script can be invoked via http in the same way as the other TWiki scripts (see
Invocation Examples, below) to execute a function that is associated to a "subject" and a "verb" (see below). These functions are usually registered by plugins using the
TWiki::Func::registerRESTHandler
method. The
rest
script will print the result directly to the browser unless the
endPoint
parameter is specified, in which case it will output a redirect to the given topic.
The
rest
script supports the following parameters:
username |
If TemplateLogin , or a similar login manager not embedded in the web server, is used, then you need to pass a username and password to the server. The username and password parameters are used for this purpose. |
password |
See username |
topic |
If defined as the full name (including web) of a topic, then when the script starts up plugins will be passed this as the "current" topic. If not defined, then %USERWEB%.WebHome will be passed to plugins. |
endPoint |
Where to redirect the response once the request is served, in the form "Web.Topic" |
The function is free to use any other query parameters for its own purposes.
The
rest
script should
always require authentication in any TWiki that has logins. Otherwise there is a risk of opening up major security holes. So make sure you add it to the list of authenticated scripts if you are using
ApacheLogin
.
Invocation Examples
The
rest
script assumes that it will be called with URL in the form:
http://my.host/bin/rest/<subject>/<verb>
where
<subject>
must be the
WikiWord name of one of the installed
TWikiPlugins, and the
<verb>
is the alias for the function registered using the
TWiki::Func::registerRESTHandler
method. The
<subject>
and
<verb>
are then used to lookup and call the registered function.
<subject>
and
<verb>
are checked for illegal characters exactly in the same way as the web and topic names.
As an example, the
EmptyPlugin has registered a function to be used with the
rest
script under the subject
EmptyPlugin and the verb
example. Click below to see the
rest
script in action (run as
TWikiGuest).
Call the Plugin
Note that for Plugins to register REST handlers, they must be enabled in
configure
.
save
The
save
script performs a range of save-related functions, as selected by the
action
parameter.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
action_save=1 |
default; save, return to view, dontnotify is off |
|
action_quietsave=1 |
save, and return to view, dontnotify is on |
|
action_checkpoint |
save and redirect to the edit script, dontnotify is on |
|
action_cancel |
exit without save, return to view |
|
action_preview |
preview edited text |
|
action_addform |
Redirect to the "change form" page. |
|
action_replaceform... |
Redirect to the "change form" page. |
|
action_delRev |
Administrators only delete the most recent revision of the topic - all other parameters are ignored. You have to be an administrator to use this, and not all store implementations will support it. |
|
action_repRev |
Administrators only replace the text of the most recent revision of the topic with the text in the text parameter. text must included embedded meta-data tags. All other parameters are ignored. You have to be an administrator to use this, and not all store implementations will support it. |
|
onlynewtopic |
If set, error if topic already exists |
|
onlywikiname |
If set, error if topic name is not a WikiWord |
|
dontnotify |
if defined, suppress change notification |
|
templatetopic |
Name of a topic to use as a template for the text and form (new topic only) |
|
text |
New text of the topic |
|
forcenewrevision |
if set, forces a revision even if TWiki thinks one isn't needed |
|
topicparent |
If 'none' remove any current topic parent. If the name of a topic, set the topic parent to this. |
|
formtemplate |
if defined, use the named template for the form (will remove the form is set to 'none') |
|
editaction |
When action is checkpoint , add form or replace form... , this is used as the action parameter to the edit script that is redirected to after the save is complete. |
|
originalrev |
Revision on which the edit started. |
|
edit |
The script to use to edit the topic when action is checkpoint |
edit |
editparams |
The parameter string to use to edit the topic |
|
redirectto |
The save process will redirect to this topic or URL if it is successful. (Typically this would be the URL that was being viewed when edit was invoked). The parameter value can be a TopicName , a Web.TopicName , or a URL. Note: Redirect to a URL only works if it is enabled in configure (Miscellaneous {AllowRedirectUrl} ). |
view topic being edited |
Any errors will cause a redirect to an
oops
page.
The parameters are interpreted in according to the following rules.
- The first sequence of ten or more
X
characters in the topic name will be converted to a number such that the resulting topic name is unique in the target web.
- When the action is
save
, checkpoint
, quietsave
, or preview
:
- The new text is taken from the
text
parameter, if it is defined,
- otherwise it is taken from the
templatetopic
, if it is defined, (new topic only)
- otherwise it is taken from the previous version of the topic, if any,
- The name of the new form is taken from the
formtemplate
, if defined
- otherwise it is taken from the
templatetopic
, if defined, (new topic only)
- otherwise it is taken from the previous version of the topic, if any,
- otherwise no form is attached.
- The value for each field in the form is taken from the query, if it is defined
- otherwise it is taken from the
templatetopic
, if defined, (new topic only)
- otherwise it is taken from the previous version of the topic, if any,
- otherwise it defaults to the empty string.
Merging is only enabled if the topic text comes from
text
and
originalrev
is > 0 and is not the same as the revision number of the most recent revision. If merging is enabled both the topic and the meta-data are merged.
Form field values are passed in parameters named 'field' - for example, if I have a field
Status
the parameter name is
Status
.
search
CGI gateway to the
%SEARCH%
functionality driven by the following CGI parameters:
Parameter: |
Description: |
Default: |
"text" |
Search term. Is a keyword search, literal search or regular expression search, depending on the type parameter. SearchHelp has more |
required |
search="text" |
(Alternative to above) |
N/A |
web="Name" web="Main, Know" web="all" |
Comma-separated list of webs to search. See TWikiVariables#VarSEARCH for more details. |
Current web |
topic="WebPreferences" topic="*Bug" |
Limit search to topics: A topic, a topic with asterisk wildcards, or a list of topics separated by comma. |
All topics in a web |
excludetopic="Web*" excludetopic="WebHome, WebChanges" |
Exclude topics from search: A topic, a topic with asterisk wildcards, or a list of topics separated by comma. |
None |
type="keyword" type="literal" type="regex" |
Do a keyword search like soap "web service" -shampoo ; a literal search like web service ; or RegularExpression search like soap;web service;!shampoo |
%SEARCHVAR- DEFAULTTYPE% preferences setting (literal) |
scope="topic" scope="text" scope="all" |
Search topic name (title); the text (body) of topic; or all (both) |
"text" |
order="topic" order="created" order="modified" order="editby" order= "formfield(name)" |
Sort the results of search by the topic names, topic creation time, last modified time, last editor, or named field of TWikiForms. The sorting is done web by web; in case you want to sort across webs, create a formatted table and sort it with TablePlugin's initsort |
Sort by topic name |
limit="all" limit="16" |
Limit the number of results returned. This is done after sorting if order is specified |
All results |
date="..." |
limits the results to those pages with latest edit time in the given time interval. |
All results |
reverse="on" |
Reverse the direction of the search |
Ascending search |
casesensitive="on" |
Case sensitive search |
Ignore case |
bookview="on" |
BookView search, e.g. show complete topic text |
Show topic summary |
nonoise="on" |
Shorthand for nosummary="on" nosearch="on" nototal="on" zeroresults="off" noheader="on" noempty="on" |
Off |
nosummary="on" |
Show topic title only |
Show topic summary |
nosearch="on" |
Suppress search string |
Show search string |
noheader="on" |
Suppress search header Topics: Changed: By: |
Show search header |
nototal="on" |
Do not show number of topics found |
Show number |
zeroresults="off" |
Suppress all output if there are no hits |
zeroresults="on" , displays: "Number of topics: 0" |
noempty="on" |
Suppress results for webs that have no hits. |
Show webs with no hits |
header="..." format="..." |
Custom format results: see FormattedSearch for usage, variables & examples |
Results in table |
expandvariables="on" |
Expand variables before applying a FormattedSearch on a search hit. Useful to show the expanded text, e.g. to show the result of a SpreadSheetPlugin %CALC{}% instead of the formula |
Raw text |
multiple="on" |
Multiple hits per topic. Each hit can be formatted. The last token is used in case of a regular expression ";" and search |
Only one hit per topic |
nofinalnewline="on" |
If on , the search variable does not end in a line by itself. Any text continuing immediately after the search tag on the same line will be rendered as part of the table generated by the search, if appropriate. |
off |
separator=", " |
Line separator between hits |
Newline "$n" |
statistics
Refresh the
WebStatistics topics in range of webs.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
webs |
comma-separated list of webs to run stats on |
all accessible webs |
logdate |
YYYYMM to generate statistics for |
current month |
for example:
- from browser http://open-services.net/bin/statistics updates all user webs
- from browser http://open-services.net/bin/statistics?webs=TWiki,Main,Sandbox updates TWiki,Main,Sandbox
- from browser http://open-services.net/bin/statistics/TWiki updates TWiki
- from command line twiki/bin/statistics updates all user webs
- from command line twiki/bin/statistics -webs=TWiki,Main,Sandbox updates TWiki,Main,Sandbox
- from command line twiki/bin/statistics TWiki.WebHome updates TWiki
see
TWikiSiteTools#WebStatistics_site_statistics for updating statistics using cron.
upload
Uploads an attachment to a topic. The HTTP request is expected to be in
multipart/form-data
format.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
hidefile |
if defined, will not show file in attachment table |
|
filepath |
local (client) path name of the file being uploaded. This is used to look up the data for the file in the HTTP query. |
|
filename |
deprecated, do not use |
|
filecomment |
Comment to associate with file in attachment table |
|
createlink |
if defined, will create a link to file at end of topic |
|
changeproperties |
if defined, this is a property change operation only - no file will be uploaded. |
null |
You can use a tool like
curl
to upload files from the command line using this script.
view
Used for viewing topics.
Parameter |
Description |
Default |
raw=on |
Shows the text of the topic in a scrollable textarea |
|
raw=debug |
As raw=on , but also shows the metadata (forms etc) associated with the topic. |
|
raw=text |
Shows only the source of the topic, as plain text (Content-type: text/plain). Only shows the body text, not the form or other meta-data. |
raw=all |
Shows only the source of the topic, as plain text (Content-type: text/plain), with embedded meta-data. This may be useful if you want to extract the source of a topic to a local file on disc. |
|
section |
Allows to view only a part of the topic delimited by a named section (see VarSTARTSECTION). If the given section is not present, no topic content is displayed. |
|
contenttype |
Allows you to specify a different Content-Type: (e.g. contenttype=text/plain ) |
|
rev |
Revision to view (e.g. rev=45 ) |
|
template |
Allows you to specify a different skin template, overriding the 'view' template the view script would normally use. The default template is view . For example, you could specify /bin/view/TWiki/TWikiScripts?template=edit. This is mainly useful when you have specialised templates for a TWiki Application. |
|
topic |
redirects (at the beging of the cgi script running) to show the spcified Web.Topic, or, redirects to a URL, if allowed by {AllowRedirectUrl} and {PermittedRedirectHostUrls} |
|
For historical reasons, the view script has a special interpretation of the
text
skin. In earlier TWiki versions the
skin=text
parameter was used like this:
http://.../view/MyWeb/MyTopic?skin=text&contenttype=text/plain&raw=on
which shows the topic as plain text; useful for those who want to download plain text for the topic.
Using
skin=text
this way is
DEPRECATED, use
raw=text
instead.
viewfile
Used for viewing attachments. Normally, a site will publish the attachments (
pub
) directory using a URL. However if it contains sensitive information, you will want to protect attachments using
TWikiAccessControls. In this case, you can use the
viewfile
script to give access to attachments while still checking access controls.
Instead of using the
filename
parameter, you can append the attachment name
to the end of the URL path (after the topic) e.g.
http://open-services.net/bin/viewfile/Webname/TopicName/Attachment.gif
Command Line Scripts
Details on command line scripts located in the
twiki/tools
directory.
geturl.pl
This is a very simple script to get the content of a web site. It is marked as
deprecated and might be removed (or enhanced) in a future TWiki release. Its functions are covered by the standard
wget
and
curl
commands.
- Usage:
geturl.pl <host> <path> [<port> [<header>]]
- Example:
geturl.pl some.domain /some/dir/file.html 80
- Will get:
http://some.domain:80/some/dir/file.html
rewriteshebang.pl
Simple script to rewrite the
#!/usr/bin/perl
shebang lines specific to your local Perl installation. It will rewrite the first line of all your TWiki cgi scripts so they use a different shebang line. Use it if your perl is in a non-standard location, or you want to use a different interpreter (such as 'speedy').
tick_twiki.pl
This script executes a number of non-essential regular administration tasks that will help keep your TWiki healthy and happy, such as removing expired sessions and lease files.
It is intended to be run as a cron job or a scheduled task once a week. Example crontab entry:
0 0 * * 0 cd /usr/twiki/bin && perl ../tools/tick_twiki.pl
Note: The script has to be run by a user who can write files created by the webserver user.
Related Topics: AdminDocumentationCategory,
DeveloperDocumentationCategory
Back to top
TWiki Site Tools
Utilities for searching, navigation, and monitoring site activity
TWiki Site Tools include utilities for navigating, searching and keeping up with site activity. Preferences can be configured by web or site-wide. You are currently in the
TWiki web. In particular, TWiki provides two highly configurable, automated site monitoring tools,
WebNotify, to e-mail alerts when topics are edited, and
WebStatistics, to generate detailed activity reports.
WebNotify - recent changes alert
Each TWiki web has an automatic e-mail alert service that sends a list of recent changes on a preset schedule, like once a day. Users can subscribe and unsubscribe using
WebNotify in each web. The Perl script
mailnotify
is called by a background process at regular intervals. The script sends an automated e-mail to subscribed users if topics were changed in a web since the script was last run.
Web Changes Notification Service
Each TWiki web has an automatic e-mail notification service that sends you an e-mail with links to all of the topics modified since the last alert.
Users subscribe to email notifications using their
WikiName or an alternative email address, and can specify the webs/topics they wish to track, Whole groups of users can also be subscribed for notification.
The general format of a subscription is:
three spaces *
subscriber [
:
topics ]
Where
subscriber can be a
WikiName, an E-mail address, or a
group name. If
subscriber contains any characters that are not legal in
an email address, then it must be enclosed in 'single' or "double" quotes.
topics is an optional space-separated list of topics:
- ... without a Web. prefix
- ...that exist in this web.
Users may further customize the specific content they will receive using the following controls:
- Using wild-card character in topic names - You can use
*
in a topic name, where it is treated as a wildcard character. A *
will match zero or more other characters - so, for example, Fred*
will match all topic names starting with Fred
, *Fred
will match all topic names ending with Fred
, and *
will match all topic names.
- Unsubscribing to specific topics - Each topic may optionally be preceded by a '+' or '-' sign. The '+' sign means "subscribe to this topic". The '-' sign means "unsubscribe" or "don't send notifications regarding this particular topic". This allows users to elect to filter out certain topics. Topic filters ('-') take precedence over topic includes ('+') i.e. if you unsubscribe from a topic it will cancel out any subscriptions to that topic.
- Including child-topics in subscription - Each topic may optionally be followed by an integer in parentheses, indicating the depth of the tree of children below that topic. Changes in all these children will be detected and reported along with changes to the topic itself. Note This uses the TWiki "Topic parent" feature.
- Subscribing to entire topic ("news mode") - Each topic may optionally be immediately followed by an exclamation mark ! or a question mark ? with no intervening spaces, indicating that the topic (and children if there is a tree depth specifier as well) should be mailed out as complete topics instead of change summaries. ! causes the topic to be mailed every time even if there have been no changes, and ? will mail the topic only if there have been changes to it. One can limit the content of the subscribed topic to send out by inserting %STARTPUBLISH% and %STOPPUBLISH% markers within the topic. Note that "news mode" subscriptions require a corresponding cron job that includes the "-news" option (see details).
Examples:
Subscribe Daisy to all changes to topics in this web.
* daisy.cutter@flowers.com
Subscribe Daisy to all changes to topics that start with
Web
.
* daisy.cutter@flowers.com : Web*
Subscribe Daisy to changes to topics starting with
Petal
, and their immediate children, WeedKillers and children to a depth of 3, and all topics that match start with
Pretty
and end with
Flowers
e.g.
PrettyPinkFlowers
* DaisyCutter: Petal* (1) WeedKillers (3) Pretty*Flowers
Subscribe StarTrekFan to changes to all topics that start with
Star
except those that end in
Wars
,
sInTheirEyes
or
shipTroopers
.
* StarTrekFan: Star* - *Wars - *sInTheirEyes - *shipTroopers
Subscribe Daisy to the full content of NewsLetter whenever it has changed
* daisy@flowers.com: NewsLetter?
Subscribe buttercup to NewsLetter and its immediate children, even if it hasn't changed.
* buttercup@flowers.com: NewsLetter! (1)
Subscribe GardenGroup (which includes Petunia) to all changed topics under AllnewsLetters to a depth of 3. Then unsubscribe Petunia from the ManureNewsLetter, which she would normally get as a member of
GardenGroup? :
* GardenGroup: AllNewsLetters? (3)
* petunia@flowers.com: - ManureNewsLetter
Subscribe
IT:admins
(a non-TWiki group defined by an alternate user mapping) to all changes to Web* topics.
* 'IT:admins' : Web*
A user may be listed many times in the WebNotify topic. Where a user has several lines in WebNotify that all match the same topic, they will only be notified about
changes that topic
once (though they will still receive individual mails for news topics).
If a
group is listed for notification, the group will be recursively expanded to the e-mail addresses of all members.
__
Warning: Because an email address is not linked to a user name, there is no way for TWiki to check access controls for email addresses. A user identified by an email address will only be sent change notifications if the topic they are asubscribed to is readable by guest users. You can limit what email addresses can be used in WebNotify, or even block use of emails altogther, using the
{MailerContrib}{EmailFilterIn} setting in =configure
.
Tip: List names in alphabetical order to make it easier to find the names.
Note for System Administrators: Notification is supported by an add-on to the TWiki kernel called the MailerContrib. See the
MailerContrib topic for details of how to set up this service.
Note: If you prefer a news feed, point your reader to
WebRss (for RSS 1.0 feeds) or
WebAtom (for ATOM 1.0 feeds). Learn more at
WebRssBase and
WebAtomBase, respectively.
You can also use
%USERSWEB%
instead of
Main
, but this is not necessary even if you have renamed the main web by configuring
{MainWebName}
in
configure.
WebSearch - search TWiki site
WebSearch is an extremely fast and flexible search facility, part of the core TWiki feature set.
WebSearchAdvanced offers more options, including:
- topic title or full-text search
- regular expressions
- search within web or site-wide
- index-style A-Z alphabetical listing sorted topic title
- many more
See also:
SearchHelp for help;
TWikiVariables and
FormattedSearch for including hard-coded searches in text.
WebChanges - what's new
To check for the most recently edited topics while on-site, use the
WebChanges link, usually located in the toolbar. It lists the most recently modified topics, newest first, along with the first couple of lines of the page content.
This is simply a preset
SEARCH
. The number of topics listed by the
limit
parameter.:
%SEARCH{ ".*" web="TWiki" type="regex" nosearch="on" order="modified"
reverse="on"
limit="50" }%
WebRss and WebAtom - news feeds on recent changes
You can point your news reader at
WebRss and
WebAtom to find out what is new in a TWiki web.
WebRssBase and
WebAtomBase have the details. Like
WebChanges, this is based on a
%SEARCH{}%
.
WebIndex - list of topics
WebIndex lists all web topics in alphabetical order, with the first couple of lines of text. This is simply a preset
SEARCH
:
%SEARCH{ "\.*" scope="topic" type="regex" nosearch="on" }%
WebStatistics - site statistics
You can generate a listing manually, or on an automated schedule, of visits to individual pages, on a per web basis. Compiled as a running total on a monthly basis. Includes totals for Topic Views, Topic Saves, Attachment Uploads, Most Popular Topics with number of views, and Top Contributors showing total of saves and attachment uploads. Previous months are saved.
Configuring for automatic operation
- You can automatically generate usage statistics for all webs. To enable this:
- Make sure variable {Log}{view}, {Log}{save} and *{Log}{upload} in are set in configure. This will generate log file entries (see below).
- The WebStatistics topic must be present in all webs where you want to have statistics. You can use the topic in the Main web as a template.
- Call the
twiki/bin/statistics
script from a cron job, once a day is recommended. This will update the WebStatistics topics in all webs.
- Attention: The script must run as the same user as the CGI scripts are running, which is user
nobody
on many systems. Example crontab entry:
0 0 * * * (cd /path/to/twiki/bin; ./statistics >/dev/null 2>&1)
- There is a workaround in case you can't run the script as user
nobody
: Run the utility twiki/tools/geturl.pl
in your cron job and specify the URL of the twiki/bin/statistics
script as a parameter. Example:
0 0 * * * (cd /path/to/twiki/tools; ./geturl.pl mydomain.com /urlpath/to/twiki/bin/statistics >/dev/null 2>&1)
- NOTE:
geturl.pl
will do a TWiki CGI request as the TWikiGuest user, so if you use this workaround, the WebStatistics topics you are updating will have to be writable by TWikiGuest.
When running from the command line or a cron job, you can pass parameters to the script like this:
./statistics -logdate 200605 -webs TWiki,Sandbox
Generating statistics manually by URL
- The
twiki/bin/statistics
script can also be executed as a CGI script, just enter the URL in your browser. Examples:
- Update current month for all webs you have access to:
/bin/statistics
- Update current month for Main web only:
/bin/statistics/Main
- Update Jul 2018 for Main web:
/bin/statistics/Main?logdate=201807
- Update Jul 2018 for the ProjectX, ProjectY and ProjectZ webs:
/bin/statistics?logdate=201807;webs=ProjectX,ProjectY,ProjectZ
Log Files
TWiki generates monthly log files which are used by the statistics script
- The log file is defined by the {LogFileName} setting in configure
- The file name is
log<year><month>.txt
- Example path name:
twiki/logs/log201807.txt
- Each access gets logged as:
| <time> | <wikiusername> | <action> | <web>.<topic> | <extra info> | <IP address> |
- Example log entry:
| 16 Jul 2018 - 21:01 | TWikiGuest | view | WebRss | | 66.124.232.02 |
- Actions are logged if enabled in configure by the {Log}{action} flags
- Logged actions:
Script | Action name | Extra info |
attach | attach | when viewing attach screen of previous uploaded attachment: filename |
changes | changes | |
edit | edit | when editing non-existing topic: (not exist) |
rdiff | rdiff | higher and lower revision numbers: 4 3 |
register | regstart | WikiUserName, e-Mail address, LoginName: user attempts to register |
register | register | E-mail address: user successfully registers |
register | bulkregister | WikiUserName of new, e-mail address, admin ID |
rename | rename | when moving topic: moved to Newweb.NewTopic |
rename | move | when moving attachment: Attachment filename moved to Newweb.NewTopic |
save | save | when replacing existing revision: repRev 3 when user checks the minor changes box: dontNotify when user changes attributes to an exising attachment: filename.ext |
save | cmd | special admin parameter used when saving |
search | search | search string |
upload | upload | filename |
view | view | when viewing non-existing topic: (not exist) when viewing previous topic revision: r3 |
E-mail
Configuring outgoing mail
Outgoing mail is required for
TWikiRegistration and for
recent changes alert.
TWiki will use the
Net::SMTP
module if it is installed on your system. Set this with the
SMTPMAILHOST
variable in
TWikiPreferences.
The notify e-mail uses the default
changes.tmpl
template, or a skin if activated in the
TWikiPreferences.
mailnotify also relies on two hidden files in each
twiki/data/Web
directory:
.changes
and
.mailnotify.
Make sure both are writable by your web server process.
.changes
contains a list of changes; go ahead and make this empty.
.mailnotify
contains a timestamp of the last time notification was done.
You can use an external mail program, such as
sendmail
, if the
Net::SMTP
module is not installed. Set the program path in
{MailProgram}
in
configure.
- Net::SMTP can be easily disabled (if there is an installation error) by setting
SMTPMAILHOST
in TWikiPreferences to an empty value.
- You can set a separate
SMTPSENDERHOST
variable to define the mail sender host (some SMTP installations require this).
Setting the automatic e-mail schedule
For Unix platforms: Edit the
cron
table so that
mailnotify
is called in an interval of your choice. Please consult
man crontab
of how to modify the table that schedules program execution at certain intervals. Example:
% crontab -e
0 1 * * * (cd /path/to/twiki/bin; ./mailnotify -q)
The above line will run mailnotify nightly at 01:00. The
-q
switch suppresses all normal output.
For ISP installations: Many ISPs don't allow hosted accounts direct cron access, as it's often used for things that can heavily load the server. Workaround scripts are available.
On Windows: You can use a scheduled task if you have administrative privileges.
TWiki:Codev/CronTabWin is a free scheduler for Windows.
Site Permissions
- TWikiAccessControl describes how to restrict read and write access to topics and webs, by users and groups
- SitePermissions lists the permissions settings of the webs on this TWiki site
Help with crontab
The crontab command is used to schedule commands to be executed periodically.
- Wikipedia.org:Crontab - crontab documentation
- pycron - crontab for Windows
Related Topics: AdminDocumentationCategory,
AdminToolsCategory
Back to top
Managing Topics
Browser-based rename, move, and delete for individual topics
Overview
You can use browser-based controls to change a topic's name, move it to another TWiki web, or delete it to a hidden
Trash
web.
How to Rename/Move/Delete a Topic
- Click on
[More]
(bottom right of page) on the topic to be changed, then, in the new screen, on [Rename/move]
. You can now rename and/or move/delete in one operation:
- Move/Delete: Select the target web if other than the current web - choose
Trash
to delete a topic.
- Rename: Enter the new topic name - default is current name
NOTE: You'll be warned if any of the topics to be affected are locked (being edited), or if there is a name conflict.
- Prevent updates by unchecking individual items on the list of referring links - these topics will NOT to be updated with the new name (by default, all referring links will be updated).
- Click on
[Rename/Move]
: the topic will be renamed and links to the topic updated as requested.
- If any of the referring pages are locked then they will be listed: you can correct these later by again pressing
[Rename/Move]
.
- There is a Put back feature that allows you to undo a
Rename/Move/Delete
- an instruction line and undo link will appear at the bottom of the modified topic. This allows you to revert from the last modification only.
Deleted Topics: How to Clear the Trash
Deleted topics are moved to a special
Trash
web - they are NOT physically erased from the server. All webs share
Trash
- in case of a name conflict with a topic already
Trash
, the user is alerted and asked to choose a new name.
The
Trash
web should be be cleared periodically, by archiving (saving) the text and RCS files if required (recommended), then deleting them from the
Trash
directory.
- This can only be done from on the server, not through the browser.
- Since simple FTP access to the
Trash
directory is all that's required for maintenance, it's possible to grant Trash
admin privileges to multiple users, while strictly limiting server access.
Redirecting from an Old Topic
You can use
TWikiMetaData to place a command in the
WebTopicViewTemplate and
WebTopicNonWikiTemplate that will indicate that a topic has been moved by searching for the tag %META:TOPICMOVED{...}%. Customize something like this:
%<nop>METASEARCH{type="topicmoved" web="%WEB%" topic="%TOPIC%"
title="This topic used to exist and was moved to: "}%
How Rename/Move Works
- %SEARCH%, with a special template, finds and displays all occurrences of the topic name in other topics, site-wide. These referring links are by default automatically changed to the new topic and/or web name. This includes relevant TWikiMetaData definitions.
- User can omit one or more topics from the update list by unchecking them.
-
<pre>
and <verbatim>
are honoured - no changes are made to text within these areas.
- The topic is moved (if locks allow).
- References are changed (locks and permissions permitting).
- Any referring topics that can't be changed due to locks are listed - user can take note and change them at another time.
How Referring Topics Are Found
First, matching topics in the current web are listed - matches are to
topic
. Next, all webs (including the current one) are listed that match
web.topic
.
All webs will be searched during rename, even if
NOSEARCHALL
is defined on a web, though access permissions will of course be honoured.
Changed references are kept are as short as possible, ex:
topic
is used in preference to
web.topic
.
Effect of User Access Settings
User permissions affect the 'rename' functions in various ways. To rename a topic, you need all of
VIEW
,
CHANGE
and
RENAME
access to that topic. To alter referring topics, you need
CHANGE
access. See
TWikiAccessControl for information on setting up access permissions.
Special Considerations
Consider carefully whether to make browser-based
Rename/Move/Delete widely available, or to restrict it to an administrator/moderator group. Allowing all users to easily manipulate topics can be extremely useful in refactoring a busy web or site. However, there are at least two significant potential drawbacks to take into account:
- When referring links are updated, the modified topics appear in WebChanges, creating the impression that editorial changes were made. This can undermine the usefulness of WebChanges.
- Due to current limitations, fairly heavy use of Rename/Move/Delete functions can lead to an accumulation of minor technical problems (ex: broken links) and usability issues (ex: user confusion). If Rename... is used heavily, these negatives will obviously increase, in number and effect.
Ultimately, the size, objectives, and policies of your TWiki site, the real-world behavior of your user group, and most importantly, the initial TWiki site management leadership, will determine the most effective implementation of this feature, and the success of the site overall.
Known Issues
Rename/Move is fairly complicated due to the dynamic generation of links. Ideally, it would be possible to run the required part of rendering in a way that would allow identification of the text to be changed. Unfortunately, these hooks don't exist in TWiki at present. Instead, %SEARCH% is used with a special template to show the text to be changed, and the selected topics are then altered. One drawback is that
search
can show matches that will not be updated due to case differences. Other mismatches with actual rendered output are also possible as the approaches are so different.
The following shows some limitations of square bracket processing.
[[Old Topic]] => [[NewTopic][Old Topic]]
[[old topic]] => [[NewTopic][old topic]]
[[old t opic]] => not changed
[[OldTopic]] => [[NewTopic]]
Related Topics: UserDocumentationCategory,
AdminDocumentationCategory
Back to top
Managing Webs
Adding, renaming and deleting webs are all web-based operations.
Overview
A
TWikiSite is divided into webs; each one represents one subject, one area of collaboration. Administrators can add/rename/delete webs.
Choose Web Template
There are two methods used to create a new web. First you can use a specially designed
TemplateWeb. This is an invisible web that begins with an underscore "_" character (for example
_default
). All topics in the template web will be copied into your new web.
The second method is to use an existing web as a template web. This may be useful if you already have a web that you would like to use as a starting point. Only topics that have names beginning with
Web... (like "WebHome", "WebNotify", etc.) are copied.
In either case you will want to be sure to verify that your new web has all the custom modifications that you desire. Any
TWikiVariables defined in the form below will automatically be set in the WebPreferences of the new web.
Adding a New Web
Notes:
- You must have
ROOTCHANGE
access to create a top-level web (one with no parent)
- Only the person who created it has permission to change the WebPreferences in the new web
Hierarchical Webs
You can only create hierarchical webs (webs within webs) if the
{EnableHierarchicalWebs}
setting in
configure is enabled. Hierarchical webs are currently enabled.
Note: You might not need hierarchical webs. TWiki topics already have a parent/child relationship within a web, which is shown in the breadcrumb. Try to keep the number of webs to a minimum in order to keep search and cross-referencing simple.
You can create hierarchical webs via the
Adding a New Web form above, by using a slash- or dot-separated path name which is based on an existing web name in the
Name of new web: field.
Example:
To create a subweb named
Bar
inside a web named
Foo
, use
Foo/Bar
or
Foo.Bar
as the new web name in the form above.
Subweb Preferences are Inherited
The preferences of a subweb are inherited from the parent web and overridden locally. Preferences are ultimately inherited from the
TWiki.TWikiPreferences topic.
Example Preference Inheritance for Sandbox/TestWeb/SubWeb.SubWebTopic
topic:
-
TWiki.TWikiPreferences
site-wide preferences
-
Sandbox.WebPreferences
inherits from and overrides settings in TWiki.TWikiPreferences
-
Sandbox/TestWeb.WebPreferences
inherits from and overrides settings in Sandbox.WebPreferences
-
Sandbox/TestWeb/SubWeb.WebPreferences
inherits from and overrides settings in Sandbox/TestWeb.WebPreferences
-
Sandbox/TestWeb/SubWeb.SubWebTopic
inherits from and overrides settings in Sandbox/TestWeb/SubWeb.WebPreferences
Navigation
The Pattern skin (default) indicates Subwebs by indenting them in the sidebar relative to their level in the hierarchy.
Renaming or Deleting a Web
Rename a web via the Tools section in each
WebPreferences topic. You may delete a web by moving it into a Trash web.
Permissions
You may only rename a web if you have the following permissions
- You must be allowed to rename and changes topics in the web you want to rename
- You must be allowed to rename topics in the parent web of the web you want to rename
- If the web is a root web (i.e. it has no parent web) then you must have permission to both create and rename root webs. These permissions are controlled by the ALLOWROOTCHANGE preference, which can be set in Main.TWikiPreferences.
- If you move the web to another parent web you must be allowed to create and change topics in the new parent web.
When you rename a web TWiki will try and update all links that refer to the old web. You should note that links only get updated in topics that you are allowed to edit. If you use access rights in the TWiki installation it is generally best to let an administrator rename webs to avoid too many broken links.
Edit Conflicts
If anyone is editing a topic which requires updating, or which lives in the web being renamed, a second confirmation screen will come up which will indicate which topics are still locked for edit. You may continue to hit the refresh button until an edit lease is obtained for each topic which requires updating (the "Refresh" button will change to "Submit"), or hit "Cancel", which will cancel your edit lease on all affected topics.
Renaming the webs in the distribution
It is possible, though not recommended, to change the names of the webs in the distribution.
If you plan to rename the Main web, remember that TWiki stores user topics in this web. That means that every
WikiName signature -
Main.SomeUserName
- points to it and would need updating (unless the variable,
%USERSWEB%.SomeUserName
, is used throughout). This potentially large change can be performed automatically if you rename the web from the Tools section of
WebPreferences, as described above.
If you want to rename the TWiki or Main webs, remember they are referred to in the TWiki configuration. You will need to change the
{SystemWebName}
,
{UsersWebName}
and/or
{LocalSitePreferences}
settings in the configuration using the
configure interface.
Renaming the webs in the distribution is not recommended because it makes upgrades much more complicated.
Related Topics: AdminDocumentationCategory,
AdminToolsCategory
Back to top
Manage Users
Register users on your TWiki site; change/reset/install passwords; remove user accounts
Some of the features below may be disabled, depending on your TWiki
configuration.
Authentication and Access Control
Register User
You don't have to have user home pages in TWiki for Authentication to
work - see
TWikiUserAuthentication for details.
Change, Reset and Install Passwords
Note that the below features are only relevant when you use an internal password manager where TWiki can set and reset passwords.
- ChangePassword is for users who can remember their password and want to change it
- ResetPassword is for users who cannot remember their password; a system generated password is e-mailed to them
- BulkResetPassword if for administrators who want to reset many passwords at once
- ChangeEmailAddress changes the hidden email address stored in the password file
Changing User Account Names
To change the user's
WikiName:
- Rename the user's TWiki homepage in the Main web, such as from
JaneSmith
to JaneMiller
.
- Fix backlinks in the Main web only
- Make sure the group topics are updated (if any.)
- Edit the Main.TWikiUsers topic and move the user's entry so that the list is in proper alphabetical order.
- Recreate the old topic with a pointer to the new topic, so that links in other webs work properly. Example content:
%M% Jane Smith is now known as JaneMiller
If external authentication is used and you want to change the login name:
- The login name needs to be changed in the authentication server (e.g. Active Directory)
- In TWiki's Main.TWikiUsers topic, fix the mapping from login name to WikiName:
* JaneSmith - jsmith - 13 Sep 2006
to:
* JaneMiller - jmiller - 13 Sep 2006
Removing User Accounts
To remove a user account (FredQuimby, who logs in as "fred"):
- If you are using a
.htpasswd
file, edit the .htpasswd
file to delete the line starting fred:
- Warning: Do not use the Apache
htpasswd
program with .htpasswd
files generated by TWiki! htpasswd
wipes out email addresses that TWiki plants in the info fields of this file.
- Remove the
FredQuimby - fred
line from the Main.TWikiUsers topic
- Remove
FredQuimby
from all groups and from all the ALLOWWEB/ALLOWTOPIC...
declarations, if any.
Note: If you fail to do this you risk creating a security hole, as the next user to register with the wikiname FredQuimby will inherit the old FredQuimby's permissions.
- [optional] Delete their user topic Main.FredQuimby (including attachments, if any.)
Note: Consider leaving the user topic file in place so their past signatures and revision author entries don't end up looking like
AnUncreatedTopic? . If you want to make it clear the user is no longer around, replace the topic content with a note to that effect. The existance of the UserName topic should also prevent that user name from being re-used, sealing the potential security hole regarding inherited permissions..
Related Topics: AdminDocumentationCategory
Back to top
Appendix A: TWiki Development Time-line
TWiki Release 4.2.3 (Freetown) released 00:54:17 12 September 2008
Patch release following the 4.2.0 released 22 Jan 2008
New Features and Enhancements of TWiki Release 4.2
- Security Release
- TWiki 4.2.3 is a patch release which only contains an emergency fix to the configure script to close an exploit found in the configure script when left unprotected using apache auth (see the Protect the configure script step in the TWikiInstallationGuide).
- Easier Installation and Upgrade
- New Internal Admin Login feature
- The Main.TWikiUsers topic is no longer distributed as a default topic in Main web
- A new directory
working
which per default is located in the TWiki root which contains registration_approvals, tmp, and work_areas
- Configure can now authenticate when connecting to local plugins repository.
- Usability Enhancements
- New WYSIWYG editor based on TinyMCE replaces the Kupu based editor
- New "Restore topic" feature has been added to the More Topic Actions menu to easily restore an older version of a topic
- Application Platform Enhancements
- Enhancements to IF: allows, ingroup, istopic, and isweb
- Search Enhancements
- New
query
search mode supports SQL-style queries over form fields and other meta-data
- Skins and Templates Enhancements
- The PatternSkin which is the default skin for TWiki has got a face lift
- The default templates have been heavily refactored to make it easier to create skins reusing the default skin.
- Miscellaneous Feature Enhancements
- Many new functions in the API for plugin developers
- Table of Content (TOC) feature enhanced
- re-architected Pluggable user mapping (between login name and WikiName) to integrate with alternative authentication and Management schemes
- Topic based User management has been extracted into a separately update-able package (TWikiUsersContrib)
- Enhancements of Pre-installed Plugins
- Bug Fixes
- More than 300 bugs fixes since 4.1.2
Hall of Fame of TWiki Release 4.2
Many people have been involved in creating TWiki 4.2. Special thanks go to the most active contributors in the following areas:
Many thanks also to the contributors in the following areas:
- Sponsor and facilitator: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Testing and bug fixing: TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit, TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen, TWiki:Main.MichaelDaum, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- Spec and code: TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie (2323), TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens (566), TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit (507), TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny (83), TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen (73), TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen (72), TWiki:Main.AntonioTerceiro (63) - ( 3857 changes by 20 authors )
- Templates and skins: TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens (587), TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie (130), TWiki:Main.AndreUlrich (73), TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit (44) - ( 869 changes by 12 authors )
- Documentation: TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens (460), TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie (377), TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny (233), TWiki:Main.AndreUlrich (157), TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit (118), TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen (68) - ( 1450 changes by 14 authors )
- Release package builds: TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit
- Usability: TWiki:Main.CarloSchulz, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens
- Translations: Coordinated by TWiki:Main.AntonioTerceiro
- Marketing: TWiki:Main.RodBeckstrom, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.MichaelCorbett, TWiki:Main.KoenMartens
- Public relations: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.MichaelCorbett
- Meetups: TWiki:Main.AmirShobeiri
- TWiki.org wiki champions: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen, TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit, TWiki:Main.MichaelDaum, TWiki:Main.CarloSchulz, TWiki:Main.StephaneLenclud, TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin, TWiki:Main.KoenMartens
- Customer support: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit, TWiki:Main.HaraldJoerg
- System administration: TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie
If you find an omission please fix it at
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiHistory. For the full list of contributors see
TWikiContributor.
Note: Order of contributors under "Spec and code", "Templates and skins" and "Documentation" is based on number of SVN file changes for core and default extensions from March 2007 (svn rev:13046) to Jan 2008 (svn rev:16210). (Details at
TWikibug:TWiki420SvnLog). Order of contributors under "Testing and bug fixing" is based on Bugs web statistics from 2007-03 to 2007-12. Order of contributors under "TWiki.org wiki champions" and "Customer support" is based on TWiki.org web statistics from 2007-02 to 2007-12.
See more details on the TWiki 4.2 release at
TWikiReleaseNotes04x02.
TWiki Release 4.1 (Edinburgh), 16 Jan 2007
New Features and Enhancements of TWiki Release 4.1
- Easier Installation and Upgrade
- Plugins can now be installed from the configure script.
- The loading of plugin preferences settings has been moved earlier in the preferences evaluation order so that plugin settings can be redefined in Main.TWikiPreferences, WebPreferences and in topics. To make TWiki upgrades easier, it is recommended to set the plugin settings in Main.TWikiPreferences, and not to customize the settings in the plugin topic. For example, to change the TEMPLATES setting of the CommentPlugin, create a new COMMENTPLUGIN_TEMPLATES setting in Main.TWikiPreferences.
- Plugin settings can now be defined in configure instead of in the plugin topic (requires that the individual plugin has implemented this). TWiki performs slightly better by not looking for preferences settings in plugin topics.
- Configure no longer shows many unnecessary errors when run first time.
- The webmaster email address is now defined in configure instead of TWikiPreferences.
- Default file access rights in the distribution package have been changed to be more universally defined and in line with the default access rights for new topics.
- Usability Enhancements
- Redesigned result page when typing incomplete topic name into the Jump box, so that it is possible to quickly navigate to a topic, also in a very large TWiki installation. For example, "I know there is a topic about Ajax somewhere in the Eng web. OK, let my type
Eng.ajax
into the Jump box... Here we go, the third link is the AjaxCookbook I was looking for."
- Many user documentation improvements.
- URL parameters maintained in Table of Contents links so you can stay in a temporary skin (e.g. print) and keep URLPARAM values when you click the TOC links
- Attachment tables now sorted alphabetically.
- Better printing of tables and verbatim text in PatternSkin.
- Application Platform Enhancements
- Auto-incremented topic name on save with AUTOINC<n> in topic name; used by TWiki applications to create topic based database records.
- The edit and save scripts support a
redirectto
parameter to redirect to a topic or a URL; for security, redirect to URL needs to be enabled with a {AllowRedirectUrl}
configure flag.
- CommentPlugin supports the
redirectto
parameter to redirect to a URL or link to TWiki topic after submitting comment.
- The
topic
URL parameter also respects the {AllowRedirectUrl}
configure flag so redirects to URLs can be disabled which could be abused for phishing attacks.
- The view script supports a
section
URL parameter to view just a named section within a topic. Useful for simple AJAX type applications.
- New plugin handler for content move.
- Enhancements for Ajax based applications with TWiki:Plugins/YahooUserInterfaceContrib and TWiki:Plugins.TWikiAjaxContrib (available at twiki.org).
- Search Enhancements
- METASEARCH handles a format parameter like SEARCH.
- Topic not found / WebTopicViewTemplate search now case insensitive.
- FormattedSearch header supporting
$nop
, $quot
, $percnt
, $dollar
.
- Add search by createdate option to SEARCH.
- New newline option for SEARCH to protect e.g. formfields from being altered during rendering in SEARCH.
- Skins and Templates Enhancements
- Support for templates to have text rendering affecting aspect outside of textarea.
- Pattern skin dependence on TwistyPlugin instead of TwistyContrib (performance improvement.)
- Don't strip newlines from the front of TMPL:DEFs.
- Miscellaneous Feature Enhancements
- Change in WikiWord definition: Numbers are treated as lower case letters, e.g. Y2K is now a WikiWord.
- Configurable template load path. Advanced feature for those that work with customized templates.
- Added %VBAR% to TWikiPreferences for vertical bar symbol.
- On topic creation, force initial letter of topic name to be upper case.
- Allow date format in form fields.
- Enhance REVINFO{} variable with same date qualifiers as GMTIME{}.
- WebTopicCreator - adding ability to select a template from any topic name ending in ...Template
- Functionality of TWiki:Plugins.DateFieldPlugin merged into core
- Enhancements of Pre-installed Plugins
- CommentPlugin: Supports removal of comment prompt after a comment is made.
- EditTablePlugin: Default date format based on JSCalendarContrib instead of plugin topic.
- InterwikiPlugin: Supports custom link formats.
- SlideShowPlugin: Preserves URL parameters in slideshow
- SpreadSheetPlugin: New functions
$LISTRAND()
, $LISTSHUFFLE()
, $LISTTRUNCATE()
.
- TablePlugin: New attribute
cellborder
.
- TablePlugin: Highlight the sorted column with custom colors; includes also a general cosmetic update of default colors.
- TablePlugin: Support for initsort on more than one table. A table with the initsort option is initsorted UNLESS it is sorted by clicking on a column header. If you click on a header of another table all other tables goes back to the default sort defined by initsort or not sorted if no initsort, and the new table is sorted based on the user clicking on a table header.
- Bugfixes
- More than 200 bugs fixed since 4.0.5
Hall of Fame of TWiki Release 4.1
Although many more people have been involved in creating TWiki-4.1, special thanks go to the most active contributors in the following areas:
- Sponsor and facilitator: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Process improvement: TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie
- Release management: TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen
- Spec, code, testing: TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.ThomasWeigert, TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen, TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit, TWiki:Main.HaraldJoerg, TWiki:Main.MichaelDaum, TWiki:Main.MeredithLesly, TWiki:Main.WillNorris, TWiki:Main.RafaelAlvarez, TWiki:Main.AntonioTerceiro
- Templates and skins: TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.MichaelDaum, TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit
- Documentation: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen, TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen
- Translations: Coordinated by TWiki:Main.AntonioTerceiro
- Public relations: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.TomTansy
- TWiki.org wiki champions: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.KennethLavrsen, TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.ThomasWeigert, TWiki:Main.MichaelDaum
- Customer support: TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie, TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens, TWiki:Main.SteffenPoulsen, TWiki:Main.SteveStark, TWiki:Main.MichaelDaum
- System administration: TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie
If you find an omission please fix it at
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiHistory. For the full list of contributors see
TWikiContributor.
Note: Sequence of contributors under "Spec, code, testing", "Templates and skins" and "Documentation" is based on number of SVN check-ins for core and default extensions from 2006-02 to 2006-12. Sequence of contributors under "TWiki.org wiki champions" and "Customer support" is based on TWiki.org web statistics from 2006-02 to 2006-12.
See more details on the TWiki 4.1 release at
TWikiReleaseNotes04x01.
TWiki Release 4.0.0 (Dakar), 01 Feb 2006
Major New Features
- Much simpler install and configuration
- Integrated session support
- Webserver-independent login/logout
- Security sandbox blocking exploits for remote command execution on the server
- Edit conflict resolution with automatic merge
- Multilingual UI
- E-mail confirmations for registration
- WYSIWYG editor (beta)
- Hierarchical sub-webs (beta)
Many, many people worked on TWiki-4.0.0. The credits in the table below only list the people who worked on individual enhancements. If you find an omission please fix it at
TWiki:TWiki.TWikiHistory. There were many other contributors; for a full list, visit
TWikiContributor.
Most of the redesign, refactoring and new documentation work in Dakar release was done by
Crawford Currie.
Michael Sparks provided ideas and proof of concept for several improvements. Other people who gave
large amounts of their time and patience to less sexy aspects of the work, such as testing, infrastructure and documentation, are
AntonAylward,
KennethLavrsen,
LynnwoodBrown,
MichaelDaum,
Peter Thoeny,
SteffenPoulsen,
Sven Dowideit,
WillNorris.
Installation & configuration |
Contributor |
Much simpler install and configuration |
Crawford Currie, LynnwoodBrown, ArthurClemens |
mod_perl safe code for better performance |
Crawford Currie |
Security |
Security sandbox blocking exploits for remote command execution on the server |
Florian Weimer, Crawford Currie, Sven Dowideit |
Reworked access permission model |
Crawford Currie |
Internationalization & localization |
User Interface Internationalisation |
AntonioTerceiro |
Chinese translation |
CheDong |
Danish translation |
SteffenPoulsen |
Dutch translation |
ArthurClemens |
French translation |
BenVoui |
German translation |
AndreUlrich |
Italian translation |
MassimoMancini |
Polish translation |
ZbigniewKulesza |
Portuguese translation |
AntonioTerceiro, CarlinhosCecconi |
Spanish translation |
WillNorris, MiguelABayona |
Swedish translation |
Erik Åman |
New features for users |
Edit conflict resolution with automatic merge |
Crawford Currie |
Fine grained change notification on page level and parent/child relationship |
Crawford Currie |
WYSIWYG editor |
Crawford Currie, ColasNahaboo, DamienMandrioli, RomainRaugi |
Integrated session support |
GregAbbas, Crawford Currie |
Webserver-independent login/logout |
Crawford Currie |
Registration process with e-mail confirmation |
MartinCleaver |
Tip of the Day box in TWiki Home |
PaulineCheung, Peter Thoeny, AntonAylward |
ATOM feeds |
Peter Thoeny |
"Force New Revision" check box for topic save |
WillNorris |
New features for TWiki administrators and wiki application developers |
Improved preferences handling |
ThomasWeigert, Crawford Currie |
Named include sections |
RafaelAlvarez |
Create topic names with consecutive numbers |
Sven Dowideit |
Parameterized includes |
Crawford Currie |
Dynamic form option definitions of TWikiForms with FormattedSearch |
MartinCleaver |
SEARCH enhancements with new parameters excludeweb , newline , noempty , nofinalnewline , nonoise , recurse , zeroresults |
Crawford Currie, ArthurClemens, Peter Thoeny, ThomasWeigert |
FormattedSearch enhancements with $changes , $count , $formfield(name, 30, ...) , $summary(expandvar) , $summary(noheaders) , $summary(showvarnames) |
ColasNahaboo, Crawford Currie, Peter Thoeny, Sven Dowideit |
New TWikiVariables ACTIVATEDPLUGINS, ALLVARIABLES, AUTHREALM, EMAILS, FAILEDPLUGINS, HTTP, HTTPS, ICONURL, ICONURLPATH, IF, LANGUAGES, LOCALSITEPREFS, LOGIN, LOGOUT, MAKETEXT, META, PLUGINDESCRIPTIONS, QUERYSTRING, STARTSECTION/ENDSECTION, SESSION_VARIABLE, SESSIONID, SESSIONVAR, SPACEOUT, USERLANGUAGE, WIKIHOMEURL |
ArthurClemens, AntonioTerceiro, Crawford Currie, GregAbbas, Peter Thoeny, Sven Dowideit, WillNorris and many more |
TWiki form with hidden type and other form enhancements |
LynnwoodBrown, ThomasWeigert |
Support topic-specific templates for TWiki applications |
ThomasWeigert |
Direct save feature for one-click template-based topic creation |
LynnwoodBrown, Crawford Currie, ThomasWeigert |
Automatic Attachments showing all files in the attachment directory |
MartinCleaver |
Rename, move or delete webs |
PeterNixon |
Hierarchical subwebs (beta) |
PeterNixon |
New features for Plugin developers |
REST (representational state transfer) interface for Plugins |
RafaelAlvarez, TWiki:Main.MartinCleaver, Sven Dowideit |
New and improved Plugins APIs |
Crawford Currie, ThomasWeigert |
Improvements in the TWiki engine room |
Major OO redesign and refactoring of codebase |
Crawford Currie |
Automatic build system |
Crawford Currie |
Extensive test suite, unit tests and testcases |
Crawford Currie |
TWiki:Codev.DevelopBranch , DEVELOP branch Bugs system |
Sven Dowideit |
Documentation, logo artwork, skins: |
Documentation |
Crawford Currie, LynnwoodBrown, Peter Thoeny, Sven Dowideit and others |
Design of TWikiLogos with big "T" in a speech bubble |
ArthurClemens, Peter Thoeny |
Improved templates and PatternSkin |
ArthurClemens |
See more details at
TWikiReleaseNotes04x00
01-Sep-2004 Release (Cairo)
Major New Features
- Automatic upgrade script, and easier first-time installation
- Attractive new skins, using a standard set of CSS classes, and a skin browser to help you choose
- New easier-to-use save options
- Many improvements to SEARCH
- Improved support for internationalisation
- Better topic management screens
- More pre-installed Plugins: CommentPlugin, EditTablePlugin, RenderListPlugin, SlideShowPlugin, SmiliesPlugin, SpreadSheetPlugin, TablePlugin
- Improved Plugins API and more Plugin callbacks
- Better support for different authentication methods
- Many user interface and usability improvements
- And many, many more enhancements
Details of New Features and Enhancements of 01-Sep-2004 Release |
Developer, Sponsor |
Install: Ship with an automatic upgrade script to facilitate TWiki upgrades. Details |
TWiki:Main.MartinGregory TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Install: New testenv function to change the locks in the TWiki database to the web server user id (automates installation step). Details |
TWiki:Main.MattWilkie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Install: The shipped .htaccess.txt now needs to be edited before it is valid, to help reduce chances of error. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Install: Configurable password file handling for different types of encryption. Details |
TWiki:Main.PavelGoran TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Install: Remove office locations from registration. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Install: Changes to support shorter URLs with Apache Rewrite rules. Details |
TWiki:Main.AntonioBellezza TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Install: Remove the Know web from the distribution. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Internationalization: Support use of UTF-8 URLs for I18N characters in TWiki page and attachment names. Details |
TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin |
Authentication: Authenticate users when creating new topic in view restricted web. Details |
TWiki:Main.JonathanGraehl TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Preferences: TWiki Preferences need to be secured properly. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Preferences: Use TWiki Forms to set user preferences. Details |
TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre |
Skins: New pre-installed skins PatternSkin and DragonSkin. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Skins: New skin browser to choose from installed skins. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Skins: Documented set of CSS classes that are used in standard skins. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Skins: Added CSS class names to Diff output. Details |
TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Skins: Templates can now be read from user topics, as well as from files in the templates diretcory. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Skins: Ensure that the default template gets overridden by a template passed in. Details |
TWiki:Main.MartinCleaver TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Skin: Convey an important broadcast message to all users, e.g. scheduled server downtime. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Skin: Balanced pastel colors for TWiki webs. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
Rendering: Use exclamation point prefix to escape TWiki markup rendering. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
Rendering: Ordered lists with uppercase & lowercase letters, uppercase & lowercase Roman numerals. Details |
TWiki:Main.DanBoitnott TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Rendering: Allow custom styles for the "?" of uncreated topics. Details |
TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Rendering: Render IRC and NNTP as a URL. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Rendering: Make acronym linking more strict by requiring a trailing boundary, e.g. excluding TLAfoobar. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Rendering: TWiki Form with Label type. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Rendering: Web names can now be WikiWords. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Rendering: New syntax for definition list with dollar sign and colon. Details |
TWiki:Main.AdamTheo TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Rendering: Table with multi-span rows, functionality provided by Table Plugin. Details |
TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Variables: New title parameter for TOC variable. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
Variables: New REVINFO variable in templates supports flexible display of revision information. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Variables: Set times to be displayed as gmtime or servertime. Details |
TWiki:Main.SueBlake TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Variables: Properly encode parameters for form fields with ENCODE variable. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: Expand USERNAME and WIKINAME in Template Topics. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: Expand same variables in new user template as in template topics. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: Optionally warn when included topic does not exist; with the option to create the included topic. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: In topic text show file-types of attached files as icons. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: New variable FORMFIELD returns the value of a field in the form attached to a topic.. Details |
TWiki:Main.DavidSachitano TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Variables: Meta data rendering for form fields with META{"formfield"}. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: New PLUGINVERSION variable. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: URLPARAM now has a default="..." argument, for when no value has been given. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: URLPARAM variable with newline parameter. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Variables: URLPARAM variable with new multiple=on parameter. Details |
TWiki:Main.PaulineCheung TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: New switch for search to perform an AND NOT search. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Keyword search to search with implicit AND. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Multiple searches in same topic with new multiple="on" paramter. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Remove limitation on number of topics to search in a web. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Exclude topics from search with an excludetopic parameter. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Expand Variables on Formatted Search with expandvariables Flag. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Formatted Search with Web Form variable to retrieve the name of the form attached to a topic. Details |
TWiki:Main.FrankSmith TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Formatted Search with Conditional Output. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Formatted Search with $parent token to get the parent topic. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: New separator parameter to SEARCH supports better SEARCH embedding. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Improved search performance when sorting result by topic name. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: New scope=all search parameter to search in topic name and topic text at the same time. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: New topic parameter for AND search on topic text and topic name. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search modules uses Perl-style keyword parameters (code cleanup). Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: New $wikiname variable in format parameter of formatted search. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
Search: Sort search by topic creation date. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Search: Topic creation date and user in Formatted Search. Details |
TWiki:Main.CoreyFruitman TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Search: Increase levels of nested search from 2 to 16. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Plugins: New pre-installed Plugins CommentPlugin, EditTablePlugin, RenderListPlugin, SlideShowPlugin, SmiliesPlugin, SpreadSheetPlugin, TablePlugin. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Plugins: New callback afterSaveHandler , called after a topic is saved. Details |
TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Plugins: New callbacks beforeAttachmentSaveHandler and afterAttachmentSaveHandler , used to intervene on attachment save event. Details |
TWiki:Main.MartinCleaver TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Plugins: New callbacks beforeCommonTagsHandler and afterCommonTagsHandler . Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Plugins: New callback renderFormFieldForEditHandler to render form field for edit. Details |
TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre |
Plugins: New callback renderWikiWordHandler to custom render links. Details |
TWiki:Main.MartinCleaver TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Plugins: New function TWiki::Func::formatTime to format time into a string. Details |
TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Plugins: New function TWiki::Func::getRegularExpression to get predefined regular expressions. Details |
TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin |
Plugins: New functions TWiki::Func::getPluginPreferences* to get Plugin preferences. Details |
TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Plugins: New function TWiki::Func::extractParameters to extract all parameters from a variable string. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Plugins: New function TWiki::Func::checkDependencies to check for module dependency. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Plugins: A recommendation for where a Plugin can store its data. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
UI: Show tool-tip topic info on WikiWord links. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
UI: Save topic and continue edit feature. Details |
TWiki:Main.ColasNahaboo |
UI: Change topic with direct save (without edit/preview/save cycle) and checkpoint save. Details |
TWiki:Main.MattWilkie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
UI: In attachment table, change 'action' to 'manage'. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
UI: Smaller usability enhancements on the file attachment table. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
UI: Removes anchor links from header content and places them before the text to fix 'header becomes link'. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
UI: Improved functionality of the More screen. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
UI: Quick reference chart of most used markup is now listed on the edit screen. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
UI: Flag for edit script to avoid overwrite of existing topic text and form data. Details |
TWiki:Main.NielsKoldso TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
UI: Disable Escape key in IE textarea to prevent it cancelling work. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
UI: Improved warning message on unsaved topic. Details |
TWiki:Main.MartinGregory TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
UI: Reverse order of words in page title for better multi-window/tab navigation. Details |
TWiki:Main.ArthurClemens |
UI: Provides a framework to create and modify a topic without going through edit->preview->save sequence. Details |
TWiki:Main.AndreUlrich TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
UI: Set the topic parent to none in More screen, e.g. remove the current topic parent. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
UI: Use templates to define how file attachments are displayed. Was previously hard-coded. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
UI: Topic diff shows unified diff with unchanged context. Details |
TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
UI: Diff feature shows TWiki form changes in nice tables. Details |
TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Code refactoring: The log entry for a save now has a dontNotify flag in the extra field if the user checked the minor changes flag. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Code refactoring: Server-side include of attachments accelerates INCLUDE. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Code refactoring: Move functionality out of bin scripts and into included modules. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Code refactoring: Move bin script functionality into TWiki::UI modules. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Code refactoring: Optimize preferences handling for better performance. Details |
TWiki:Main.PavelGoran TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
Code refactoring: Refactor variable expansion for edit and register. Details |
TWiki:Main.CrawfordCurrie TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Code refactoring: Move savemulti script into TWiki::UI::Save. Details |
TWiki:Main.MattWilkie TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit |
Code refactoring: Topic search is done natively in Perl, it does not depend anymore on system calls with pipes. Details |
TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny |
Code refactoring: Fix logical error in upload script which prevented MIME filename from being used. Details |
TWiki:Main.WalterMundt |
01-Feb-2003 Release (Beijing)
- 18 Jan 2003 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 31 Dec 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Enhanced Plugin API to manipulate topic data with new functions in Func.pm:
readTopicText
, saveTopicText
, setTopicEditLock
, checkTopicEditLock
- 31 Dec 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 29 Dec 2002 - TWiki:Main.AndreaSterbini, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin, TWiki:Main.SvenDowideit
- New Plugin hooks
registrationHandler
, beforeEditHandler
, afterEditHandler
, beforeSaveHandler
, writeHeaderHandler
, redirectCgiQueryHandler
, getSessionValueHandler
, setSessionValueHandler
- 30 Nov 2002 - TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- Internationalization ('I18N') support for international characters in WikiWords, such as ISO-8859-15, KOI8-R - also supports Chinese, Japanese, etc.
- 25 Nov 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Include previous topic revision with
%INCLUDE{ "OtherTopic" rev="1.2" }%
- 15 Nov 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- The Go box understands also URLs, useful for special TWikiSkins handling
- 08 Nov 2002 - TWiki:Main.ColasNahaboo, TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- In WebNotify, if only the WikiName is specified, the e-mail is taken from the user's home page; if the WikiName is a group name, a notification is sent to all members of the group
- 30 Oct 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%NOP{}%
variable in TWikiTemplates topic gets removed at topic creation time; useful to write protect template topics
- 28 Sep 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- The
%URLPARAM{}%
variable in TWikiTemplates topic gets expanded at topic creation time; useful for dynamic content creation
- 28 Sep 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
$logDir
introduced in TWiki.cfg to set the log directory
- 13 Sep 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Renamed the Test web to Sandbox
- 03 Aug 2002 - TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- New
setlib.cfg
file in the bin directory to set the TWiki library path
- 02 Aug 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny, TWiki:Main.RyanFreebern
- Support for outbound HTTP proxy when including URLs based on new
%PROXYHOST
and %PROXYPORT%
settings in the TWikiPreferences
- 12 Jul 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- The page logo is configurable with new
%WIKILOGOIMG%
, %TWIKILOGOURL%
and %WIKILOGOALT%
variables in TWikiPreferences; replacing $wikiHomeUrl
in TWiki.cfg
- 12 Jun 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%WIKITOOLNAME%
variable in TWikiPreferences; replacing $wikiToolName
in TWiki.cfg
- 31 May 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%EDITBOXSTYLE%
preferences variable which sets the edit box width automatically to the window width
- 17 May 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%URLENCODE{}%
variable to encodes a string for using in a URL parameter, e.g. %URLENCODE{"spaced name"}%
returns spaced%20name
- 17 May 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 05 May 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New user home pages are now based on the NewUserTemplate, replacing the
/twiki/templates/register.tmpl
template file
- 26 Apr 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New markup to exclude heading from a
%TOC%
table of content, e.g. ---+!! This heading
is not shown in a TOC
- 13 Apr 2002 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 01 Apr 2002 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- New data storage framework that lets you use external RCS commands for revision control, or a new native Perl implementation that does not depend on the external RCS commands
- 28 Mar 2002 - TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- Fixed IE5/IE6-specific problem whereby going back from preview sometimes removes all edit changes
- 23 Mar 2002 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- New AND search; with regular expression enabled, use the semicolon ";" as the AND operator in
%SEARCH{}%
variable, FormattedSearch and WebSearch
- 21 Mar 2002 - TWiki:Main.ColasNahaboo, TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- Fixed cache issue where the edit page showed outdated content
- 06 Mar 2002 - TWiki:Main.RichardDonkin
- Improved statistics script which uses less memory to process large log files
- 09 Jan 2002 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- Variables inside
<verbatim>
tags are no longer expanded
01-Dec-2001 Release (Athens)
01-Sep-2001 Release
- 30 Aug 2001 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- Easier install for Windows, including auto detection in
TWiki.cfg
- 30 Aug 2001 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- 21 Aug 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Convert to XHTML 1.0 function: first step to XHTML-ifying TWiki
- 26 Jun 2001 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- 07 Jun 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New topic templates as topics instead of templates. Customize by editing the topic. Retired
notedited.tmpl
, notext.tmpl
and notwiki.tmpl
templates. More in TWikiTemplates.
- 07 Jun 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%TOPICLIST{"format"}%
and %WEBLIST{"format"}%
variables to get a formatted topic index and web index, respectively. More in TWikiVariables.
- 01 Jun 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%URLPARAM{"name"}%
variable to query URL parameters. More in TWikiVariables.
- 01 Jun 2001 - TWiki:Main.AndreaSterbini
- 01 Jun 2001 - TWiki:Main.KlausWriessnegger, TWiki:Main.AndreaSterbini
- 01 May 2001 - TWiki:Main.AndreaSterbini
- 01 May 2001 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- 01 May 2001 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- 01 May 2001 - TWiki:Main.JohnTalintyre
- 27 Mar 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- The table syntax has been enhanced to (i) render
| *bold* |
cells as table headers, (ii) render space padded cells | center aligned |
and | right aligned |
, (iii) span multiple columns using | empty cells |||
. More in TextFormattingRules.
- 25 Mar 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 28 Feb 2001 - TWiki:Main.AndreaSterbini, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New Wiki rule for headings, i.e.
---++ My Title
; and new %TOC%
variable to build a table of content from headings in a topic. More in TWikiVariables.
- 28 Feb 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New Wiki rule to specify arbitrary text for external links (i.e.
[[http://TWki.org][TWiki]]
) and internal links (i.e [[WikiSyntax][syntax]]
). More in TWikiVariables.
- 28 Feb 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New Wiki rule for named anchors, e.g. links within a topic. Define a named anchor with
#MyAnchor
at the beginning of a line, and link to it with [[#MyAnchor]]
. More in TWikiVariables.
- 25 Feb 2001 - TWiki:Main.NicholasLee, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Use
Net::SMTP
module instead of sendmail
if installed.
- 01 Feb 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added
<verbatim>
... </verbatim>
tags to show source code "as is". Unlike the <pre>
... </pre>
tags, it also shows <
, >
, &
characters "as is".
- 01 Feb 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 21 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added a "Minor change, don't notify" checkbox in preview. More in DontNotify.
- 21 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added Bold Fixed formatting using double-equal signs, e.g. write
==Bold Fixed==
to get Bold Fixed
.
- 20 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Format changed of
%GMTIME{"..."}%
and %SERVERTIME{"..."}%
variables. Format is now "$hour:$min"
instead of "hour:min"
. More in TWikiVariables. Attention: Check your existing topics when you upgrade TWiki!
- 18 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- WebChanges, WebSearch and e-mail notification indicate also the revision number of a topic (i.e. 18 Jan 2001 16:43 r1.5), or NEW for a new topic (i.e. i.e. 18 Jan 2001 16:43 NEW).
- 16 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variable
%STARTINCLUDE%
and %STOPINCLUDE%
variables to control what gets included of a topic. More in TWikiVariables.
- 16 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- TWiki skins Define a different page layout with a customized header and footer layout, i.e. a
print
skin for a printable view of a topic. More in TWikiSkins and TWiki:Codev/TWikiSkins.
- 07 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.StanleyKnutson
- Better error handling when saving a topic.
- 05 Jan 2001 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 05 Dec 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 03 Dec 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
noheader="on"
switch in %SEARCH{...}%
to suppress table header. More in TWikiVariables.
01-Dec-2000 Release
- 03 Nov 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Flag
$doHidePasswdInRegistration
in wikicfg.pm
to hide plain text password in registration e-mail.
- 01 Nov 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variable
%VAR{"NAME" web="Web"}%
to get web-specific preferences. More in TWikiVariables.
- 01 Nov 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added a "Cancel" link in edit that releases the edit lock.
- 23 Oct 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 05 Oct 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Remember user by IP address so that
view
"knows" the user once authenticated in edit
. More in TWikiUserAuthentication.
- 26 Sep 2000 - TWiki:Main.AlWilliams, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 26 Sep 2000 - TWiki:Main.HaroldGottschalk, TWiki:Main.AndreaSterbini, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 20 Sep 2000 - TWiki:Main.ManpreetSingh
- New -q switch in
mailnotify
to suppress all normal output.
- 19 Sep 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 18 Sep 2000 - TWiki:Main.ManpreetSingh, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 19 Aug 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Ref-By link searches all webs (not just the current web.)
- 16 Aug 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New TWikiPreferences variables
%HTTP_EQUIV_ON_VIEW%
, %HTTP_EQUIV_ON_EDIT%
and %HTTP_EQUIV_ON_PREVIEW%
that define the <meta http-equiv="...">
meta tags for the TWiki templates. This can be used for example to set a document expiration time.
- 29 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variables
%GMTIME{"..."}%
and %SERVERTIME{"..."}%
. More in TWikiVariables.
- 23 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Changed include syntax from
%INCLUDE{"Web/TopicName.txt"}%
to %INCLUDE{"Web.TopicName"}%
. Legacy syntax still supported.
- 23 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- BookView search allows you show a set of topics for easy printing.
- 22 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- More forgiving syntax for
*bold*, italic, __bold italic__
and fixed
, where it is not necessary anymore to have a trailing space before .,;:?!
characters.
- 22 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Split the TWiki.Main web into TWiki.Main (users, company data) and TWiki.TWiki (TWiki related documentation, registration)
- 07 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added an "Release edit lock" checkbox in preview to let other people edit the topic immediately without the one hour lock.
- 07 Jul 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Fixed problem of losing carriage returns when editing topics with KDE KFM browser or W3M browser.
- 21 Jun 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Fixed problem that a page redirect on some server environments is not working (host name is needed in URL).
- 21 Jun 2000 - TWiki:Main.CrisBailiff, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Fixed security issue to prevent a server side
%INCLUDE%
of arbitrary files.
- 29 May 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New
%GMTIME%
variable that shows the current GM time.
- 28 May 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Lock warning shows remaining lock time in minutes.
- 15 May 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterFokkinga
- 02 May 2000 - TWiki:Main.KevinKinnell, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Advanced search features like search multiple webs; sort by topic name / modified time / author; limit the number of results returned. More in TWikiVariables.
01-May-2000 Release
- 21 Apr 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New TWikiVariables
%HTTP_HOST%
, %REMOTE_ADDR%
, %REMOTE_PORT%
and %REMOTE_USER%
.
- 21 Apr 2000 - TWiki:Main.JohnAltstadt, TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- TWikiRegistration is done separately for Intranet use (depends on remote_user) or Internet use (depends on .htpasswd file).
- 20 Mar 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Uploading a file (topic file attachment) will optionally create a link to the uploaded file at the end of the topic. The preference variable
%ATTACHLINKBOX%
controls the default state of the link check box in the attach file page.
- 11 Mar 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Better security with taint checking (
Perl -T
option )
- 25 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New preference variables
%EDITBOXWIDTH%
and %EDITBOXHEIGHT%
to specify the edit box size.
- 25 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Edit preferences topics to set TWiki variables. There are three level of preferences Site-level (TWikiPreferences), web-level (WebPreferences in each web) and user-level preferences (for each of the TWikiUsers). With this, discontinue use of server side include of
wikiwebs.inc
, wikiwebtable.inc
, weblist.inc
, webcopyright.inc
and webcolors.inc
files.
- 11 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variable
%SCRIPTSUFFIX%
/ $scriptSuffix containing an optional file extension of the TWiki Perl script. Templates have been changed to use this variable. This allows you to rename the Perl script files to have a file extension like for example ".cgi".
- 11 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variable
%SCRIPTURLPATH%
/ $scriptUrlPath containing the script URL without the domain name. Templates have been changed to use this variable instead of %SCRIPTURL%
. This is for performance reasons.
- 07 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Changed the syntax for server side include variable from
%INCLUDE:"filename.ext"%
to %INCLUDE{"filename.ext"}%
. (Previous syntax still supported. Change was done because of inline search syntax)
- 07 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Inline search. New variable
%SEARCH{"str" ...}%
to show a search result embedded in a topic text. TWikiVariables has more on the syntax. Inline search combined with the category table feature can be used for example to create a simple bug tracking system.
- 04 Feb 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Access statistics. Each web has a WebStatistics topic that shows monthy statistics with number of topic views and changes, most popular topics, and top contributors. (It needs to be enabled, TWikiDocumentation has more.)
- 29 Jan 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Fixed bug where TWiki would not initialize correctly under certain circumstances, i.e. when running it under mod_perl. Sub
initialize
in wiki.pm
did not handle $thePathInfo
correctly.
- 24 Jan 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 10 Jan 2000 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- No more escaping for '%' percent characters. (Number of consecutive '%' entered and displayed is identical.)
- 03 Oct 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Limit the number of revisions shown at the bottom of the topic. Example
Topic TWikiHistory . { ..... Diffs r1.10 > r1.9 > r1.8 > r1.7 >... }
Additional revisions can be selected by pressing the >...
link.
01-Sep-1999 Release
- 31 Aug 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Fixed Y2K bug. (Date in year 2000 had wrong format.)
- 08 Aug 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New text formatting rule for creating tables. Text gets rendered as a table if enclosed in " " vertical bars. Example line as it is written and how it shows up
- 03 Aug 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Online registration of new user using web form in TWikiRegistration. Authentication of users.
- 22 Jul 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Flags
$doLogTopic*
in wikicfg.pm to selectively log topic view, edit, save, rdiff, attach, search and changes to monthly log file.
- 21 Jul 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Flag
$doRemovePortNumber
in wikicfg.pm to optionally remove the port number from the TWiki URL. Example www.some.domain:1234/twiki
gets www.some.domain/twiki
.
- 15 Jul 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Search path for include files in
%INCLUDE:"file.inc"%
variable. Search first in the current web, then in parent data directory. Useful to overload default include text in the data directory by web-specific text, like for example webcopyright.inc
text.
- 07 Jul 1999 - TWiki:Main.ChristopheVermeulen
- Link a plural topic to a singular topic in case the plural topic does not exist. Example
TestVersion
/ TestVersions
, TestPolicy
/ TestPolicies
, TestAddress
/ TestAddresses
, TestBox
/ TestBoxes
.
01-Jul-1999 Release
- 23 Jun 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New TextFormattingRules to write bold italic text by enclosing words with double underline characters.
- 23 Jun 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Separate wiki.pm into configuration (wikicfg.pm) and TWiki core (wiki.pm) . This is to ease the upgrade of TWiki installations, it also allows customized extensions to TWiki without affecting the TWiki core.
- 21 May 1999 - TWiki:Main.DavidWarman
- Externalize copyright text at the bottom of every page into a web-specific
webcopyright.inc
file. This is to easily customize the copyright text.
- 20 May 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added meta tag so that robots index only /view/ of topics, not /edit/, /attach/ e.t.c. Tag <META NAME="ROBOTS" CONTENT="NOINDEX">
- 20 May 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variables
%WIKIHOMEURL%
(link when pressing the icon on the upper left corner) and %WIKITOOLNAME%
(the name of the wiki tool TWiki
).
- 15 Apr 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Topic locking Warn user if a topic has been edited by an other person within one hour. This is to prevent contention, e.g. simultaneous topic updates.
- 26 Mar 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- File attachments Upload and download any file as a topic attachment by using the browser. FileAttachment has more.
- 26 Mar 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New variables
%PUBURL%
(Public directory URL) and %ATTACHURL%
(URL of topic file attachment).
- 09 Feb 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- New text formatting rule for creating
fixed font text
. Words get showns in fixed font
by enclosing them in "=" equal signs. Example Writing =fixed font= will show up as fixed font
.
- 09 Feb 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- No new topic revision is created if the same person saves a topic again within one hour.
- 03 Feb 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Possible to view complete revision history of a topic on one page. Access at the linked date in the Changes page, or the
Diffs
link at the bottom of each topic, e.g.
Topic TWikiHistory . { Edit Ref-By Diffs r1.3 > r1.2 > r1.1 }
Revision r1.3 1998/11/10 01:34 by PeterThoeny
- 04 Jan 1999 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Fixed bug when viewing differences between topic revisions that include HTML table tags like <table>, <tr>, <td>.
1998 Releases
- 08 Dec 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Signature is shown below the text area when editing a topic. Use this to easily copy & paste your signature into the text.
- 07 Dec 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Possible to add a category table to a TWiki topic. This permits storing and searching for more structured information. Editing a topic shows a HTML form with the usual text area and a table with selectors, checkboxes, radio buttons and text fields. TWikiDocumentation has more on setup. The TWiki.Know web uses this category table to set classification, platform and OS version.
- 18 Nov 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Internal log of topic save actions to the file
data/logYYYYMM.txt
, where YYYYMM
the year and month in numeric format is. Intended for auditing only, not accessible from the web.
- 10 Nov 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- The e-mail notification and the Changes topic have now a topic date that is linked. Clicking on the link will show the difference between the two most recent topic revisions.
- 10 Nov 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- View differences between topic revisions. Each topic has a list of revisions (e.g.
r1.3
) and differences thereof (e.g. >
) at the bottom
Topic TWikiHistory . { Edit Ref-By r1.3 > r1.2 > r1.1 }
Revision r1.3 1998/11/10 01:34 by TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 26 Oct 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added preview of topic changes before saving the topic. This was necessary to prevent unneeded revisions.
- 26 Oct 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added revision control using RCS. Each topic has now a list of revisions at the bottom and a revision info, e.g.
Topic TWikiHistory . { Edit Ref-By r1.3 r1.2 r1.1 }
Revision r1.3 1998/10/26 01:34:00 by TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 14 Oct 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Refered-By Find out which topics have a link to the current topic. Each topic has a Ref-By link for that. Note Only references from the current web are shown, not references from other webs.
- 13 Oct 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 24 Sep 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Corrected templates for automatic e-mail notification so that MS Outlook can display attachment as an HTML file.
- 13 Aug 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- 07 Aug 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Automatic e-mail notification when something has changed in a TWiki web. Each web has a topic WebNotify where one can subscribe and unsubscribe.
- 06 Aug 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added server side include of files. Syntax is
%INCLUDE:"filename.ext"%
- 05 Aug 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Signature and date is inserted automatically when creating a new topic.
- 04 Aug 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Separate templates for text of non existing topic and default text of new topic. (template file templates/Web/notedited.tmpl)
- 04 Aug 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Warn user if new topic name is not a valid Wiki name. (template file templates/Web/notwiki.tmpl)
- 31 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Support for quoted text with a '>' at the beginning of the line.
- 28 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added TWiki variables, enclosed in % signs
%TOPIC%
(Topic name), %WEB%
(web name), %SCRIPTURL%
(script URL), %DATE%
(current date), %WIKIWEBMASTER%
(Wiki webmaster address), %WIKIVERSION%
(Wiki version), %USERNAME%
(user name), %WIKIUSERNAME%
(Wiki user name).
- 28 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Topic WebChanges shows Wiki username instead of Intranet username, e.g.
PeterThoeny
instead of thoeny
in case the Wiki username exists. Implementation Automatic lookup of Wiki username in topic TWikiUsers.
- 28 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Topic index. (Technically speaking a simple '.*' search on topic names.)
- 28 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Topic WebSearch allows full text search and and topic search with/without regular expressions.
- 27 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Added automatic links to topics in other TWiki webs by specifying <web name>.<topic name>, e.g.
Know.WebSeach
.
- 23 Jul 1998 - TWiki:Main.PeterThoeny
- Installed initial version, based on the JOS Wiki. See WikiWikiClones for details.
Dev Flow
The typical TWiki development flow...
Related Topics: DeveloperDocumentationCategory
Back to top
Appendix B: Encode URLs With UTF8
Use internationalised characters within WikiWords and attachment names
This topic addresses implemented UTF-8 support for URLs only. The overall plan for UTF-8 support for TWiki is described in
TWiki:Codev.ProposedUTF8SupportForI18N.
Current Status
To simplify use of internationalised characters within
WikiWords and attachment names, TWiki now supports UTF-8 URLs, converting on-the-fly to virtually any character set, including ISO-8859-*, KOI8-R, EUC-JP, and so on.
Support for UTF-8 URL encoding avoids having to configure the browser to turn off this encoding in URLs (the default in Internet Explorer, Opera Browser and some Mozilla Browser URLs) and enables support of browsers where only this mode is supported (e.g. Opera Browser for Symbian smartphones). A non-UTF-8 site character set (e.g. ISO-8859-*) is still used within TWiki, and in fact pages are stored and viewed entirely in the site character set - the browser dynamically converts URLs from the site character set into UTF-8, and TWiki converts them back again.
System requirements are updated as follows:
- ASCII or ISO-8859-1-only sites do not require any additional CPAN modules to be installed.
- Perl 5.8 sites using any character set do not require additional modules, since CPAN:Encode is installed as part of Perl.
- This feature still works on Perl 5.005_03 as per TWikiSystemRequirements, or Perl 5.6, as long as CPAN:Unicode::MapUTF8 is installed.
The following 'non-ASCII-safe' character encodings are now excluded from use as the site character set, since they interfere with TWiki markup: ISO-2022-*, HZ-*, Shift-JIS, MS-Kanji, GB2312, GBK, GB18030, Johab and UHC. However, many multi-byte character sets work fine, e.g. EUC-JP, EUC-KR, EUC-TW, and EUC-CN. In addition, UTF-8 can already be used, with some limitations, for East Asian languages where EUC character encodings are not acceptable - see
TWiki:Codev.ProposedUTF8SupportForI18N.
It's now possible to override the site character set defined in the
{SiteLocale}
setting in
configure - this enables you to have a slightly different spelling of the character set in the server locale (e.g. 'eucjp') and the HTTP header sent to the browser (e.g. 'euc-jp').
This feature should also support use of Mozilla Browser with
TWiki:Codev.TWikiOnMainframe (as long as mainframe web server can convert or pass through UTF-8 URLs) - however, this specific combination is not tested. Other browser-server combinations should not have any problems.
Please note that use of UTF-8 as the site character set is not yet supported - see Phase 2 of
TWiki:Codev.ProposedUTF8SupportForI18N for plans and work to date in this area.
This feature is complete in TWiki releases newer than February 2004.
Note for skin developers: is no longer required (
TWiki:Plugins.InternationalisingYourSkin).
Details of Implementation
URLs are not allowed to contain non-ASCII (8th bit set) characters:
http://www.w3.org/TR/html4/appendix/notes.html#non-ascii-chars
The overall plan for UTF-8 support for TWiki is described in two phases in
TWiki:/Codev.ProposedUTF8SupportForI18N - this page addresses the first phase, in which UTF-8 is supported for URLs only.
UTF-8 URL translation to virtually any character set is supported as of TWiki Release 01 Sep 2004, but full UTF-8 support (e.g. pages in UTF-8) is not supported yet - this will be phase 2.
The code automatically detects whether a URL is UTF-8 or not, taking care to avoid over-long and illegal UTF-8 encodings that could introduce
TWiki:Codev.MajorSecurityProblemWithIncludeFileProcessing (tested against a comprehensive
UTF-8 test file, which IE 5.5 fails quite dangerously, and Opera Browser passes). Any non-ASCII URLs that are
not valid UTF-8 are then assumed to be directly URL-encoded as a single-byte or multi-byte character set (as now), e.g. EUC-JP.
The main point is that you can use TWiki with international characters in
WikiWords without changing your browser setup from the default, and you can also still use TWiki using non-UTF-8 URLs. This works on any Perl version from 5.005_03 onwards and corresponds to Phase 1 of
TWiki:Codev.ProposedUTF8SupportForI18N. You can have different users using different URL formats transparently on the same server.
UTF-8 URLs are automatically converted to the current
{Site}{Charset}, using modules such as
CPAN:Encode if needed.
TWiki generates the whole page in the site charset, e.g. ISO-8859-1 or EUC-JP, but the browser dynamically UTF-8 encodes the attachment's URL when it's used. Since Apache serves attachment downloads without TWiki being involved, TWiki's code can't do its UTF-8 decoding trick, so TWiki URL-encodes such URLs in ISO-8859-1 or whatever when generating the page, to bypass this URL encoding, ensuring that the URLs and filenames seen by Apache remain in the site charset.
TWiki:Codev.TWikiOnMainframe uses EBCDIC web servers that typically translate their output to ASCII, UTF-8 or ISO-8859-1 (and URLs in the other direction) since there are so few EBCDIC web browsers. Such web servers don't work with even ISO-8859-1 URLs if they are URL encoded, since the automated translation is bypassed for URL-encoded characters. For TWiki on Mainframe, TWiki assumes that the web server will automatically translate UTF-8 URLs into EBCDIC URLs, as long as URL encoding is turned off in TWiki pages.
Testing and Limitation
It should work with
TWiki:Codev.TWikiOnMainframe. Tested with IE 5.5, Opera 7.11 and Mozilla (Firebird 0.7).
Opera Browser on the P800 smartphone is working for page viewing but leads to corrupt page names when editing pages.
For up to date information see
TWiki:Codev.EncodeURLsWithUTF8
Back to top
Appendix C: TWiki CSS
Listing of CSS class names emitted from TWiki core code and standard plugins, for the Dakar release.
Who should read this document?
Most html elements generated by TWiki core code now have Cascading Style Sheet (CSS) tags.
Skin builders and others who want to change the appearance of the default TWiki installation or any of the skins can use this document to see what styles can be created for these html elements.
Naming conventions
- All TWiki class names have the prefix
twiki
. So: twikiAlert, twikiToc, etcetera. Remember that CSS class names are case sensitive - TWiki CSS uses lowercase tw
.
- If you define your own CSS classes, it is preferable that you do not use the
twiki
prefix to prevent undesired overriding effects.
A wide range of standard styles are used in the TWiki core code and topics, and more are used in plugins. The following is an exhaustive list of all styles defined by the Pattern skin. For the most part, the names are the only documentation of the purpose of the style. For more information on how these styles are used, read the code (sorry!)
TWiki styles in core code
.twikiAlert |
Client.pm, Form.pm, Statistics.pm |
.twikiFirstCol |
Render.pm |
.twikiForm |
Render.pm |
.twikiNew |
Changes.pm, Search.pm |
.twikiHelp |
Changes.pm |
.twikiTopRow |
Manage.pm |
.twikiSummary |
Manage.pm |
.twikiGrayText |
Manage.pm |
.twikiCheckBox |
Manage.pm |
.twikiLink |
Render.pm |
.twikiNewLink |
Render.pm |
.twikiAnchorLink |
Render.pm |
.twikiCurrentWebHomeLink |
Render.pm |
.twikiCurrentTopicLink |
Render.pm |
.twikiEmulatedLink |
Preview.pm |
.twikiWebIndent |
TWiki.pm |
.twikiEditFormDateField |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormTextField |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormLabelField |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormTextAreaField |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormCheckboxButton |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormCheckboxField |
Form.pm |
.twikiRadioButton |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormRadioField |
Form.pm |
.twikiEditFormError |
Form.pm |
.twikiDiffTable |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffDeletedHeader |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffDeletedMarker |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffDeletedText |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffAddedHeader |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffAddedMarker |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffAddedText |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffChangedHeader |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffChangedText |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffUnchangedText |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffUnchangedTextContents |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffLineNumberHeader |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffDebug |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffDebugRight |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiDiffDebugLeft |
RDiff.pm |
.twikiToc |
TWiki.pm |
.twikiTocTitle |
TWiki.pm |
TWiki Styles in Plugins
.twikiTable |
The table |
.twikiSortedCol |
A sorted column |
.twikiSortedAscendingCol |
Sorted column, ascending |
.twikiSortedDescendingCol |
Sorted column, descending |
.tableSortIcon |
The sort icon holder (span) |
.twikiFirstCol |
The first column |
.twikiTableEven |
Even numbered rows |
.twikiTableOdd |
Odd numbered rows |
.twikiTableCol + column number |
Unique column identifier, for instance: twikiTableCol0 |
.twikiTableRow + type + row number |
Unique row identifier, for instance: twikiTableRowdataBg0 |
TWiki Styles in Templates
.twikiPage |
twiki.tmpl |
.twikiMiddleContainer |
twiki.tmpl |
.twikiMain |
twiki.tmpl |
.twikiFormTable |
formtables.tmpl, form.tmpl |
.twikiFormTableHRow |
formtables.tmpl, form.tmpl |
.twikiFormTableRow |
formtables.tmpl |
.twikiFormTableFooter |
formtables.tmpl |
.twikiAttachments |
attachtables.tmpl |
.twikiEditForm |
form.tmpl |
.twikiSubmit |
|
.twikiSubmitDisabled |
|
.twikiInputField |
|
.twikiInputFieldDisabled |
|
.twikiInputFieldReadOnly |
|
.twikiInputFieldFocus |
For Internet Explorer that does not recognize the :focus pseudo class selector |
.twikiInputFieldBeforeFocus |
for use with Javascript: the color of the input text when not clicked in the field |
.twikiTextarea |
|
.twikiTextareaRawView |
|
.twikiButton |
|
.twikiFocus |
Behaviour marker so a field can be given input focus |
.twikiLeft |
|
.twikiRight |
|
.twikiClear |
|
.twikiHidden |
|
.twikiSmall |
|
.twikiBottomRow |
|
.twikiSRAuthor |
|
.twikiSRRev |
|
.twikiPageForm |
|
.twikiSeparator |
|
.twikiAccessKey |
|
.twikiLinkLabel |
|
.twikiFormSteps |
container around a form, such as the attach form: attach.tmpl |
.twikiFormStep |
form row |
.twikiNoBreak |
no break on whitespace |
.twikiMakeVisible |
For elements that should only be visible with javascript on: default set to hidden, is made visible by javascript. Defaults to inline. |
.twikiMakeVisibleInline |
For span elements that should only be visible with javascript on: default set to hidden, is made visible by javascript. |
.twikiMakeVisibleBlock |
For div elements that should only be visible with javascript on: default set to hidden, is made visible by javascript. |
.twikiMakeHidden |
For elements that should be hidden with javascript on: no default style, is made hidden by javascript. |
.twikiFooterNote |
|
.twikiPopUp |
Behaviour marker so a popup-window can be invoked |
TWiki Styles used in configure
#twikiLogin |
CSS.pm |
.twikiFormSteps |
CSS.pm |
.twikiFormStep |
CSS.pm |
TWiki Styles in topics
TWiki Styles in Skins
#twikiLogin |
login.pattern.tmpl |
|
Reserved Styles
.twikiImage |
defined in PatternSkin |
div creates border around enclosed image |
.twikiNotification |
defined in PatternSkin |
temporary alert, lighter than broadcast message |
.twikiUnvisited |
defined in PatternSkin |
link style that ignores the visited link state; useful for form links |
Tips
PatternSkin makes extensive use of CSS in its templates. Read the
PatternSkin topic and
PatternSkinCss to learn more about creating your own CSS-based skin.
Practical introduction to CSS:
http://www.w3.org/Style/LieBos2e/enter/
Related Topics: TWikiSkins,
PatternSkin,
DeveloperDocumentationCategory,
AdminDocumentationCategory
Back to top